doc: fix xtensa commands type
[openocd.git] / doc / openocd.texi
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c %**start of header
3 @setfilename openocd.info
4 @settitle OpenOCD User's Guide
5 @dircategory Development
6 @direntry
7 * OpenOCD: (openocd). OpenOCD User's Guide
8 @end direntry
9 @paragraphindent 0
10 @c %**end of header
11
12 @include version.texi
13
14 @copying
15
16 This User's Guide documents
17 release @value{VERSION},
18 dated @value{UPDATED},
19 of the Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD).
20
21 @itemize @bullet
22 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008-2022 The OpenOCD Project
23 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2007-2008 Spencer Oliver @email{spen@@spen-soft.co.uk}
24 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008-2010 Oyvind Harboe @email{oyvind.harboe@@zylin.com}
25 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 Duane Ellis @email{openocd@@duaneellis.com}
26 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2009-2010 David Brownell
27 @end itemize
28
29 @quotation
30 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
31 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2 or
32 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
33 Invariant Sections, no Front-Cover Texts, and no Back-Cover Texts. A
34 copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free
35 Documentation License''.
36 @end quotation
37 @end copying
38
39 @titlepage
40 @titlefont{@emph{Open On-Chip Debugger:}}
41 @sp 1
42 @title OpenOCD User's Guide
43 @subtitle for release @value{VERSION}
44 @subtitle @value{UPDATED}
45
46 @page
47 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
48 @insertcopying
49 @end titlepage
50
51 @summarycontents
52 @contents
53
54 @ifnottex
55 @node Top
56 @top OpenOCD User's Guide
57
58 @insertcopying
59 @end ifnottex
60
61 @menu
62 * About:: About OpenOCD
63 * Developers:: OpenOCD Developer Resources
64 * Debug Adapter Hardware:: Debug Adapter Hardware
65 * About Jim-Tcl:: About Jim-Tcl
66 * Running:: Running OpenOCD
67 * OpenOCD Project Setup:: OpenOCD Project Setup
68 * Config File Guidelines:: Config File Guidelines
69 * Server Configuration:: Server Configuration
70 * Debug Adapter Configuration:: Debug Adapter Configuration
71 * Reset Configuration:: Reset Configuration
72 * TAP Declaration:: TAP Declaration
73 * CPU Configuration:: CPU Configuration
74 * Flash Commands:: Flash Commands
75 * Flash Programming:: Flash Programming
76 * PLD/FPGA Commands:: PLD/FPGA Commands
77 * General Commands:: General Commands
78 * Architecture and Core Commands:: Architecture and Core Commands
79 * JTAG Commands:: JTAG Commands
80 * Boundary Scan Commands:: Boundary Scan Commands
81 * Utility Commands:: Utility Commands
82 * GDB and OpenOCD:: Using GDB and OpenOCD
83 * Tcl Scripting API:: Tcl Scripting API
84 * FAQ:: Frequently Asked Questions
85 * Tcl Crash Course:: Tcl Crash Course
86 * License:: GNU Free Documentation License
87
88 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
89 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
90 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
91 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
92 * OpenOCD Concept Index:: Concept Index
93 * Command and Driver Index:: Command and Driver Index
94 @end menu
95
96 @node About
97 @unnumbered About
98 @cindex about
99
100 OpenOCD was created by Dominic Rath as part of a 2005 diploma thesis written
101 at the University of Applied Sciences Augsburg (@uref{http://www.hs-augsburg.de}).
102 Since that time, the project has grown into an active open-source project,
103 supported by a diverse community of software and hardware developers from
104 around the world.
105
106 @section What is OpenOCD?
107 @cindex TAP
108 @cindex JTAG
109
110 The Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD) aims to provide debugging,
111 in-system programming and boundary-scan testing for embedded target
112 devices.
113
114 It does so with the assistance of a @dfn{debug adapter}, which is
115 a small hardware module which helps provide the right kind of
116 electrical signaling to the target being debugged. These are
117 required since the debug host (on which OpenOCD runs) won't
118 usually have native support for such signaling, or the connector
119 needed to hook up to the target.
120
121 Such debug adapters support one or more @dfn{transport} protocols,
122 each of which involves different electrical signaling (and uses
123 different messaging protocols on top of that signaling). There
124 are many types of debug adapter, and little uniformity in what
125 they are called. (There are also product naming differences.)
126
127 These adapters are sometimes packaged as discrete dongles, which
128 may generically be called @dfn{hardware interface dongles}.
129 Some development boards also integrate them directly, which may
130 let the development board connect directly to the debug
131 host over USB (and sometimes also to power it over USB).
132
133 For example, a @dfn{JTAG Adapter} supports JTAG
134 signaling, and is used to communicate
135 with JTAG (IEEE 1149.1) compliant TAPs on your target board.
136 A @dfn{TAP} is a ``Test Access Port'', a module which processes
137 special instructions and data. TAPs are daisy-chained within and
138 between chips and boards. JTAG supports debugging and boundary
139 scan operations.
140
141 There are also @dfn{SWD Adapters} that support Serial Wire Debug (SWD)
142 signaling to communicate with some newer ARM cores, as well as debug
143 adapters which support both JTAG and SWD transports. SWD supports only
144 debugging, whereas JTAG also supports boundary scan operations.
145
146 For some chips, there are also @dfn{Programming Adapters} supporting
147 special transports used only to write code to flash memory, without
148 support for on-chip debugging or boundary scan.
149 (At this writing, OpenOCD does not support such non-debug adapters.)
150
151
152 @b{Dongles:} OpenOCD currently supports many types of hardware dongles:
153 USB-based, parallel port-based, and other standalone boxes that run
154 OpenOCD internally. @xref{Debug Adapter Hardware}.
155
156 @b{GDB Debug:} It allows ARM7 (ARM7TDMI and ARM720t), ARM9 (ARM920T,
157 ARM922T, ARM926EJ--S, ARM966E--S), XScale (PXA25x, IXP42x), Cortex-M3
158 (Stellaris LM3, STMicroelectronics STM32 and Energy Micro EFM32) and
159 Intel Quark (x10xx) based cores to be debugged via the GDB protocol.
160
161 @b{Flash Programming:} Flash writing is supported for external
162 CFI-compatible NOR flashes (Intel and AMD/Spansion command set) and several
163 internal flashes (LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4300, AT91SAM7, AT91SAM3U,
164 STR7x, STR9x, LM3, STM32x and EFM32). Preliminary support for various NAND flash
165 controllers (LPC3180, Orion, S3C24xx, more) is included.
166
167 @section OpenOCD Web Site
168
169 The OpenOCD web site provides the latest public news from the community:
170
171 @uref{http://openocd.org/}
172
173 @section Latest User's Guide:
174
175 The user's guide you are now reading may not be the latest one
176 available. A version for more recent code may be available.
177 Its HTML form is published regularly at:
178
179 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/html/index.html}
180
181 PDF form is likewise published at:
182
183 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/pdf/openocd.pdf}
184
185 @section OpenOCD User's Forum
186
187 There is an OpenOCD forum (phpBB) hosted by SparkFun,
188 which might be helpful to you. Note that if you want
189 anything to come to the attention of developers, you
190 should post it to the OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
191 instead of this forum.
192
193 @uref{http://forum.sparkfun.com/viewforum.php?f=18}
194
195 @section OpenOCD User's Mailing List
196
197 The OpenOCD User Mailing List provides the primary means of
198 communication between users:
199
200 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-user}
201
202 @section OpenOCD IRC
203
204 Support can also be found on irc:
205 @uref{irc://irc.libera.chat/openocd}
206
207 @node Developers
208 @chapter OpenOCD Developer Resources
209 @cindex developers
210
211 If you are interested in improving the state of OpenOCD's debugging and
212 testing support, new contributions will be welcome. Motivated developers
213 can produce new target, flash or interface drivers, improve the
214 documentation, as well as more conventional bug fixes and enhancements.
215
216 The resources in this chapter are available for developers wishing to explore
217 or expand the OpenOCD source code.
218
219 @section OpenOCD Git Repository
220
221 During the 0.3.x release cycle, OpenOCD switched from Subversion to
222 a Git repository hosted at SourceForge. The repository URL is:
223
224 @uref{git://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
225
226 or via http
227
228 @uref{http://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
229
230 You may prefer to use a mirror and the HTTP protocol:
231
232 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/r/openocd.git}
233
234 With standard Git tools, use @command{git clone} to initialize
235 a local repository, and @command{git pull} to update it.
236 There are also gitweb pages letting you browse the repository
237 with a web browser, or download arbitrary snapshots without
238 needing a Git client:
239
240 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/w/openocd.git}
241
242 The @file{README} file contains the instructions for building the project
243 from the repository or a snapshot.
244
245 Developers that want to contribute patches to the OpenOCD system are
246 @b{strongly} encouraged to work against mainline.
247 Patches created against older versions may require additional
248 work from their submitter in order to be updated for newer releases.
249
250 @section Doxygen Developer Manual
251
252 During the 0.2.x release cycle, the OpenOCD project began
253 providing a Doxygen reference manual. This document contains more
254 technical information about the software internals, development
255 processes, and similar documentation:
256
257 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/html/index.html}
258
259 This document is a work-in-progress, but contributions would be welcome
260 to fill in the gaps. All of the source files are provided in-tree,
261 listed in the Doxyfile configuration at the top of the source tree.
262
263 @section Gerrit Review System
264
265 All changes in the OpenOCD Git repository go through the web-based Gerrit
266 Code Review System:
267
268 @uref{https://review.openocd.org/}
269
270 After a one-time registration and repository setup, anyone can push commits
271 from their local Git repository directly into Gerrit.
272 All users and developers are encouraged to review, test, discuss and vote
273 for changes in Gerrit. The feedback provides the basis for a maintainer to
274 eventually submit the change to the main Git repository.
275
276 The @file{HACKING} file, also available as the Patch Guide in the Doxygen
277 Developer Manual, contains basic information about how to connect a
278 repository to Gerrit, prepare and push patches. Patch authors are expected to
279 maintain their changes while they're in Gerrit, respond to feedback and if
280 necessary rework and push improved versions of the change.
281
282 @section OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
283
284 The OpenOCD Developer Mailing List provides the primary means of
285 communication between developers:
286
287 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-devel}
288
289 @section OpenOCD Bug Tracker
290
291 The OpenOCD Bug Tracker is hosted on SourceForge:
292
293 @uref{http://bugs.openocd.org/}
294
295
296 @node Debug Adapter Hardware
297 @chapter Debug Adapter Hardware
298 @cindex dongles
299 @cindex FTDI
300 @cindex wiggler
301 @cindex printer port
302 @cindex USB Adapter
303 @cindex RTCK
304
305 Defined: @b{dongle}: A small device that plugs into a computer and serves as
306 an adapter .... [snip]
307
308 In the OpenOCD case, this generally refers to @b{a small adapter} that
309 attaches to your computer via USB or the parallel port.
310
311
312 @section Choosing a Dongle
313
314 There are several things you should keep in mind when choosing a dongle.
315
316 @enumerate
317 @item @b{Transport} Does it support the kind of communication that you need?
318 OpenOCD focuses mostly on JTAG. Your version may also support
319 other ways to communicate with target devices.
320 @item @b{Voltage} What voltage is your target - 1.8, 2.8, 3.3, or 5V?
321 Does your dongle support it? You might need a level converter.
322 @item @b{Pinout} What pinout does your target board use?
323 Does your dongle support it? You may be able to use jumper
324 wires, or an "octopus" connector, to convert pinouts.
325 @item @b{Connection} Does your computer have the USB, parallel, or
326 Ethernet port needed?
327 @item @b{RTCK} Do you expect to use it with ARM chips and boards with
328 RTCK support (also known as ``adaptive clocking'')?
329 @end enumerate
330
331 @section USB FT2232 Based
332
333 There are many USB JTAG dongles on the market, many of them based
334 on a chip from ``Future Technology Devices International'' (FTDI)
335 known as the FTDI FT2232; this is a USB full speed (12 Mbps) chip.
336 See: @url{http://www.ftdichip.com} for more information.
337 In summer 2009, USB high speed (480 Mbps) versions of these FTDI
338 chips started to become available in JTAG adapters. Around 2012, a new
339 variant appeared - FT232H - this is a single-channel version of FT2232H.
340 (Adapters using those high speed FT2232H or FT232H chips may support adaptive
341 clocking.)
342
343 The FT2232 chips are flexible enough to support some other
344 transport options, such as SWD or the SPI variants used to
345 program some chips. They have two communications channels,
346 and one can be used for a UART adapter at the same time the
347 other one is used to provide a debug adapter.
348
349 Also, some development boards integrate an FT2232 chip to serve as
350 a built-in low-cost debug adapter and USB-to-serial solution.
351
352 @itemize @bullet
353 @item @b{usbjtag}
354 @* Link @url{http://elk.informatik.fh-augsburg.de/hhweb/doc/openocd/usbjtag/usbjtag.html}
355 @item @b{jtagkey}
356 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey.shtml}
357 @item @b{jtagkey2}
358 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey2.shtml}
359 @item @b{oocdlink}
360 @* See: @url{http://www.oocdlink.com} By Joern Kaipf
361 @item @b{signalyzer}
362 @* See: @url{http://www.signalyzer.com}
363 @item @b{Stellaris Eval Boards}
364 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - The Stellaris eval boards
365 bundle FT2232-based JTAG and SWD support, which can be used to debug
366 the Stellaris chips. Using separate JTAG adapters is optional.
367 These boards can also be used in a "pass through" mode as JTAG adapters
368 to other target boards, disabling the Stellaris chip.
369 @item @b{TI/Luminary ICDI}
370 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - TI/Luminary In-Circuit Debug
371 Interface (ICDI) Boards are included in Stellaris LM3S9B9x
372 Evaluation Kits. Like the non-detachable FT2232 support on the other
373 Stellaris eval boards, they can be used to debug other target boards.
374 @item @b{olimex-jtag}
375 @* See: @url{http://www.olimex.com}
376 @item @b{Flyswatter/Flyswatter2}
377 @* See: @url{http://www.tincantools.com}
378 @item @b{turtelizer2}
379 @* See:
380 @uref{http://www.ethernut.de/en/hardware/turtelizer/index.html, Turtelizer 2}, or
381 @url{http://www.ethernut.de}
382 @item @b{comstick}
383 @* Link: @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=383}
384 @item @b{stm32stick}
385 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/stm32-stick}
386 @item @b{axm0432_jtag}
387 @* Axiom AXM-0432 Link @url{http://www.axman.com} - NOTE: This JTAG does not appear
388 to be available anymore as of April 2012.
389 @item @b{cortino}
390 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=cortino}
391 @item @b{dlp-usb1232h}
392 @* Link @url{http://www.dlpdesign.com/usb/usb1232h.shtml}
393 @item @b{digilent-hs1}
394 @* Link @url{http://www.digilentinc.com/Products/Detail.cfm?Prod=JTAG-HS1}
395 @item @b{opendous}
396 @* Link @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous/wiki/JTAG} FT2232H-based
397 (OpenHardware).
398 @item @b{JTAG-lock-pick Tiny 2}
399 @* Link @url{http://www.distortec.com/jtag-lock-pick-tiny-2} FT232H-based
400
401 @item @b{GW16042}
402 @* Link: @url{http://shop.gateworks.com/index.php?route=product/product&path=70_80&product_id=64}
403 FT2232H-based
404
405 @end itemize
406 @section USB-JTAG / Altera USB-Blaster compatibles
407
408 These devices also show up as FTDI devices, but are not
409 protocol-compatible with the FT2232 devices. They are, however,
410 protocol-compatible among themselves. USB-JTAG devices typically consist
411 of a FT245 followed by a CPLD that understands a particular protocol,
412 or emulates this protocol using some other hardware.
413
414 They may appear under different USB VID/PID depending on the particular
415 product. The driver can be configured to search for any VID/PID pair
416 (see the section on driver commands).
417
418 @itemize
419 @item @b{USB-JTAG} Kolja Waschk's USB Blaster-compatible adapter
420 @* Link: @url{http://ixo-jtag.sourceforge.net/}
421 @item @b{Altera USB-Blaster}
422 @* Link: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_usb_blstr.pdf}
423 @end itemize
424
425 @section USB J-Link based
426 There are several OEM versions of the SEGGER @b{J-Link} adapter. It is
427 an example of a microcontroller based JTAG adapter, it uses an
428 AT91SAM764 internally.
429
430 @itemize @bullet
431 @item @b{SEGGER J-Link}
432 @* Link: @url{http://www.segger.com/jlink.html}
433 @item @b{Atmel SAM-ICE} (Only works with Atmel chips!)
434 @* Link: @url{http://www.atmel.com/tools/atmelsam-ice.aspx}
435 @item @b{IAR J-Link}
436 @end itemize
437
438 @section USB RLINK based
439 Raisonance has an adapter called @b{RLink}. It exists in a stripped-down form on the STM32 Primer,
440 permanently attached to the JTAG lines. It also exists on the STM32 Primer2, but that is wired for
441 SWD and not JTAG, thus not supported.
442
443 @itemize @bullet
444 @item @b{Raisonance RLink}
445 @* Link: @url{http://www.mcu-raisonance.com/~rlink-debugger-programmer__@/microcontrollers__tool~tool__T018:4cn9ziz4bnx6.html}
446 @item @b{STM32 Primer}
447 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer.php}
448 @item @b{STM32 Primer2}
449 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer2.php}
450 @end itemize
451
452 @section USB ST-LINK based
453 STMicroelectronics has an adapter called @b{ST-LINK}.
454 They only work with STMicroelectronics chips, notably STM32 and STM8.
455
456 @itemize @bullet
457 @item @b{ST-LINK}
458 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32VLDISCOVERY.
459 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/219866.jsp}
460 @item @b{ST-LINK/V2}
461 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32F4DISCOVERY.
462 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/251168.jsp}
463 @item @b{STLINK-V3}
464 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits.
465 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/stlink-v3}
466 @end itemize
467
468 For info the original ST-LINK enumerates using the mass storage usb class; however,
469 its implementation is completely broken. The result is this causes issues under Linux.
470 The simplest solution is to get Linux to ignore the ST-LINK using one of the following methods:
471 @itemize @bullet
472 @item modprobe -r usb-storage && modprobe usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i
473 @item add "options usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i" to /etc/modprobe.conf
474 @end itemize
475
476 @section USB TI/Stellaris ICDI based
477 Texas Instruments has an adapter called @b{ICDI}.
478 It is not to be confused with the FTDI based adapters that were originally fitted to their
479 evaluation boards. This is the adapter fitted to the Stellaris LaunchPad.
480
481 @section USB Nuvoton Nu-Link
482 Nuvoton has an adapter called @b{Nu-Link}.
483 It is available either as stand-alone dongle and embedded on development boards.
484 It supports SWD, serial port bridge and mass storage for firmware update.
485 Both Nu-Link v1 and v2 are supported.
486
487 @section USB CMSIS-DAP based
488 ARM has released a interface standard called CMSIS-DAP that simplifies connecting
489 debuggers to ARM Cortex based targets @url{http://www.keil.com/support/man/docs/dapdebug/dapdebug_introduction.htm}.
490
491 @section USB Other
492 @itemize @bullet
493 @item @b{USBprog}
494 @* Link: @url{http://shop.embedded-projects.net/} - which uses an Atmel MEGA32 and a UBN9604
495
496 @item @b{USB - Presto}
497 @* Link: @url{http://tools.asix.net/prg_presto.htm}
498
499 @item @b{Versaloon-Link}
500 @* Link: @url{http://www.versaloon.com}
501
502 @item @b{ARM-JTAG-EW}
503 @* Link: @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag-ew.html}
504
505 @item @b{Buspirate}
506 @* Link: @url{http://dangerousprototypes.com/bus-pirate-manual/}
507
508 @item @b{opendous}
509 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous-jtag/} - which uses an AT90USB162
510
511 @item @b{estick}
512 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/estick-jtag/}
513
514 @item @b{Keil ULINK v1}
515 @* Link: @url{http://www.keil.com/ulink1/}
516
517 @item @b{TI XDS110 Debug Probe}
518 @* Link: @url{https://software-dl.ti.com/ccs/esd/documents/xdsdebugprobes/emu_xds110.html}
519 @* Link: @url{https://software-dl.ti.com/ccs/esd/documents/xdsdebugprobes/emu_xds_software_package_download.html#xds110-support-utilities}
520 @end itemize
521
522 @section IBM PC Parallel Printer Port Based
523
524 The two well-known ``JTAG Parallel Ports'' cables are the Xilinx DLC5
525 and the Macraigor Wiggler. There are many clones and variations of
526 these on the market.
527
528 Note that parallel ports are becoming much less common, so if you
529 have the choice you should probably avoid these adapters in favor
530 of USB-based ones.
531
532 @itemize @bullet
533
534 @item @b{Wiggler} - There are many clones of this.
535 @* Link: @url{http://www.macraigor.com/wiggler.htm}
536
537 @item @b{DLC5} - From XILINX - There are many clones of this
538 @* Link: Search the web for: ``XILINX DLC5'' - it is no longer
539 produced, PDF schematics are easily found and it is easy to make.
540
541 @item @b{Amontec - JTAG Accelerator}
542 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtag_accelerator.shtml}
543
544 @item @b{Wiggler2}
545 @* Link: @url{http://www.ccac.rwth-aachen.de/~michaels/index.php/hardware/armjtag}
546
547 @item @b{Wiggler_ntrst_inverted}
548 @* Yet another variation - See the source code, src/jtag/parport.c
549
550 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler}
551 @* Unknown - probably not on the market today
552
553 @item @b{arm-jtag}
554 @* Link: Most likely @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag.html} [another wiggler clone]
555
556 @item @b{chameleon}
557 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/chameleon.shtml}
558
559 @item @b{Triton}
560 @* Unknown.
561
562 @item @b{Lattice}
563 @* ispDownload from Lattice Semiconductor
564 @url{http://www.latticesemi.com/lit/docs/@/devtools/dlcable.pdf}
565
566 @item @b{flashlink}
567 @* From STMicroelectronics;
568 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/com/TECHNICAL_RESOURCES/TECHNICAL_LITERATURE/DATA_BRIEF/DM00039500.pdf}
569
570 @end itemize
571
572 @section Other...
573 @itemize @bullet
574
575 @item @b{ep93xx}
576 @* An EP93xx based Linux machine using the GPIO pins directly.
577
578 @item @b{at91rm9200}
579 @* Like the EP93xx - but an ATMEL AT91RM9200 based solution using the GPIO pins on the chip.
580
581 @item @b{bcm2835gpio}
582 @* A BCM2835-based board (e.g. Raspberry Pi) using the GPIO pins of the expansion header.
583
584 @item @b{imx_gpio}
585 @* A NXP i.MX-based board (e.g. Wandboard) using the GPIO pins (should work on any i.MX processor).
586
587 @item @b{am335xgpio}
588 @* A Texas Instruments AM335x-based board (e.g. BeagleBone Black) using the GPIO pins of the expansion headers.
589
590 @item @b{jtag_vpi}
591 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the JTAG VPI server interface.
592 @* Link: @url{http://github.com/fjullien/jtag_vpi}
593
594 @item @b{vdebug}
595 @* A driver for Cadence virtual Debug Interface to emulated or simulated targets.
596 It implements a client connecting to the vdebug server, which in turn communicates
597 with the emulated or simulated RTL model through a transactor. The driver supports
598 JTAG and DAP-level transports.
599
600 @item @b{jtag_dpi}
601 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the SystemVerilog Direct Programming
602 Interface (DPI) for JTAG devices. DPI allows OpenOCD to connect to the JTAG
603 interface of a hardware model written in SystemVerilog, for example, on an
604 emulation model of target hardware.
605
606 @item @b{xlnx_pcie_xvc}
607 @* A JTAG driver exposing Xilinx Virtual Cable over PCI Express to OpenOCD as JTAG/SWD interface.
608
609 @item @b{linuxgpiod}
610 @* A bitbang JTAG driver using Linux GPIO through library libgpiod.
611
612 @item @b{sysfsgpio}
613 @* A bitbang JTAG driver using Linux legacy sysfs GPIO.
614 This is deprecated from Linux v5.3; prefer using @b{linuxgpiod}.
615
616 @item @b{esp_usb_jtag}
617 @* A JTAG driver to communicate with builtin debug modules of Espressif ESP32-C3 and ESP32-S3 chips using OpenOCD.
618
619 @end itemize
620
621 @node About Jim-Tcl
622 @chapter About Jim-Tcl
623 @cindex Jim-Tcl
624 @cindex tcl
625
626 OpenOCD uses a small ``Tcl Interpreter'' known as Jim-Tcl.
627 This programming language provides a simple and extensible
628 command interpreter.
629
630 All commands presented in this Guide are extensions to Jim-Tcl.
631 You can use them as simple commands, without needing to learn
632 much of anything about Tcl.
633 Alternatively, you can write Tcl programs with them.
634
635 You can learn more about Jim at its website, @url{http://jim.tcl.tk}.
636 There is an active and responsive community, get on the mailing list
637 if you have any questions. Jim-Tcl maintainers also lurk on the
638 OpenOCD mailing list.
639
640 @itemize @bullet
641 @item @b{Jim vs. Tcl}
642 @* Jim-Tcl is a stripped down version of the well known Tcl language,
643 which can be found here: @url{http://www.tcl.tk}. Jim-Tcl has far
644 fewer features. Jim-Tcl is several dozens of .C files and .H files and
645 implements the basic Tcl command set. In contrast: Tcl 8.6 is a
646 4.2 MB .zip file containing 1540 files.
647
648 @item @b{Missing Features}
649 @* Our practice has been: Add/clone the real Tcl feature if/when
650 needed. We welcome Jim-Tcl improvements, not bloat. Also there
651 are a large number of optional Jim-Tcl features that are not
652 enabled in OpenOCD.
653
654 @item @b{Scripts}
655 @* OpenOCD configuration scripts are Jim-Tcl Scripts. OpenOCD's
656 command interpreter today is a mixture of (newer)
657 Jim-Tcl commands, and the (older) original command interpreter.
658
659 @item @b{Commands}
660 @* At the OpenOCD telnet command line (or via the GDB monitor command) one
661 can type a Tcl for() loop, set variables, etc.
662 Some of the commands documented in this guide are implemented
663 as Tcl scripts, from a @file{startup.tcl} file internal to the server.
664
665 @item @b{Historical Note}
666 @* Jim-Tcl was introduced to OpenOCD in spring 2008. Fall 2010,
667 before OpenOCD 0.5 release, OpenOCD switched to using Jim-Tcl
668 as a Git submodule, which greatly simplified upgrading Jim-Tcl
669 to benefit from new features and bugfixes in Jim-Tcl.
670
671 @item @b{Need a crash course in Tcl?}
672 @*@xref{Tcl Crash Course}.
673 @end itemize
674
675 @node Running
676 @chapter Running
677 @cindex command line options
678 @cindex logfile
679 @cindex directory search
680
681 Properly installing OpenOCD sets up your operating system to grant it access
682 to the debug adapters. On Linux, this usually involves installing a file
683 in @file{/etc/udev/rules.d,} so OpenOCD has permissions. An example rules file
684 that works for many common adapters is shipped with OpenOCD in the
685 @file{contrib} directory. MS-Windows needs
686 complex and confusing driver configuration for every peripheral. Such issues
687 are unique to each operating system, and are not detailed in this User's Guide.
688
689 Then later you will invoke the OpenOCD server, with various options to
690 tell it how each debug session should work.
691 The @option{--help} option shows:
692 @verbatim
693 bash$ openocd --help
694
695 --help | -h display this help
696 --version | -v display OpenOCD version
697 --file | -f use configuration file <name>
698 --search | -s dir to search for config files and scripts
699 --debug | -d set debug level to 3
700 | -d<n> set debug level to <level>
701 --log_output | -l redirect log output to file <name>
702 --command | -c run <command>
703 @end verbatim
704
705 If you don't give any @option{-f} or @option{-c} options,
706 OpenOCD tries to read the configuration file @file{openocd.cfg}.
707 To specify one or more different
708 configuration files, use @option{-f} options. For example:
709
710 @example
711 openocd -f config1.cfg -f config2.cfg -f config3.cfg
712 @end example
713
714 Configuration files and scripts are searched for in
715 @enumerate
716 @item the current directory,
717 @item any search dir specified on the command line using the @option{-s} option,
718 @item any search dir specified using the @command{add_script_search_dir} command,
719 @item a directory in the @env{OPENOCD_SCRIPTS} environment variable (if set),
720 @item @file{%APPDATA%/OpenOCD} (only on Windows),
721 @item @file{$HOME/Library/Preferences/org.openocd} (only on Darwin),
722 @item @file{$XDG_CONFIG_HOME/openocd} (@env{$XDG_CONFIG_HOME} defaults to @file{$HOME/.config}),
723 @item @file{$HOME/.openocd},
724 @item the site wide script library @file{$pkgdatadir/site} and
725 @item the OpenOCD-supplied script library @file{$pkgdatadir/scripts}.
726 @end enumerate
727 The first found file with a matching file name will be used.
728
729 @quotation Note
730 Don't try to use configuration script names or paths which
731 include the "#" character. That character begins Tcl comments.
732 @end quotation
733
734 @section Simple setup, no customization
735
736 In the best case, you can use two scripts from one of the script
737 libraries, hook up your JTAG adapter, and start the server ... and
738 your JTAG setup will just work "out of the box". Always try to
739 start by reusing those scripts, but assume you'll need more
740 customization even if this works. @xref{OpenOCD Project Setup}.
741
742 If you find a script for your JTAG adapter, and for your board or
743 target, you may be able to hook up your JTAG adapter then start
744 the server with some variation of one of the following:
745
746 @example
747 openocd -f interface/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
748 openocd -f interface/ftdi/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
749 @end example
750
751 You might also need to configure which reset signals are present,
752 using @option{-c 'reset_config trst_and_srst'} or something similar.
753 If all goes well you'll see output something like
754
755 @example
756 Open On-Chip Debugger 0.4.0 (2010-01-14-15:06)
757 For bug reports, read
758 http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/bugs.html
759 Info : JTAG tap: lm3s.cpu tap/device found: 0x3ba00477
760 (mfg: 0x23b, part: 0xba00, ver: 0x3)
761 @end example
762
763 Seeing that "tap/device found" message, and no warnings, means
764 the JTAG communication is working. That's a key milestone, but
765 you'll probably need more project-specific setup.
766
767 @section What OpenOCD does as it starts
768
769 OpenOCD starts by processing the configuration commands provided
770 on the command line or, if there were no @option{-c command} or
771 @option{-f file.cfg} options given, in @file{openocd.cfg}.
772 @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage}.
773 At the end of the configuration stage it verifies the JTAG scan
774 chain defined using those commands; your configuration should
775 ensure that this always succeeds.
776 Normally, OpenOCD then starts running as a server.
777 Alternatively, commands may be used to terminate the configuration
778 stage early, perform work (such as updating some flash memory),
779 and then shut down without acting as a server.
780
781 Once OpenOCD starts running as a server, it waits for connections from
782 clients (Telnet, GDB, RPC) and processes the commands issued through
783 those channels.
784
785 If you are having problems, you can enable internal debug messages via
786 the @option{-d} option.
787
788 Also it is possible to interleave Jim-Tcl commands w/config scripts using the
789 @option{-c} command line switch.
790
791 To enable debug output (when reporting problems or working on OpenOCD
792 itself), use the @option{-d} command line switch. This sets the
793 @option{debug_level} to "3", outputting the most information,
794 including debug messages. The default setting is "2", outputting only
795 informational messages, warnings and errors. You can also change this
796 setting from within a telnet or gdb session using @command{debug_level<n>}
797 (@pxref{debuglevel,,debug_level}).
798
799 You can redirect all output from the server to a file using the
800 @option{-l <logfile>} switch.
801
802 Note! OpenOCD will launch the GDB & telnet server even if it can not
803 establish a connection with the target. In general, it is possible for
804 the JTAG controller to be unresponsive until the target is set up
805 correctly via e.g. GDB monitor commands in a GDB init script.
806
807 @node OpenOCD Project Setup
808 @chapter OpenOCD Project Setup
809
810 To use OpenOCD with your development projects, you need to do more than
811 just connect the JTAG adapter hardware (dongle) to your development board
812 and start the OpenOCD server.
813 You also need to configure your OpenOCD server so that it knows
814 about your adapter and board, and helps your work.
815 You may also want to connect OpenOCD to GDB, possibly
816 using Eclipse or some other GUI.
817
818 @section Hooking up the JTAG Adapter
819
820 Today's most common case is a dongle with a JTAG cable on one side
821 (such as a ribbon cable with a 10-pin or 20-pin IDC connector)
822 and a USB cable on the other.
823 Instead of USB, some dongles use Ethernet;
824 older ones may use a PC parallel port, or even a serial port.
825
826 @enumerate
827 @item @emph{Start with power to your target board turned off},
828 and nothing connected to your JTAG adapter.
829 If you're particularly paranoid, unplug power to the board.
830 It's important to have the ground signal properly set up,
831 unless you are using a JTAG adapter which provides
832 galvanic isolation between the target board and the
833 debugging host.
834
835 @item @emph{Be sure it's the right kind of JTAG connector.}
836 If your dongle has a 20-pin ARM connector, you need some kind
837 of adapter (or octopus, see below) to hook it up to
838 boards using 14-pin or 10-pin connectors ... or to 20-pin
839 connectors which don't use ARM's pinout.
840
841 In the same vein, make sure the voltage levels are compatible.
842 Not all JTAG adapters have the level shifters needed to work
843 with 1.2 Volt boards.
844
845 @item @emph{Be certain the cable is properly oriented} or you might
846 damage your board. In most cases there are only two possible
847 ways to connect the cable.
848 Connect the JTAG cable from your adapter to the board.
849 Be sure it's firmly connected.
850
851 In the best case, the connector is keyed to physically
852 prevent you from inserting it wrong.
853 This is most often done using a slot on the board's male connector
854 housing, which must match a key on the JTAG cable's female connector.
855 If there's no housing, then you must look carefully and
856 make sure pin 1 on the cable hooks up to pin 1 on the board.
857 Ribbon cables are frequently all grey except for a wire on one
858 edge, which is red. The red wire is pin 1.
859
860 Sometimes dongles provide cables where one end is an ``octopus'' of
861 color coded single-wire connectors, instead of a connector block.
862 These are great when converting from one JTAG pinout to another,
863 but are tedious to set up.
864 Use these with connector pinout diagrams to help you match up the
865 adapter signals to the right board pins.
866
867 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's other end} once the JTAG cable is connected.
868 A USB, parallel, or serial port connector will go to the host which
869 you are using to run OpenOCD.
870 For Ethernet, consult the documentation and your network administrator.
871
872 For USB-based JTAG adapters you have an easy sanity check at this point:
873 does the host operating system see the JTAG adapter? If you're running
874 Linux, try the @command{lsusb} command. If that host is an
875 MS-Windows host, you'll need to install a driver before OpenOCD works.
876
877 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's power supply, if needed.}
878 This step is primarily for non-USB adapters,
879 but sometimes USB adapters need extra power.
880
881 @item @emph{Power up the target board.}
882 Unless you just let the magic smoke escape,
883 you're now ready to set up the OpenOCD server
884 so you can use JTAG to work with that board.
885
886 @end enumerate
887
888 Talk with the OpenOCD server using
889 telnet (@code{telnet localhost 4444} on many systems) or GDB.
890 @xref{GDB and OpenOCD}.
891
892 @section Project Directory
893
894 There are many ways you can configure OpenOCD and start it up.
895
896 A simple way to organize them all involves keeping a
897 single directory for your work with a given board.
898 When you start OpenOCD from that directory,
899 it searches there first for configuration files, scripts,
900 files accessed through semihosting,
901 and for code you upload to the target board.
902 It is also the natural place to write files,
903 such as log files and data you download from the board.
904
905 @section Configuration Basics
906
907 There are two basic ways of configuring OpenOCD, and
908 a variety of ways you can mix them.
909 Think of the difference as just being how you start the server:
910
911 @itemize
912 @item Many @option{-f file} or @option{-c command} options on the command line
913 @item No options, but a @dfn{user config file}
914 in the current directory named @file{openocd.cfg}
915 @end itemize
916
917 Here is an example @file{openocd.cfg} file for a setup
918 using a Signalyzer FT2232-based JTAG adapter to talk to
919 a board with an Atmel AT91SAM7X256 microcontroller:
920
921 @example
922 source [find interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg]
923
924 # GDB can also flash my flash!
925 gdb_memory_map enable
926 gdb_flash_program enable
927
928 source [find target/sam7x256.cfg]
929 @end example
930
931 Here is the command line equivalent of that configuration:
932
933 @example
934 openocd -f interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg \
935 -c "gdb_memory_map enable" \
936 -c "gdb_flash_program enable" \
937 -f target/sam7x256.cfg
938 @end example
939
940 You could wrap such long command lines in shell scripts,
941 each supporting a different development task.
942 One might re-flash the board with a specific firmware version.
943 Another might set up a particular debugging or run-time environment.
944
945 @quotation Important
946 At this writing (October 2009) the command line method has
947 problems with how it treats variables.
948 For example, after @option{-c "set VAR value"}, or doing the
949 same in a script, the variable @var{VAR} will have no value
950 that can be tested in a later script.
951 @end quotation
952
953 Here we will focus on the simpler solution: one user config
954 file, including basic configuration plus any TCL procedures
955 to simplify your work.
956
957 @section User Config Files
958 @cindex config file, user
959 @cindex user config file
960 @cindex config file, overview
961
962 A user configuration file ties together all the parts of a project
963 in one place.
964 One of the following will match your situation best:
965
966 @itemize
967 @item Ideally almost everything comes from configuration files
968 provided by someone else.
969 For example, OpenOCD distributes a @file{scripts} directory
970 (probably in @file{/usr/share/openocd/scripts} on Linux).
971 Board and tool vendors can provide these too, as can individual
972 user sites; the @option{-s} command line option lets you say
973 where to find these files. (@xref{Running}.)
974 The AT91SAM7X256 example above works this way.
975
976 Three main types of non-user configuration file each have their
977 own subdirectory in the @file{scripts} directory:
978
979 @enumerate
980 @item @b{interface} -- one for each different debug adapter;
981 @item @b{board} -- one for each different board
982 @item @b{target} -- the chips which integrate CPUs and other JTAG TAPs
983 @end enumerate
984
985 Best case: include just two files, and they handle everything else.
986 The first is an interface config file.
987 The second is board-specific, and it sets up the JTAG TAPs and
988 their GDB targets (by deferring to some @file{target.cfg} file),
989 declares all flash memory, and leaves you nothing to do except
990 meet your deadline:
991
992 @example
993 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
994 source [find board/csb337.cfg]
995 @end example
996
997 Boards with a single microcontroller often won't need more
998 than the target config file, as in the AT91SAM7X256 example.
999 That's because there is no external memory (flash, DDR RAM), and
1000 the board differences are encapsulated by application code.
1001
1002 @item Maybe you don't know yet what your board looks like to JTAG.
1003 Once you know the @file{interface.cfg} file to use, you may
1004 need help from OpenOCD to discover what's on the board.
1005 Once you find the JTAG TAPs, you can just search for appropriate
1006 target and board
1007 configuration files ... or write your own, from the bottom up.
1008 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
1009
1010 @item You can often reuse some standard config files but
1011 need to write a few new ones, probably a @file{board.cfg} file.
1012 You will be using commands described later in this User's Guide,
1013 and working with the guidelines in the next chapter.
1014
1015 For example, there may be configuration files for your JTAG adapter
1016 and target chip, but you need a new board-specific config file
1017 giving access to your particular flash chips.
1018 Or you might need to write another target chip configuration file
1019 for a new chip built around the Cortex-M3 core.
1020
1021 @quotation Note
1022 When you write new configuration files, please submit
1023 them for inclusion in the next OpenOCD release.
1024 For example, a @file{board/newboard.cfg} file will help the
1025 next users of that board, and a @file{target/newcpu.cfg}
1026 will help support users of any board using that chip.
1027 @end quotation
1028
1029 @item
1030 You may need to write some C code.
1031 It may be as simple as supporting a new FT2232 or parport
1032 based adapter; a bit more involved, like a NAND or NOR flash
1033 controller driver; or a big piece of work like supporting
1034 a new chip architecture.
1035 @end itemize
1036
1037 Reuse the existing config files when you can.
1038 Look first in the @file{scripts/boards} area, then @file{scripts/targets}.
1039 You may find a board configuration that's a good example to follow.
1040
1041 When you write config files, separate the reusable parts
1042 (things every user of that interface, chip, or board needs)
1043 from ones specific to your environment and debugging approach.
1044 @itemize
1045
1046 @item
1047 For example, a @code{gdb-attach} event handler that invokes
1048 the @command{reset init} command will interfere with debugging
1049 early boot code, which performs some of the same actions
1050 that the @code{reset-init} event handler does.
1051
1052 @item
1053 Likewise, the @command{arm9 vector_catch} command (or
1054 @cindex vector_catch
1055 its siblings @command{xscale vector_catch}
1056 and @command{cortex_m vector_catch}) can be a time-saver
1057 during some debug sessions, but don't make everyone use that either.
1058 Keep those kinds of debugging aids in your user config file,
1059 along with messaging and tracing setup.
1060 (@xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.)
1061
1062 @item
1063 You might need to override some defaults.
1064 For example, you might need to move, shrink, or back up the target's
1065 work area if your application needs much SRAM.
1066
1067 @item
1068 TCP/IP port configuration is another example of something which
1069 is environment-specific, and should only appear in
1070 a user config file. @xref{tcpipports,,TCP/IP Ports}.
1071 @end itemize
1072
1073 @section Project-Specific Utilities
1074
1075 A few project-specific utility
1076 routines may well speed up your work.
1077 Write them, and keep them in your project's user config file.
1078
1079 For example, if you are making a boot loader work on a
1080 board, it's nice to be able to debug the ``after it's
1081 loaded to RAM'' parts separately from the finicky early
1082 code which sets up the DDR RAM controller and clocks.
1083 A script like this one, or a more GDB-aware sibling,
1084 may help:
1085
1086 @example
1087 proc ramboot @{ @} @{
1088 # Reset, running the target's "reset-init" scripts
1089 # to initialize clocks and the DDR RAM controller.
1090 # Leave the CPU halted.
1091 reset init
1092
1093 # Load CONFIG_SKIP_LOWLEVEL_INIT version into DDR RAM.
1094 load_image u-boot.bin 0x20000000
1095
1096 # Start running.
1097 resume 0x20000000
1098 @}
1099 @end example
1100
1101 Then once that code is working you will need to make it
1102 boot from NOR flash; a different utility would help.
1103 Alternatively, some developers write to flash using GDB.
1104 (You might use a similar script if you're working with a flash
1105 based microcontroller application instead of a boot loader.)
1106
1107 @example
1108 proc newboot @{ @} @{
1109 # Reset, leaving the CPU halted. The "reset-init" event
1110 # proc gives faster access to the CPU and to NOR flash;
1111 # "reset halt" would be slower.
1112 reset init
1113
1114 # Write standard version of U-Boot into the first two
1115 # sectors of NOR flash ... the standard version should
1116 # do the same lowlevel init as "reset-init".
1117 flash protect 0 0 1 off
1118 flash erase_sector 0 0 1
1119 flash write_bank 0 u-boot.bin 0x0
1120 flash protect 0 0 1 on
1121
1122 # Reboot from scratch using that new boot loader.
1123 reset run
1124 @}
1125 @end example
1126
1127 You may need more complicated utility procedures when booting
1128 from NAND.
1129 That often involves an extra bootloader stage,
1130 running from on-chip SRAM to perform DDR RAM setup so it can load
1131 the main bootloader code (which won't fit into that SRAM).
1132
1133 Other helper scripts might be used to write production system images,
1134 involving considerably more than just a three stage bootloader.
1135
1136 @section Target Software Changes
1137
1138 Sometimes you may want to make some small changes to the software
1139 you're developing, to help make JTAG debugging work better.
1140 For example, in C or assembly language code you might
1141 use @code{#ifdef JTAG_DEBUG} (or its converse) around code
1142 handling issues like:
1143
1144 @itemize @bullet
1145
1146 @item @b{Watchdog Timers}...
1147 Watchdog timers are typically used to automatically reset systems if
1148 some application task doesn't periodically reset the timer. (The
1149 assumption is that the system has locked up if the task can't run.)
1150 When a JTAG debugger halts the system, that task won't be able to run
1151 and reset the timer ... potentially causing resets in the middle of
1152 your debug sessions.
1153
1154 It's rarely a good idea to disable such watchdogs, since their usage
1155 needs to be debugged just like all other parts of your firmware.
1156 That might however be your only option.
1157
1158 Look instead for chip-specific ways to stop the watchdog from counting
1159 while the system is in a debug halt state. It may be simplest to set
1160 that non-counting mode in your debugger startup scripts. You may however
1161 need a different approach when, for example, a motor could be physically
1162 damaged by firmware remaining inactive in a debug halt state. That might
1163 involve a type of firmware mode where that "non-counting" mode is disabled
1164 at the beginning then re-enabled at the end; a watchdog reset might fire
1165 and complicate the debug session, but hardware (or people) would be
1166 protected.@footnote{Note that many systems support a "monitor mode" debug
1167 that is a somewhat cleaner way to address such issues. You can think of
1168 it as only halting part of the system, maybe just one task,
1169 instead of the whole thing.
1170 At this writing, January 2010, OpenOCD based debugging does not support
1171 monitor mode debug, only "halt mode" debug.}
1172
1173 @item @b{ARM Semihosting}...
1174 @cindex ARM semihosting
1175 When linked with a special runtime library provided with many
1176 toolchains@footnote{See chapter 8 "Semihosting" in
1177 @uref{http://infocenter.arm.com/help/topic/com.arm.doc.dui0203i/DUI0203I_rvct_developer_guide.pdf,
1178 ARM DUI 0203I}, the "RealView Compilation Tools Developer Guide".
1179 The CodeSourcery EABI toolchain also includes a semihosting library.},
1180 your target code can use I/O facilities on the debug host. That library
1181 provides a small set of system calls which are handled by OpenOCD.
1182 It can let the debugger provide your system console and a file system,
1183 helping with early debugging or providing a more capable environment
1184 for sometimes-complex tasks like installing system firmware onto
1185 NAND or SPI flash.
1186
1187 @item @b{ARM Wait-For-Interrupt}...
1188 Many ARM chips synchronize the JTAG clock using the core clock.
1189 Low power states which stop that core clock thus prevent JTAG access.
1190 Idle loops in tasking environments often enter those low power states
1191 via the @code{WFI} instruction (or its coprocessor equivalent, before ARMv7).
1192
1193 You may want to @emph{disable that instruction} in source code,
1194 or otherwise prevent using that state,
1195 to ensure you can get JTAG access at any time.@footnote{As a more
1196 polite alternative, some processors have special debug-oriented
1197 registers which can be used to change various features including
1198 how the low power states are clocked while debugging.
1199 The STM32 DBGMCU_CR register is an example; at the cost of extra
1200 power consumption, JTAG can be used during low power states.}
1201 For example, the OpenOCD @command{halt} command may not
1202 work for an idle processor otherwise.
1203
1204 @item @b{Delay after reset}...
1205 Not all chips have good support for debugger access
1206 right after reset; many LPC2xxx chips have issues here.
1207 Similarly, applications that reconfigure pins used for
1208 JTAG access as they start will also block debugger access.
1209
1210 To work with boards like this, @emph{enable a short delay loop}
1211 the first thing after reset, before "real" startup activities.
1212 For example, one second's delay is usually more than enough
1213 time for a JTAG debugger to attach, so that
1214 early code execution can be debugged
1215 or firmware can be replaced.
1216
1217 @item @b{Debug Communications Channel (DCC)}...
1218 Some processors include mechanisms to send messages over JTAG.
1219 Many ARM cores support these, as do some cores from other vendors.
1220 (OpenOCD may be able to use this DCC internally, speeding up some
1221 operations like writing to memory.)
1222
1223 Your application may want to deliver various debugging messages
1224 over JTAG, by @emph{linking with a small library of code}
1225 provided with OpenOCD and using the utilities there to send
1226 various kinds of message.
1227 @xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.
1228
1229 @end itemize
1230
1231 @section Target Hardware Setup
1232
1233 Chip vendors often provide software development boards which
1234 are highly configurable, so that they can support all options
1235 that product boards may require. @emph{Make sure that any
1236 jumpers or switches match the system configuration you are
1237 working with.}
1238
1239 Common issues include:
1240
1241 @itemize @bullet
1242
1243 @item @b{JTAG setup} ...
1244 Boards may support more than one JTAG configuration.
1245 Examples include jumpers controlling pullups versus pulldowns
1246 on the nTRST and/or nSRST signals, and choice of connectors
1247 (e.g. which of two headers on the base board,
1248 or one from a daughtercard).
1249 For some Texas Instruments boards, you may need to jumper the
1250 EMU0 and EMU1 signals (which OpenOCD won't currently control).
1251
1252 @item @b{Boot Modes} ...
1253 Complex chips often support multiple boot modes, controlled
1254 by external jumpers. Make sure this is set up correctly.
1255 For example many i.MX boards from NXP need to be jumpered
1256 to "ATX mode" to start booting using the on-chip ROM, when
1257 using second stage bootloader code stored in a NAND flash chip.
1258
1259 Such explicit configuration is common, and not limited to
1260 booting from NAND. You might also need to set jumpers to
1261 start booting using code loaded from an MMC/SD card; external
1262 SPI flash; Ethernet, UART, or USB links; NOR flash; OneNAND
1263 flash; some external host; or various other sources.
1264
1265
1266 @item @b{Memory Addressing} ...
1267 Boards which support multiple boot modes may also have jumpers
1268 to configure memory addressing. One board, for example, jumpers
1269 external chipselect 0 (used for booting) to address either
1270 a large SRAM (which must be pre-loaded via JTAG), NOR flash,
1271 or NAND flash. When it's jumpered to address NAND flash, that
1272 board must also be told to start booting from on-chip ROM.
1273
1274 Your @file{board.cfg} file may also need to be told this jumper
1275 configuration, so that it can know whether to declare NOR flash
1276 using @command{flash bank} or instead declare NAND flash with
1277 @command{nand device}; and likewise which probe to perform in
1278 its @code{reset-init} handler.
1279
1280 A closely related issue is bus width. Jumpers might need to
1281 distinguish between 8 bit or 16 bit bus access for the flash
1282 used to start booting.
1283
1284 @item @b{Peripheral Access} ...
1285 Development boards generally provide access to every peripheral
1286 on the chip, sometimes in multiple modes (such as by providing
1287 multiple audio codec chips).
1288 This interacts with software
1289 configuration of pin multiplexing, where for example a
1290 given pin may be routed either to the MMC/SD controller
1291 or the GPIO controller. It also often interacts with
1292 configuration jumpers. One jumper may be used to route
1293 signals to an MMC/SD card slot or an expansion bus (which
1294 might in turn affect booting); others might control which
1295 audio or video codecs are used.
1296
1297 @end itemize
1298
1299 Plus you should of course have @code{reset-init} event handlers
1300 which set up the hardware to match that jumper configuration.
1301 That includes in particular any oscillator or PLL used to clock
1302 the CPU, and any memory controllers needed to access external
1303 memory and peripherals. Without such handlers, you won't be
1304 able to access those resources without working target firmware
1305 which can do that setup ... this can be awkward when you're
1306 trying to debug that target firmware. Even if there's a ROM
1307 bootloader which handles a few issues, it rarely provides full
1308 access to all board-specific capabilities.
1309
1310
1311 @node Config File Guidelines
1312 @chapter Config File Guidelines
1313
1314 This chapter is aimed at any user who needs to write a config file,
1315 including developers and integrators of OpenOCD and any user who
1316 needs to get a new board working smoothly.
1317 It provides guidelines for creating those files.
1318
1319 You should find the following directories under
1320 @t{$(INSTALLDIR)/scripts}, with config files maintained upstream. Use
1321 them as-is where you can; or as models for new files.
1322 @itemize @bullet
1323 @item @file{interface} ...
1324 These are for debug adapters. Files that specify configuration to use
1325 specific JTAG, SWD and other adapters go here.
1326 @item @file{board} ...
1327 Think Circuit Board, PWA, PCB, they go by many names. Board files
1328 contain initialization items that are specific to a board.
1329
1330 They reuse target configuration files, since the same
1331 microprocessor chips are used on many boards,
1332 but support for external parts varies widely. For
1333 example, the SDRAM initialization sequence for the board, or the type
1334 of external flash and what address it uses. Any initialization
1335 sequence to enable that external flash or SDRAM should be found in the
1336 board file. Boards may also contain multiple targets: two CPUs; or
1337 a CPU and an FPGA.
1338 @item @file{target} ...
1339 Think chip. The ``target'' directory represents the JTAG TAPs
1340 on a chip
1341 which OpenOCD should control, not a board. Two common types of targets
1342 are ARM chips and FPGA or CPLD chips.
1343 When a chip has multiple TAPs (maybe it has both ARM and DSP cores),
1344 the target config file defines all of them.
1345 @item @emph{more} ... browse for other library files which may be useful.
1346 For example, there are various generic and CPU-specific utilities.
1347 @end itemize
1348
1349 The @file{openocd.cfg} user config
1350 file may override features in any of the above files by
1351 setting variables before sourcing the target file, or by adding
1352 commands specific to their situation.
1353
1354 @section Interface Config Files
1355
1356 The user config file
1357 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1358
1359 @example
1360 source [find interface/FOOBAR.cfg]
1361 @end example
1362
1363 A preconfigured interface file should exist for every debug adapter
1364 in use today with OpenOCD.
1365 That said, perhaps some of these config files
1366 have only been used by the developer who created it.
1367
1368 A separate chapter gives information about how to set these up.
1369 @xref{Debug Adapter Configuration}.
1370 Read the OpenOCD source code (and Developer's Guide)
1371 if you have a new kind of hardware interface
1372 and need to provide a driver for it.
1373
1374 @deffn {Command} {find} 'filename'
1375 Prints full path to @var{filename} according to OpenOCD search rules.
1376 @end deffn
1377
1378 @deffn {Command} {ocd_find} 'filename'
1379 Prints full path to @var{filename} according to OpenOCD search rules. This
1380 is a low level function used by the @command{find}. Usually you want
1381 to use @command{find}, instead.
1382 @end deffn
1383
1384 @section Board Config Files
1385 @cindex config file, board
1386 @cindex board config file
1387
1388 The user config file
1389 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1390
1391 @example
1392 source [find board/FOOBAR.cfg]
1393 @end example
1394
1395 The point of a board config file is to package everything
1396 about a given board that user config files need to know.
1397 In summary the board files should contain (if present)
1398
1399 @enumerate
1400 @item One or more @command{source [find target/...cfg]} statements
1401 @item NOR flash configuration (@pxref{norconfiguration,,NOR Configuration})
1402 @item NAND flash configuration (@pxref{nandconfiguration,,NAND Configuration})
1403 @item Target @code{reset} handlers for SDRAM and I/O configuration
1404 @item JTAG adapter reset configuration (@pxref{Reset Configuration})
1405 @item All things that are not ``inside a chip''
1406 @end enumerate
1407
1408 Generic things inside target chips belong in target config files,
1409 not board config files. So for example a @code{reset-init} event
1410 handler should know board-specific oscillator and PLL parameters,
1411 which it passes to target-specific utility code.
1412
1413 The most complex task of a board config file is creating such a
1414 @code{reset-init} event handler.
1415 Define those handlers last, after you verify the rest of the board
1416 configuration works.
1417
1418 @subsection Communication Between Config files
1419
1420 In addition to target-specific utility code, another way that
1421 board and target config files communicate is by following a
1422 convention on how to use certain variables.
1423
1424 The full Tcl/Tk language supports ``namespaces'', but Jim-Tcl does not.
1425 Thus the rule we follow in OpenOCD is this: Variables that begin with
1426 a leading underscore are temporary in nature, and can be modified and
1427 used at will within a target configuration file.
1428
1429 Complex board config files can do the things like this,
1430 for a board with three chips:
1431
1432 @example
1433 # Chip #1: PXA270 for network side, big endian
1434 set CHIPNAME network
1435 set ENDIAN big
1436 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1437 # on return: _TARGETNAME = network.cpu
1438 # other commands can refer to the "network.cpu" target.
1439 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1440
1441 # Chip #2: PXA270 for video side, little endian
1442 set CHIPNAME video
1443 set ENDIAN little
1444 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1445 # on return: _TARGETNAME = video.cpu
1446 # other commands can refer to the "video.cpu" target.
1447 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1448
1449 # Chip #3: Xilinx FPGA for glue logic
1450 set CHIPNAME xilinx
1451 unset ENDIAN
1452 source [find target/spartan3.cfg]
1453 @end example
1454
1455 That example is oversimplified because it doesn't show any flash memory,
1456 or the @code{reset-init} event handlers to initialize external DRAM
1457 or (assuming it needs it) load a configuration into the FPGA.
1458 Such features are usually needed for low-level work with many boards,
1459 where ``low level'' implies that the board initialization software may
1460 not be working. (That's a common reason to need JTAG tools. Another
1461 is to enable working with microcontroller-based systems, which often
1462 have no debugging support except a JTAG connector.)
1463
1464 Target config files may also export utility functions to board and user
1465 config files. Such functions should use name prefixes, to help avoid
1466 naming collisions.
1467
1468 Board files could also accept input variables from user config files.
1469 For example, there might be a @code{J4_JUMPER} setting used to identify
1470 what kind of flash memory a development board is using, or how to set
1471 up other clocks and peripherals.
1472
1473 @subsection Variable Naming Convention
1474 @cindex variable names
1475
1476 Most boards have only one instance of a chip.
1477 However, it should be easy to create a board with more than
1478 one such chip (as shown above).
1479 Accordingly, we encourage these conventions for naming
1480 variables associated with different @file{target.cfg} files,
1481 to promote consistency and
1482 so that board files can override target defaults.
1483
1484 Inputs to target config files include:
1485
1486 @itemize @bullet
1487 @item @code{CHIPNAME} ...
1488 This gives a name to the overall chip, and is used as part of
1489 tap identifier dotted names.
1490 While the default is normally provided by the chip manufacturer,
1491 board files may need to distinguish between instances of a chip.
1492 @item @code{ENDIAN} ...
1493 By default @option{little} - although chips may hard-wire @option{big}.
1494 Chips that can't change endianness don't need to use this variable.
1495 @item @code{CPUTAPID} ...
1496 When OpenOCD examines the JTAG chain, it can be told verify the
1497 chips against the JTAG IDCODE register.
1498 The target file will hold one or more defaults, but sometimes the
1499 chip in a board will use a different ID (perhaps a newer revision).
1500 @end itemize
1501
1502 Outputs from target config files include:
1503
1504 @itemize @bullet
1505 @item @code{_TARGETNAME} ...
1506 By convention, this variable is created by the target configuration
1507 script. The board configuration file may make use of this variable to
1508 configure things like a ``reset init'' script, or other things
1509 specific to that board and that target.
1510 If the chip has 2 targets, the names are @code{_TARGETNAME0},
1511 @code{_TARGETNAME1}, ... etc.
1512 @end itemize
1513
1514 @subsection The reset-init Event Handler
1515 @cindex event, reset-init
1516 @cindex reset-init handler
1517
1518 Board config files run in the OpenOCD configuration stage;
1519 they can't use TAPs or targets, since they haven't been
1520 fully set up yet.
1521 This means you can't write memory or access chip registers;
1522 you can't even verify that a flash chip is present.
1523 That's done later in event handlers, of which the target @code{reset-init}
1524 handler is one of the most important.
1525
1526 Except on microcontrollers, the basic job of @code{reset-init} event
1527 handlers is setting up flash and DRAM, as normally handled by boot loaders.
1528 Microcontrollers rarely use boot loaders; they run right out of their
1529 on-chip flash and SRAM memory. But they may want to use one of these
1530 handlers too, if just for developer convenience.
1531
1532 @quotation Note
1533 Because this is so very board-specific, and chip-specific, no examples
1534 are included here.
1535 Instead, look at the board config files distributed with OpenOCD.
1536 If you have a boot loader, its source code will help; so will
1537 configuration files for other JTAG tools
1538 (@pxref{translatingconfigurationfiles,,Translating Configuration Files}).
1539 @end quotation
1540
1541 Some of this code could probably be shared between different boards.
1542 For example, setting up a DRAM controller often doesn't differ by
1543 much except the bus width (16 bits or 32?) and memory timings, so a
1544 reusable TCL procedure loaded by the @file{target.cfg} file might take
1545 those as parameters.
1546 Similarly with oscillator, PLL, and clock setup;
1547 and disabling the watchdog.
1548 Structure the code cleanly, and provide comments to help
1549 the next developer doing such work.
1550 (@emph{You might be that next person} trying to reuse init code!)
1551
1552 The last thing normally done in a @code{reset-init} handler is probing
1553 whatever flash memory was configured. For most chips that needs to be
1554 done while the associated target is halted, either because JTAG memory
1555 access uses the CPU or to prevent conflicting CPU access.
1556
1557 @subsection JTAG Clock Rate
1558
1559 Before your @code{reset-init} handler has set up
1560 the PLLs and clocking, you may need to run with
1561 a low JTAG clock rate.
1562 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1563 Then you'd increase that rate after your handler has
1564 made it possible to use the faster JTAG clock.
1565 When the initial low speed is board-specific, for example
1566 because it depends on a board-specific oscillator speed, then
1567 you should probably set it up in the board config file;
1568 if it's target-specific, it belongs in the target config file.
1569
1570 For most ARM-based processors the fastest JTAG clock@footnote{A FAQ
1571 @uref{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} gives details.}
1572 is one sixth of the CPU clock; or one eighth for ARM11 cores.
1573 Consult chip documentation to determine the peak JTAG clock rate,
1574 which might be less than that.
1575
1576 @quotation Warning
1577 On most ARMs, JTAG clock detection is coupled to the core clock, so
1578 software using a @option{wait for interrupt} operation blocks JTAG access.
1579 Adaptive clocking provides a partial workaround, but a more complete
1580 solution just avoids using that instruction with JTAG debuggers.
1581 @end quotation
1582
1583 If both the chip and the board support adaptive clocking,
1584 use the @command{jtag_rclk}
1585 command, in case your board is used with JTAG adapter which
1586 also supports it. Otherwise use @command{adapter speed}.
1587 Set the slow rate at the beginning of the reset sequence,
1588 and the faster rate as soon as the clocks are at full speed.
1589
1590 @anchor{theinitboardprocedure}
1591 @subsection The init_board procedure
1592 @cindex init_board procedure
1593
1594 The concept of @code{init_board} procedure is very similar to @code{init_targets}
1595 (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets procedure}.) - it's a replacement of ``linear''
1596 configuration scripts. This procedure is meant to be executed when OpenOCD enters run stage
1597 (@xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage},) after @code{init_targets}. The idea to have
1598 separate @code{init_targets} and @code{init_board} procedures is to allow the first one to configure
1599 everything target specific (internal flash, internal RAM, etc.) and the second one to configure
1600 everything board specific (reset signals, chip frequency, reset-init event handler, external memory, etc.).
1601 Additionally ``linear'' board config file will most likely fail when target config file uses
1602 @code{init_targets} scheme (``linear'' script is executed before @code{init} and @code{init_targets} - after),
1603 so separating these two configuration stages is very convenient, as the easiest way to overcome this
1604 problem is to convert board config file to use @code{init_board} procedure. Board config scripts don't
1605 need to override @code{init_targets} defined in target config files when they only need to add some specifics.
1606
1607 Just as @code{init_targets}, the @code{init_board} procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources
1608 the original), allowing greater code reuse.
1609
1610 @example
1611 ### board_file.cfg ###
1612
1613 # source target file that does most of the config in init_targets
1614 source [find target/target.cfg]
1615
1616 proc enable_fast_clock @{@} @{
1617 # enables fast on-board clock source
1618 # configures the chip to use it
1619 @}
1620
1621 # initialize only board specifics - reset, clock, adapter frequency
1622 proc init_board @{@} @{
1623 reset_config trst_and_srst trst_pulls_srst
1624
1625 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-start @{
1626 adapter speed 100
1627 @}
1628
1629 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-init @{
1630 enable_fast_clock
1631 adapter speed 10000
1632 @}
1633 @}
1634 @end example
1635
1636 @section Target Config Files
1637 @cindex config file, target
1638 @cindex target config file
1639
1640 Board config files communicate with target config files using
1641 naming conventions as described above, and may source one or
1642 more target config files like this:
1643
1644 @example
1645 source [find target/FOOBAR.cfg]
1646 @end example
1647
1648 The point of a target config file is to package everything
1649 about a given chip that board config files need to know.
1650 In summary the target files should contain
1651
1652 @enumerate
1653 @item Set defaults
1654 @item Add TAPs to the scan chain
1655 @item Add CPU targets (includes GDB support)
1656 @item CPU/Chip/CPU-Core specific features
1657 @item On-Chip flash
1658 @end enumerate
1659
1660 As a rule of thumb, a target file sets up only one chip.
1661 For a microcontroller, that will often include a single TAP,
1662 which is a CPU needing a GDB target, and its on-chip flash.
1663
1664 More complex chips may include multiple TAPs, and the target
1665 config file may need to define them all before OpenOCD
1666 can talk to the chip.
1667 For example, some phone chips have JTAG scan chains that include
1668 an ARM core for operating system use, a DSP,
1669 another ARM core embedded in an image processing engine,
1670 and other processing engines.
1671
1672 @subsection Default Value Boiler Plate Code
1673
1674 All target configuration files should start with code like this,
1675 letting board config files express environment-specific
1676 differences in how things should be set up.
1677
1678 @example
1679 # Boards may override chip names, perhaps based on role,
1680 # but the default should match what the vendor uses
1681 if @{ [info exists CHIPNAME] @} @{
1682 set _CHIPNAME $CHIPNAME
1683 @} else @{
1684 set _CHIPNAME sam7x256
1685 @}
1686
1687 # ONLY use ENDIAN with targets that can change it.
1688 if @{ [info exists ENDIAN] @} @{
1689 set _ENDIAN $ENDIAN
1690 @} else @{
1691 set _ENDIAN little
1692 @}
1693
1694 # TAP identifiers may change as chips mature, for example with
1695 # new revision fields (the "3" here). Pick a good default; you
1696 # can pass several such identifiers to the "jtag newtap" command.
1697 if @{ [info exists CPUTAPID ] @} @{
1698 set _CPUTAPID $CPUTAPID
1699 @} else @{
1700 set _CPUTAPID 0x3f0f0f0f
1701 @}
1702 @end example
1703 @c but 0x3f0f0f0f is for an str73x part ...
1704
1705 @emph{Remember:} Board config files may include multiple target
1706 config files, or the same target file multiple times
1707 (changing at least @code{CHIPNAME}).
1708
1709 Likewise, the target configuration file should define
1710 @code{_TARGETNAME} (or @code{_TARGETNAME0} etc) and
1711 use it later on when defining debug targets:
1712
1713 @example
1714 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1715 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1716 @end example
1717
1718 @subsection Adding TAPs to the Scan Chain
1719 After the ``defaults'' are set up,
1720 add the TAPs on each chip to the JTAG scan chain.
1721 @xref{TAP Declaration}, and the naming convention
1722 for taps.
1723
1724 In the simplest case the chip has only one TAP,
1725 probably for a CPU or FPGA.
1726 The config file for the Atmel AT91SAM7X256
1727 looks (in part) like this:
1728
1729 @example
1730 jtag newtap $_CHIPNAME cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id $_CPUTAPID
1731 @end example
1732
1733 A board with two such at91sam7 chips would be able
1734 to source such a config file twice, with different
1735 values for @code{CHIPNAME}, so
1736 it adds a different TAP each time.
1737
1738 If there are nonzero @option{-expected-id} values,
1739 OpenOCD attempts to verify the actual tap id against those values.
1740 It will issue error messages if there is mismatch, which
1741 can help to pinpoint problems in OpenOCD configurations.
1742
1743 @example
1744 JTAG tap: sam7x256.cpu tap/device found: 0x3f0f0f0f
1745 (Manufacturer: 0x787, Part: 0xf0f0, Version: 0x3)
1746 ERROR: Tap: sam7x256.cpu - Expected id: 0x12345678, Got: 0x3f0f0f0f
1747 ERROR: expected: mfg: 0x33c, part: 0x2345, ver: 0x1
1748 ERROR: got: mfg: 0x787, part: 0xf0f0, ver: 0x3
1749 @end example
1750
1751 There are more complex examples too, with chips that have
1752 multiple TAPs. Ones worth looking at include:
1753
1754 @itemize
1755 @item @file{target/omap3530.cfg} -- with disabled ARM and DSP,
1756 plus a JRC to enable them
1757 @item @file{target/str912.cfg} -- with flash, CPU, and boundary scan
1758 @item @file{target/ti_dm355.cfg} -- with ETM, ARM, and JRC (this JRC
1759 is not currently used)
1760 @end itemize
1761
1762 @subsection Add CPU targets
1763
1764 After adding a TAP for a CPU, you should set it up so that
1765 GDB and other commands can use it.
1766 @xref{CPU Configuration}.
1767 For the at91sam7 example above, the command can look like this;
1768 note that @code{$_ENDIAN} is not needed, since OpenOCD defaults
1769 to little endian, and this chip doesn't support changing that.
1770
1771 @example
1772 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1773 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1774 @end example
1775
1776 Work areas are small RAM areas associated with CPU targets.
1777 They are used by OpenOCD to speed up downloads,
1778 and to download small snippets of code to program flash chips.
1779 If the chip includes a form of ``on-chip-ram'' - and many do - define
1780 a work area if you can.
1781 Again using the at91sam7 as an example, this can look like:
1782
1783 @example
1784 $_TARGETNAME configure -work-area-phys 0x00200000 \
1785 -work-area-size 0x4000 -work-area-backup 0
1786 @end example
1787
1788 @anchor{definecputargetsworkinginsmp}
1789 @subsection Define CPU targets working in SMP
1790 @cindex SMP
1791 After setting targets, you can define a list of targets working in SMP.
1792
1793 @example
1794 set _TARGETNAME_1 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1795 set _TARGETNAME_2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu2
1796 target create $_TARGETNAME_1 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1797 -coreid 0 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG1
1798 target create $_TARGETNAME_2 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1799 -coreid 1 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG2
1800 #define 2 targets working in smp.
1801 target smp $_CHIPNAME.cpu2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1802 @end example
1803 In the above example on cortex_a, 2 cpus are working in SMP.
1804 In SMP only one GDB instance is created and :
1805 @itemize @bullet
1806 @item a set of hardware breakpoint sets the same breakpoint on all targets in the list.
1807 @item halt command triggers the halt of all targets in the list.
1808 @item resume command triggers the write context and the restart of all targets in the list.
1809 @item following a breakpoint: the target stopped by the breakpoint is displayed to the GDB session.
1810 @item dedicated GDB serial protocol packets are implemented for switching/retrieving the target
1811 displayed by the GDB session @pxref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.
1812 @end itemize
1813
1814 The SMP behaviour can be disabled/enabled dynamically. On cortex_a following
1815 command have been implemented.
1816 @itemize @bullet
1817 @item cortex_a smp on : enable SMP mode, behaviour is as described above.
1818 @item cortex_a smp off : disable SMP mode, the current target is the one
1819 displayed in the GDB session, only this target is now controlled by GDB
1820 session. This behaviour is useful during system boot up.
1821 @item cortex_a smp : display current SMP mode.
1822 @item cortex_a smp_gdb : display/fix the core id displayed in GDB session see
1823 following example.
1824 @end itemize
1825
1826 @example
1827 >cortex_a smp_gdb
1828 gdb coreid 0 -> -1
1829 #0 : coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1830 #-> -1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1831 > cortex_a smp_gdb 1
1832 gdb coreid 0 -> 1
1833 #0 :coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1834 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1835 > resume
1836 > cortex_a smp_gdb
1837 gdb coreid 1 -> 1
1838 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB ,
1839 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1840 > cortex_a smp_gdb -1
1841 gdb coreid 1 -> -1
1842 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB,
1843 #->-1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1844 @end example
1845
1846
1847 @subsection Chip Reset Setup
1848
1849 As a rule, you should put the @command{reset_config} command
1850 into the board file. Most things you think you know about a
1851 chip can be tweaked by the board.
1852
1853 Some chips have specific ways the TRST and SRST signals are
1854 managed. In the unusual case that these are @emph{chip specific}
1855 and can never be changed by board wiring, they could go here.
1856 For example, some chips can't support JTAG debugging without
1857 both signals.
1858
1859 Provide a @code{reset-assert} event handler if you can.
1860 Such a handler uses JTAG operations to reset the target,
1861 letting this target config be used in systems which don't
1862 provide the optional SRST signal, or on systems where you
1863 don't want to reset all targets at once.
1864 Such a handler might write to chip registers to force a reset,
1865 use a JRC to do that (preferable -- the target may be wedged!),
1866 or force a watchdog timer to trigger.
1867 (For Cortex-M targets, this is not necessary. The target
1868 driver knows how to use trigger an NVIC reset when SRST is
1869 not available.)
1870
1871 Some chips need special attention during reset handling if
1872 they're going to be used with JTAG.
1873 An example might be needing to send some commands right
1874 after the target's TAP has been reset, providing a
1875 @code{reset-deassert-post} event handler that writes a chip
1876 register to report that JTAG debugging is being done.
1877 Another would be reconfiguring the watchdog so that it stops
1878 counting while the core is halted in the debugger.
1879
1880 JTAG clocking constraints often change during reset, and in
1881 some cases target config files (rather than board config files)
1882 are the right places to handle some of those issues.
1883 For example, immediately after reset most chips run using a
1884 slower clock than they will use later.
1885 That means that after reset (and potentially, as OpenOCD
1886 first starts up) they must use a slower JTAG clock rate
1887 than they will use later.
1888 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1889
1890 @quotation Important
1891 When you are debugging code that runs right after chip
1892 reset, getting these issues right is critical.
1893 In particular, if you see intermittent failures when
1894 OpenOCD verifies the scan chain after reset,
1895 look at how you are setting up JTAG clocking.
1896 @end quotation
1897
1898 @anchor{theinittargetsprocedure}
1899 @subsection The init_targets procedure
1900 @cindex init_targets procedure
1901
1902 Target config files can either be ``linear'' (script executed line-by-line when parsed in
1903 configuration stage, @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage},) or they can contain a special
1904 procedure called @code{init_targets}, which will be executed when entering run stage
1905 (after parsing all config files or after @code{init} command, @xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage}.)
1906 Such procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources the original).
1907 This concept facilitates code reuse when basic target config files provide generic configuration
1908 procedures and @code{init_targets} procedure, which can then be sourced and enhanced or changed in
1909 a ``more specific'' target config file. This is not possible with ``linear'' config scripts,
1910 because sourcing them executes every initialization commands they provide.
1911
1912 @example
1913 ### generic_file.cfg ###
1914
1915 proc setup_my_chip @{chip_name flash_size ram_size@} @{
1916 # basic initialization procedure ...
1917 @}
1918
1919 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1920 # initializes generic chip with 4kB of flash and 1kB of RAM
1921 setup_my_chip MY_GENERIC_CHIP 4096 1024
1922 @}
1923
1924 ### specific_file.cfg ###
1925
1926 source [find target/generic_file.cfg]
1927
1928 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1929 # initializes specific chip with 128kB of flash and 64kB of RAM
1930 setup_my_chip MY_CHIP_WITH_128K_FLASH_64KB_RAM 131072 65536
1931 @}
1932 @end example
1933
1934 The easiest way to convert ``linear'' config files to @code{init_targets} version is to
1935 enclose every line of ``code'' (i.e. not @code{source} commands, procedures, etc.) in this procedure.
1936
1937 For an example of this scheme see LPC2000 target config files.
1938
1939 The @code{init_boards} procedure is a similar concept concerning board config files
1940 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.)
1941
1942 @anchor{theinittargeteventsprocedure}
1943 @subsection The init_target_events procedure
1944 @cindex init_target_events procedure
1945
1946 A special procedure called @code{init_target_events} is run just after
1947 @code{init_targets} (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets
1948 procedure}.) and before @code{init_board}
1949 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.) It is used
1950 to set up default target events for the targets that do not have those
1951 events already assigned.
1952
1953 @subsection ARM Core Specific Hacks
1954
1955 If the chip has a DCC, enable it. If the chip is an ARM9 with some
1956 special high speed download features - enable it.
1957
1958 If present, the MMU, the MPU and the CACHE should be disabled.
1959
1960 Some ARM cores are equipped with trace support, which permits
1961 examination of the instruction and data bus activity. Trace
1962 activity is controlled through an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM)
1963 on one of the core's scan chains. The ETM emits voluminous data
1964 through a ``trace port''. (@xref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.)
1965 If you are using an external trace port,
1966 configure it in your board config file.
1967 If you are using an on-chip ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB),
1968 configure it in your target config file.
1969
1970 @example
1971 etm config $_TARGETNAME 16 normal full etb
1972 etb config $_TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.etb
1973 @end example
1974
1975 @subsection Internal Flash Configuration
1976
1977 This applies @b{ONLY TO MICROCONTROLLERS} that have flash built in.
1978
1979 @b{Never ever} in the ``target configuration file'' define any type of
1980 flash that is external to the chip. (For example a BOOT flash on
1981 Chip Select 0.) Such flash information goes in a board file - not
1982 the TARGET (chip) file.
1983
1984 Examples:
1985 @itemize @bullet
1986 @item at91sam7x256 - has 256K flash YES enable it.
1987 @item str912 - has flash internal YES enable it.
1988 @item imx27 - uses boot flash on CS0 - it goes in the board file.
1989 @item pxa270 - again - CS0 flash - it goes in the board file.
1990 @end itemize
1991
1992 @anchor{translatingconfigurationfiles}
1993 @section Translating Configuration Files
1994 @cindex translation
1995 If you have a configuration file for another hardware debugger
1996 or toolset (Abatron, BDI2000, BDI3000, CCS,
1997 Lauterbach, SEGGER, Macraigor, etc.), translating
1998 it into OpenOCD syntax is often quite straightforward. The most tricky
1999 part of creating a configuration script is oftentimes the reset init
2000 sequence where e.g. PLLs, DRAM and the like is set up.
2001
2002 One trick that you can use when translating is to write small
2003 Tcl procedures to translate the syntax into OpenOCD syntax. This
2004 can avoid manual translation errors and make it easier to
2005 convert other scripts later on.
2006
2007 Example of transforming quirky arguments to a simple search and
2008 replace job:
2009
2010 @example
2011 # Lauterbach syntax(?)
2012 #
2013 # Data.Set c15:0x042f %long 0x40000015
2014 #
2015 # OpenOCD syntax when using procedure below.
2016 #
2017 # setc15 0x01 0x00050078
2018
2019 proc setc15 @{regs value@} @{
2020 global TARGETNAME
2021
2022 echo [format "set p15 0x%04x, 0x%08x" $regs $value]
2023
2024 arm mcr 15 [expr @{($regs >> 12) & 0x7@}] \
2025 [expr @{($regs >> 0) & 0xf@}] [expr @{($regs >> 4) & 0xf@}] \
2026 [expr @{($regs >> 8) & 0x7@}] $value
2027 @}
2028 @end example
2029
2030
2031
2032 @node Server Configuration
2033 @chapter Server Configuration
2034 @cindex initialization
2035 The commands here are commonly found in the openocd.cfg file and are
2036 used to specify what TCP/IP ports are used, and how GDB should be
2037 supported.
2038
2039 @anchor{configurationstage}
2040 @section Configuration Stage
2041 @cindex configuration stage
2042 @cindex config command
2043
2044 When the OpenOCD server process starts up, it enters a
2045 @emph{configuration stage} which is the only time that
2046 certain commands, @emph{configuration commands}, may be issued.
2047 Normally, configuration commands are only available
2048 inside startup scripts.
2049
2050 In this manual, the definition of a configuration command is
2051 presented as a @emph{Config Command}, not as a @emph{Command}
2052 which may be issued interactively.
2053 The runtime @command{help} command also highlights configuration
2054 commands, and those which may be issued at any time.
2055
2056 Those configuration commands include declaration of TAPs,
2057 flash banks,
2058 the interface used for JTAG communication,
2059 and other basic setup.
2060 The server must leave the configuration stage before it
2061 may access or activate TAPs.
2062 After it leaves this stage, configuration commands may no
2063 longer be issued.
2064
2065 @deffn {Command} {command mode} [command_name]
2066 Returns the command modes allowed by a command: 'any', 'config', or
2067 'exec'. If no command is specified, returns the current command
2068 mode. Returns 'unknown' if an unknown command is given. Command can be
2069 multiple tokens. (command valid any time)
2070
2071 In this document, the modes are described as stages, 'config' and
2072 'exec' mode correspond configuration stage and run stage. 'any' means
2073 the command can be executed in either
2074 stages. @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage}, and
2075 @xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage}.
2076 @end deffn
2077
2078 @anchor{enteringtherunstage}
2079 @section Entering the Run Stage
2080
2081 The first thing OpenOCD does after leaving the configuration
2082 stage is to verify that it can talk to the scan chain
2083 (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2084 It will warn if it doesn't find TAPs it expects to find,
2085 or finds TAPs that aren't supposed to be there.
2086 You should see no errors at this point.
2087 If you see errors, resolve them by correcting the
2088 commands you used to configure the server.
2089 Common errors include using an initial JTAG speed that's too
2090 fast, and not providing the right IDCODE values for the TAPs
2091 on the scan chain.
2092
2093 Once OpenOCD has entered the run stage, a number of commands
2094 become available.
2095 A number of these relate to the debug targets you may have declared.
2096 For example, the @command{mww} command will not be available until
2097 a target has been successfully instantiated.
2098 If you want to use those commands, you may need to force
2099 entry to the run stage.
2100
2101 @deffn {Config Command} {init}
2102 This command terminates the configuration stage and
2103 enters the run stage. This helps when you need to have
2104 the startup scripts manage tasks such as resetting the target,
2105 programming flash, etc. To reset the CPU upon startup, add "init" and
2106 "reset" at the end of the config script or at the end of the OpenOCD
2107 command line using the @option{-c} command line switch.
2108
2109 If this command does not appear in any startup/configuration file
2110 OpenOCD executes the command for you after processing all
2111 configuration files and/or command line options.
2112
2113 @b{NOTE:} This command normally occurs near the end of your
2114 openocd.cfg file to force OpenOCD to ``initialize'' and make the
2115 targets ready. For example: If your openocd.cfg file needs to
2116 read/write memory on your target, @command{init} must occur before
2117 the memory read/write commands. This includes @command{nand probe}.
2118
2119 @command{init} calls the following internal OpenOCD commands to initialize
2120 corresponding subsystems:
2121 @deffn {Config Command} {target init}
2122 @deffnx {Command} {transport init}
2123 @deffnx {Command} {dap init}
2124 @deffnx {Config Command} {flash init}
2125 @deffnx {Config Command} {nand init}
2126 @deffnx {Config Command} {pld init}
2127 @deffnx {Command} {tpiu init}
2128 @end deffn
2129
2130 At last, @command{init} executes all the commands that are specified in
2131 the TCL list @var{post_init_commands}. The commands are executed in the
2132 same order they occupy in the list. If one of the commands fails, then
2133 the error is propagated and OpenOCD fails too.
2134 @example
2135 lappend post_init_commands @{echo "OpenOCD successfully initialized."@}
2136 lappend post_init_commands @{echo "Have fun with OpenOCD !"@}
2137 @end example
2138 @end deffn
2139
2140 @deffn {Config Command} {noinit}
2141 Prevent OpenOCD from implicit @command{init} call at the end of startup.
2142 Allows issuing configuration commands over telnet or Tcl connection.
2143 When you are done with configuration use @command{init} to enter
2144 the run stage.
2145 @end deffn
2146
2147 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} {jtag_init}
2148 This is invoked at server startup to verify that it can talk
2149 to the scan chain (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2150
2151 The default implementation first tries @command{jtag arp_init},
2152 which uses only a lightweight JTAG reset before examining the
2153 scan chain.
2154 If that fails, it tries again, using a harder reset
2155 from the overridable procedure @command{init_reset}.
2156
2157 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
2158 they return.
2159 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
2160 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
2161 @end deffn
2162
2163 @anchor{tcpipports}
2164 @section TCP/IP Ports
2165 @cindex TCP port
2166 @cindex server
2167 @cindex port
2168 @cindex security
2169 The OpenOCD server accepts remote commands in several syntaxes.
2170 Each syntax uses a different TCP/IP port, which you may specify
2171 only during configuration (before those ports are opened).
2172
2173 For reasons including security, you may wish to prevent remote
2174 access using one or more of these ports.
2175 In such cases, just specify the relevant port number as "disabled".
2176 If you disable all access through TCP/IP, you will need to
2177 use the command line @option{-pipe} option.
2178
2179 @anchor{gdb_port}
2180 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_port} [number]
2181 @cindex GDB server
2182 Normally gdb listens to a TCP/IP port, but GDB can also
2183 communicate via pipes(stdin/out or named pipes). The name
2184 "gdb_port" stuck because it covers probably more than 90% of
2185 the normal use cases.
2186
2187 No arguments reports GDB port. "pipe" means listen to stdin
2188 output to stdout, an integer is base port number, "disabled"
2189 disables the gdb server.
2190
2191 When using "pipe", also use log_output to redirect the log
2192 output to a file so as not to flood the stdin/out pipes.
2193
2194 Any other string is interpreted as named pipe to listen to.
2195 Output pipe is the same name as input pipe, but with 'o' appended,
2196 e.g. /var/gdb, /var/gdbo.
2197
2198 The GDB port for the first target will be the base port, the
2199 second target will listen on gdb_port + 1, and so on.
2200 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2201 the port @var{number} defaults to 3333.
2202 When @var{number} is not a numeric value, incrementing it to compute
2203 the next port number does not work. In this case, specify the proper
2204 @var{number} for each target by using the option @code{-gdb-port} of the
2205 commands @command{target create} or @command{$target_name configure}.
2206 @xref{gdbportoverride,,option -gdb-port}.
2207
2208 Note: when using "gdb_port pipe", increasing the default remote timeout in
2209 gdb (with 'set remotetimeout') is recommended. An insufficient timeout may
2210 cause initialization to fail with "Unknown remote qXfer reply: OK".
2211 @end deffn
2212
2213 @deffn {Config Command} {tcl_port} [number]
2214 Specify or query the port used for a simplified RPC
2215 connection that can be used by clients to issue TCL commands and get the
2216 output from the Tcl engine.
2217 Intended as a machine interface.
2218 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2219 the port @var{number} defaults to 6666.
2220 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2221 @end deffn
2222
2223 @deffn {Config Command} {telnet_port} [number]
2224 Specify or query the
2225 port on which to listen for incoming telnet connections.
2226 This port is intended for interaction with one human through TCL commands.
2227 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2228 the port @var{number} defaults to 4444.
2229 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2230 @end deffn
2231
2232 @anchor{gdbconfiguration}
2233 @section GDB Configuration
2234 @cindex GDB
2235 @cindex GDB configuration
2236 You can reconfigure some GDB behaviors if needed.
2237 The ones listed here are static and global.
2238 @xref{targetconfiguration,,Target Configuration}, about configuring individual targets.
2239 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, about configuring target-specific event handling.
2240
2241 @anchor{gdbbreakpointoverride}
2242 @deffn {Command} {gdb_breakpoint_override} [@option{hard}|@option{soft}|@option{disable}]
2243 Force breakpoint type for gdb @command{break} commands.
2244 This option supports GDB GUIs which don't
2245 distinguish hard versus soft breakpoints, if the default OpenOCD and
2246 GDB behaviour is not sufficient. GDB normally uses hardware
2247 breakpoints if the memory map has been set up for flash regions.
2248 @end deffn
2249
2250 @anchor{gdbflashprogram}
2251 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_flash_program} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2252 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to program the flash memory when a
2253 vFlash packet is received.
2254 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2255 @end deffn
2256
2257 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_memory_map} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2258 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the memory configuration to GDB when
2259 requested. GDB will then know when to set hardware breakpoints, and program flash
2260 using the GDB load command. @command{gdb_flash_program enable} must also be enabled
2261 for flash programming to work.
2262 Default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2263 @xref{gdbflashprogram,,gdb_flash_program}.
2264 @end deffn
2265
2266 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_report_data_abort} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2267 Specifies whether data aborts cause an error to be reported
2268 by GDB memory read packets.
2269 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2270 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2271 @end deffn
2272
2273 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_report_register_access_error} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2274 Specifies whether register accesses requested by GDB register read/write
2275 packets report errors or not.
2276 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2277 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2278 @end deffn
2279
2280 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_target_description} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2281 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the target descriptions to gdb via qXfer:features:read packet.
2282 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2283 @end deffn
2284
2285 @deffn {Command} {gdb_save_tdesc}
2286 Saves the target description file to the local file system.
2287
2288 The file name is @i{target_name}.xml.
2289 @end deffn
2290
2291 @anchor{eventpolling}
2292 @section Event Polling
2293
2294 Hardware debuggers are parts of asynchronous systems,
2295 where significant events can happen at any time.
2296 The OpenOCD server needs to detect some of these events,
2297 so it can report them to through TCL command line
2298 or to GDB.
2299
2300 Examples of such events include:
2301
2302 @itemize
2303 @item One of the targets can stop running ... maybe it triggers
2304 a code breakpoint or data watchpoint, or halts itself.
2305 @item Messages may be sent over ``debug message'' channels ... many
2306 targets support such messages sent over JTAG,
2307 for receipt by the person debugging or tools.
2308 @item Loss of power ... some adapters can detect these events.
2309 @item Resets not issued through JTAG ... such reset sources
2310 can include button presses or other system hardware, sometimes
2311 including the target itself (perhaps through a watchdog).
2312 @item Debug instrumentation sometimes supports event triggering
2313 such as ``trace buffer full'' (so it can quickly be emptied)
2314 or other signals (to correlate with code behavior).
2315 @end itemize
2316
2317 None of those events are signaled through standard JTAG signals.
2318 However, most conventions for JTAG connectors include voltage
2319 level and system reset (SRST) signal detection.
2320 Some connectors also include instrumentation signals, which
2321 can imply events when those signals are inputs.
2322
2323 In general, OpenOCD needs to periodically check for those events,
2324 either by looking at the status of signals on the JTAG connector
2325 or by sending synchronous ``tell me your status'' JTAG requests
2326 to the various active targets.
2327 There is a command to manage and monitor that polling,
2328 which is normally done in the background.
2329
2330 @deffn {Command} {poll} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2331 Poll the current target for its current state.
2332 (Also, @pxref{targetcurstate,,target curstate}.)
2333 If that target is in debug mode, architecture
2334 specific information about the current state is printed.
2335 An optional parameter
2336 allows background polling to be enabled and disabled.
2337
2338 You could use this from the TCL command shell, or
2339 from GDB using @command{monitor poll} command.
2340 Leave background polling enabled while you're using GDB.
2341 @example
2342 > poll
2343 background polling: on
2344 target state: halted
2345 target halted in ARM state due to debug-request, \
2346 current mode: Supervisor
2347 cpsr: 0x800000d3 pc: 0x11081bfc
2348 MMU: disabled, D-Cache: disabled, I-Cache: enabled
2349 >
2350 @end example
2351 @end deffn
2352
2353 @node Debug Adapter Configuration
2354 @chapter Debug Adapter Configuration
2355 @cindex config file, interface
2356 @cindex interface config file
2357
2358 Correctly installing OpenOCD includes making your operating system give
2359 OpenOCD access to debug adapters. Once that has been done, Tcl commands
2360 are used to select which one is used, and to configure how it is used.
2361
2362 @quotation Note
2363 Because OpenOCD started out with a focus purely on JTAG, you may find
2364 places where it wrongly presumes JTAG is the only transport protocol
2365 in use. Be aware that recent versions of OpenOCD are removing that
2366 limitation. JTAG remains more functional than most other transports.
2367 Other transports do not support boundary scan operations, or may be
2368 specific to a given chip vendor. Some might be usable only for
2369 programming flash memory, instead of also for debugging.
2370 @end quotation
2371
2372 Debug Adapters/Interfaces/Dongles are normally configured
2373 through commands in an interface configuration
2374 file which is sourced by your @file{openocd.cfg} file, or
2375 through a command line @option{-f interface/....cfg} option.
2376
2377 @example
2378 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
2379 @end example
2380
2381 These commands tell
2382 OpenOCD what type of JTAG adapter you have, and how to talk to it.
2383 A few cases are so simple that you only need to say what driver to use:
2384
2385 @example
2386 # jlink interface
2387 adapter driver jlink
2388 @end example
2389
2390 Most adapters need a bit more configuration than that.
2391
2392
2393 @section Adapter Configuration
2394
2395 The @command{adapter driver} command tells OpenOCD what type of debug adapter you are
2396 using. Depending on the type of adapter, you may need to use one or
2397 more additional commands to further identify or configure the adapter.
2398
2399 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter driver} name
2400 Use the adapter driver @var{name} to connect to the
2401 target.
2402 @end deffn
2403
2404 @deffn {Command} {adapter list}
2405 List the debug adapter drivers that have been built into
2406 the running copy of OpenOCD.
2407 @end deffn
2408 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter transports} transport_name+
2409 Specifies the transports supported by this debug adapter.
2410 The adapter driver builds-in similar knowledge; use this only
2411 when external configuration (such as jumpering) changes what
2412 the hardware can support.
2413 @end deffn
2414
2415 @anchor{adapter gpio}
2416 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter gpio [ @
2417 @option{tdo} | @option{tdi} | @option{tms} | @option{tck} | @option{trst} | @
2418 @option{swdio} | @option{swdio_dir} | @option{swclk} | @option{srst} | @
2419 @option{led} @
2420 [ @
2421 gpio_number | @option{-chip} chip_number | @
2422 @option{-active-high} | @option{-active-low} | @
2423 @option{-push-pull} | @option{-open-drain} | @option{-open-source} | @
2424 @option{-pull-none} | @option{-pull-up} | @option{-pull-down} | @
2425 @option{-init-inactive} | @option{-init-active} | @option{-init-input} @
2426 ] ]}
2427
2428 Define the GPIO mapping that the adapter will use. The following signals can be
2429 defined:
2430
2431 @itemize @minus
2432 @item @option{tdo}, @option{tdi}, @option{tms}, @option{tck}, @option{trst}:
2433 JTAG transport signals
2434 @item @option{swdio}, @option{swclk}: SWD transport signals
2435 @item @option{swdio_dir}: optional swdio buffer control signal
2436 @item @option{srst}: system reset signal
2437 @item @option{led}: optional activity led
2438
2439 @end itemize
2440
2441 Some adapters require that the GPIO chip number is set in addition to the GPIO
2442 number. The configuration options enable signals to be defined as active-high or
2443 active-low. The output drive mode can be set to push-pull, open-drain or
2444 open-source. Most adapters will have to emulate open-drain or open-source drive
2445 modes by switching between an input and output. Input and output signals can be
2446 instructed to use a pull-up or pull-down resistor, assuming it is supported by
2447 the adaptor driver and hardware. The initial state of outputs may also be set,
2448 "active" state means 1 for active-high outputs and 0 for active-low outputs.
2449 Bidirectional signals may also be initialized as an input. If the swdio signal
2450 is buffered the buffer direction can be controlled with the swdio_dir signal;
2451 the active state means that the buffer should be set as an output with respect
2452 to the adapter. The command options are cumulative with later commands able to
2453 override settings defined by earlier ones. The two commands @command{gpio led 7
2454 -active-high} and @command{gpio led -chip 1 -active-low} sent sequentially are
2455 equivalent to issuing the single command @command{gpio led 7 -chip 1
2456 -active-low}. It is not permissible to set the drive mode or initial state for
2457 signals which are inputs. The drive mode for the srst and trst signals must be
2458 set with the @command{adapter reset_config} command. It is not permissible to
2459 set the initial state of swdio_dir as it is derived from the initial state of
2460 swdio. The command @command{adapter gpio} prints the current configuration for
2461 all GPIOs while the command @command{adapter gpio gpio_name} prints the current
2462 configuration for gpio_name. Not all adapters support this generic GPIO mapping,
2463 some require their own commands to define the GPIOs used. Adapters that support
2464 the generic mapping may not support all of the listed options.
2465 @end deffn
2466
2467 @deffn {Command} {adapter name}
2468 Returns the name of the debug adapter driver being used.
2469 @end deffn
2470
2471 @anchor{adapter_usb_location}
2472 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter usb location} [<bus>-<port>[.<port>]...]
2473 Displays or specifies the physical USB port of the adapter to use. The path
2474 roots at @var{bus} and walks down the physical ports, with each
2475 @var{port} option specifying a deeper level in the bus topology, the last
2476 @var{port} denoting where the target adapter is actually plugged.
2477 The USB bus topology can be queried with the command @emph{lsusb -t} or @emph{dmesg}.
2478
2479 This command is only available if your libusb1 is at least version 1.0.16.
2480 @end deffn
2481
2482 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter serial} serial_string
2483 Specifies the @var{serial_string} of the adapter to use.
2484 If this command is not specified, serial strings are not checked.
2485 Only the following adapter drivers use the serial string from this command:
2486 aice (aice_usb), arm-jtag-ew, cmsis_dap, ft232r, ftdi, hla (stlink, ti-icdi), jlink, kitprog, opendus,
2487 openjtag, osbdm, presto, rlink, st-link, usb_blaster (ublast2), usbprog, vsllink, xds110.
2488 @end deffn
2489
2490 @section Interface Drivers
2491
2492 Each of the interface drivers listed here must be explicitly
2493 enabled when OpenOCD is configured, in order to be made
2494 available at run time.
2495
2496 @deffn {Interface Driver} {amt_jtagaccel}
2497 Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
2498 connected to a PC's EPP mode parallel port.
2499 This defines some driver-specific commands:
2500
2501 @deffn {Config Command} {parport port} number
2502 Specifies either the address of the I/O port (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or
2503 the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2504 @end deffn
2505
2506 @deffn {Config Command} {rtck} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
2507 Displays status of RTCK option.
2508 Optionally sets that option first.
2509 @end deffn
2510 @end deffn
2511
2512 @deffn {Interface Driver} {arm-jtag-ew}
2513 Olimex ARM-JTAG-EW USB adapter
2514 This has one driver-specific command:
2515
2516 @deffn {Command} {armjtagew_info}
2517 Logs some status
2518 @end deffn
2519 @end deffn
2520
2521 @deffn {Interface Driver} {at91rm9200}
2522 Supports bitbanged JTAG from the local system,
2523 presuming that system is an Atmel AT91rm9200
2524 and a specific set of GPIOs is used.
2525 @c command: at91rm9200_device NAME
2526 @c chooses among list of bit configs ... only one option
2527 @end deffn
2528
2529 @deffn {Interface Driver} {cmsis-dap}
2530 ARM CMSIS-DAP compliant based adapter v1 (USB HID based)
2531 or v2 (USB bulk).
2532
2533 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2534 The vendor ID and product ID of the CMSIS-DAP device. If not specified
2535 the driver will attempt to auto detect the CMSIS-DAP device.
2536 Currently, up to eight [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2537 @example
2538 cmsis_dap_vid_pid 0xc251 0xf001 0x0d28 0x0204
2539 @end example
2540 @end deffn
2541
2542 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_backend} [@option{auto}|@option{usb_bulk}|@option{hid}]
2543 Specifies how to communicate with the adapter:
2544
2545 @itemize @minus
2546 @item @option{hid} Use HID generic reports - CMSIS-DAP v1
2547 @item @option{usb_bulk} Use USB bulk - CMSIS-DAP v2
2548 @item @option{auto} First try USB bulk CMSIS-DAP v2, if not found try HID CMSIS-DAP v1.
2549 This is the default if @command{cmsis_dap_backend} is not specified.
2550 @end itemize
2551 @end deffn
2552
2553 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_usb interface} [number]
2554 Specifies the @var{number} of the USB interface to use in v2 mode (USB bulk).
2555 In most cases need not to be specified and interfaces are searched by
2556 interface string or for user class interface.
2557 @end deffn
2558
2559 @deffn {Command} {cmsis-dap info}
2560 Display various device information, like hardware version, firmware version, current bus status.
2561 @end deffn
2562
2563 @deffn {Command} {cmsis-dap cmd} number number ...
2564 Execute an arbitrary CMSIS-DAP command. Use for adapter testing or for handling
2565 of an adapter vendor specific command from a Tcl script.
2566
2567 Take given numbers as bytes, assemble a CMSIS-DAP protocol command packet
2568 from them and send it to the adapter. The first 4 bytes of the adapter response
2569 are logged.
2570 See @url{https://arm-software.github.io/CMSIS_5/DAP/html/group__DAP__Commands__gr.html}
2571 @end deffn
2572 @end deffn
2573
2574 @deffn {Interface Driver} {dummy}
2575 A dummy software-only driver for debugging.
2576 @end deffn
2577
2578 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ep93xx}
2579 Cirrus Logic EP93xx based single-board computer bit-banging (in development)
2580 @end deffn
2581
2582 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ftdi}
2583 This driver is for adapters using the MPSSE (Multi-Protocol Synchronous Serial
2584 Engine) mode built into many FTDI chips, such as the FT2232, FT4232 and FT232H.
2585
2586 The driver is using libusb-1.0 in asynchronous mode to talk to the FTDI device,
2587 bypassing intermediate libraries like libftdi.
2588
2589 Support for new FTDI based adapters can be added completely through
2590 configuration files, without the need to patch and rebuild OpenOCD.
2591
2592 The driver uses a signal abstraction to enable Tcl configuration files to
2593 define outputs for one or several FTDI GPIO. These outputs can then be
2594 controlled using the @command{ftdi set_signal} command. Special signal names
2595 are reserved for nTRST, nSRST and LED (for blink) so that they, if defined,
2596 will be used for their customary purpose. Inputs can be read using the
2597 @command{ftdi get_signal} command.
2598
2599 To support SWD, a signal named SWD_EN must be defined. It is set to 1 when the
2600 SWD protocol is selected. When set, the adapter should route the SWDIO pin to
2601 the data input. An SWDIO_OE signal, if defined, will be set to 1 or 0 as
2602 required by the protocol, to tell the adapter to drive the data output onto
2603 the SWDIO pin or keep the SWDIO pin Hi-Z, respectively.
2604
2605 Depending on the type of buffer attached to the FTDI GPIO, the outputs have to
2606 be controlled differently. In order to support tristateable signals such as
2607 nSRST, both a data GPIO and an output-enable GPIO can be specified for each
2608 signal. The following output buffer configurations are supported:
2609
2610 @itemize @minus
2611 @item Push-pull with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line
2612 @item Open drain with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2613 @item Tristate with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line and another
2614 FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2615 @item Unbuffered, using the FTDI GPIO as a tristate output directly by
2616 switching data and direction as necessary
2617 @end itemize
2618
2619 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2620 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2621
2622 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2623 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. Up to eight
2624 [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2625 @example
2626 ftdi vid_pid 0x0403 0xcff8 0x15ba 0x0003
2627 @end example
2628 @end deffn
2629
2630 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi device_desc} description
2631 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2632 of the adapter. If not specified, the device description is ignored
2633 during device selection.
2634 @end deffn
2635
2636 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi channel} channel
2637 Selects the channel of the FTDI device to use for MPSSE operations. Most
2638 adapters use the default, channel 0, but there are exceptions.
2639 @end deffn
2640
2641 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi layout_init} data direction
2642 Specifies the initial values of the FTDI GPIO data and direction registers.
2643 Each value is a 16-bit number corresponding to the concatenation of the high
2644 and low FTDI GPIO registers. The values should be selected based on the
2645 schematics of the adapter, such that all signals are set to safe levels with
2646 minimal impact on the target system. Avoid floating inputs, conflicting outputs
2647 and initially asserted reset signals.
2648 @end deffn
2649
2650 @deffn {Command} {ftdi layout_signal} name [@option{-data}|@option{-ndata} data_mask] [@option{-input}|@option{-ninput} input_mask] [@option{-oe}|@option{-noe} oe_mask] [@option{-alias}|@option{-nalias} name]
2651 Creates a signal with the specified @var{name}, controlled by one or more FTDI
2652 GPIO pins via a range of possible buffer connections. The masks are FTDI GPIO
2653 register bitmasks to tell the driver the connection and type of the output
2654 buffer driving the respective signal. @var{data_mask} is the bitmask for the
2655 pin(s) connected to the data input of the output buffer. @option{-ndata} is
2656 used with inverting data inputs and @option{-data} with non-inverting inputs.
2657 The @option{-oe} (or @option{-noe}) option tells where the output-enable (or
2658 not-output-enable) input to the output buffer is connected. The options
2659 @option{-input} and @option{-ninput} specify the bitmask for pins to be read
2660 with the method @command{ftdi get_signal}.
2661
2662 Both @var{data_mask} and @var{oe_mask} need not be specified. For example, a
2663 simple open-collector transistor driver would be specified with @option{-oe}
2664 only. In that case the signal can only be set to drive low or to Hi-Z and the
2665 driver will complain if the signal is set to drive high. Which means that if
2666 it's a reset signal, @command{reset_config} must be specified as
2667 @option{srst_open_drain}, not @option{srst_push_pull}.
2668
2669 A special case is provided when @option{-data} and @option{-oe} is set to the
2670 same bitmask. Then the FTDI pin is considered being connected straight to the
2671 target without any buffer. The FTDI pin is then switched between output and
2672 input as necessary to provide the full set of low, high and Hi-Z
2673 characteristics. In all other cases, the pins specified in a signal definition
2674 are always driven by the FTDI.
2675
2676 If @option{-alias} or @option{-nalias} is used, the signal is created
2677 identical (or with data inverted) to an already specified signal
2678 @var{name}.
2679 @end deffn
2680
2681 @deffn {Command} {ftdi set_signal} name @option{0}|@option{1}|@option{z}
2682 Set a previously defined signal to the specified level.
2683 @itemize @minus
2684 @item @option{0}, drive low
2685 @item @option{1}, drive high
2686 @item @option{z}, set to high-impedance
2687 @end itemize
2688 @end deffn
2689
2690 @deffn {Command} {ftdi get_signal} name
2691 Get the value of a previously defined signal.
2692 @end deffn
2693
2694 @deffn {Command} {ftdi tdo_sample_edge} @option{rising}|@option{falling}
2695 Configure TCK edge at which the adapter samples the value of the TDO signal
2696
2697 Due to signal propagation delays, sampling TDO on rising TCK can become quite
2698 peculiar at high JTAG clock speeds. However, FTDI chips offer a possibility to sample
2699 TDO on falling edge of TCK. With some board/adapter configurations, this may increase
2700 stability at higher JTAG clocks.
2701 @itemize @minus
2702 @item @option{rising}, sample TDO on rising edge of TCK - this is the default
2703 @item @option{falling}, sample TDO on falling edge of TCK
2704 @end itemize
2705 @end deffn
2706
2707 For example adapter definitions, see the configuration files shipped in the
2708 @file{interface/ftdi} directory.
2709
2710 @end deffn
2711
2712 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ft232r}
2713 This driver is implementing synchronous bitbang mode of an FTDI FT232R,
2714 FT230X, FT231X and similar USB UART bridge ICs by reusing RS232 signals as GPIO.
2715 It currently doesn't support using CBUS pins as GPIO.
2716
2717 List of connections (default physical pin numbers for FT232R in 28-pin SSOP package):
2718 @itemize @minus
2719 @item RXD(5) - TDI
2720 @item TXD(1) - TCK
2721 @item RTS(3) - TDO
2722 @item CTS(11) - TMS
2723 @item DTR(2) - TRST
2724 @item DCD(10) - SRST
2725 @end itemize
2726
2727 User can change default pinout by supplying configuration
2728 commands with GPIO numbers or RS232 signal names.
2729 GPIO numbers correspond to bit numbers in FTDI GPIO register.
2730 They differ from physical pin numbers.
2731 For details see actual FTDI chip datasheets.
2732 Every JTAG line must be configured to unique GPIO number
2733 different than any other JTAG line, even those lines
2734 that are sometimes not used like TRST or SRST.
2735
2736 FT232R
2737 @itemize @minus
2738 @item bit 7 - RI
2739 @item bit 6 - DCD
2740 @item bit 5 - DSR
2741 @item bit 4 - DTR
2742 @item bit 3 - CTS
2743 @item bit 2 - RTS
2744 @item bit 1 - RXD
2745 @item bit 0 - TXD
2746 @end itemize
2747
2748 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2749 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2750
2751 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r vid_pid} @var{vid} @var{pid}
2752 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. If not specified, default
2753 0x0403:0x6001 is used.
2754 @end deffn
2755
2756 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r jtag_nums} @var{tck} @var{tms} @var{tdi} @var{tdo}
2757 Set four JTAG GPIO numbers at once.
2758 If not specified, default 0 3 1 2 or TXD CTS RXD RTS is used.
2759 @end deffn
2760
2761 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r tck_num} @var{tck}
2762 Set TCK GPIO number. If not specified, default 0 or TXD is used.
2763 @end deffn
2764
2765 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r tms_num} @var{tms}
2766 Set TMS GPIO number. If not specified, default 3 or CTS is used.
2767 @end deffn
2768
2769 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r tdi_num} @var{tdi}
2770 Set TDI GPIO number. If not specified, default 1 or RXD is used.
2771 @end deffn
2772
2773 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r tdo_num} @var{tdo}
2774 Set TDO GPIO number. If not specified, default 2 or RTS is used.
2775 @end deffn
2776
2777 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r trst_num} @var{trst}
2778 Set TRST GPIO number. If not specified, default 4 or DTR is used.
2779 @end deffn
2780
2781 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r srst_num} @var{srst}
2782 Set SRST GPIO number. If not specified, default 6 or DCD is used.
2783 @end deffn
2784
2785 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r restore_serial} @var{word}
2786 Restore serial port after JTAG. This USB bitmode control word
2787 (16-bit) will be sent before quit. Lower byte should
2788 set GPIO direction register to a "sane" state:
2789 0x15 for TXD RTS DTR as outputs (1), others as inputs (0). Higher
2790 byte is usually 0 to disable bitbang mode.
2791 When kernel driver reattaches, serial port should continue to work.
2792 Value 0xFFFF disables sending control word and serial port,
2793 then kernel driver will not reattach.
2794 If not specified, default 0xFFFF is used.
2795 @end deffn
2796
2797 @end deffn
2798
2799 @deffn {Interface Driver} {remote_bitbang}
2800 Drive JTAG from a remote process. This sets up a UNIX or TCP socket connection
2801 with a remote process and sends ASCII encoded bitbang requests to that process
2802 instead of directly driving JTAG.
2803
2804 The remote_bitbang driver is useful for debugging software running on
2805 processors which are being simulated.
2806
2807 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang port} number
2808 Specifies the TCP port of the remote process to connect to or 0 to use UNIX
2809 sockets instead of TCP.
2810 @end deffn
2811
2812 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang host} hostname
2813 Specifies the hostname of the remote process to connect to using TCP, or the
2814 name of the UNIX socket to use if remote_bitbang port is 0.
2815 @end deffn
2816
2817 For example, to connect remotely via TCP to the host foobar you might have
2818 something like:
2819
2820 @example
2821 adapter driver remote_bitbang
2822 remote_bitbang port 3335
2823 remote_bitbang host foobar
2824 @end example
2825
2826 To connect to another process running locally via UNIX sockets with socket
2827 named mysocket:
2828
2829 @example
2830 adapter driver remote_bitbang
2831 remote_bitbang port 0
2832 remote_bitbang host mysocket
2833 @end example
2834 @end deffn
2835
2836 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usb_blaster}
2837 USB JTAG/USB-Blaster compatibles over one of the userspace libraries
2838 for FTDI chips. These interfaces have several commands, used to
2839 configure the driver before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2840
2841 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster vid_pid} vid pid
2842 The vendor ID and product ID of the FTDI FT245 device. If not specified,
2843 default values are used.
2844 Currently, only one @var{vid}, @var{pid} pair may be given, e.g. for
2845 Altera USB-Blaster (default):
2846 @example
2847 usb_blaster vid_pid 0x09FB 0x6001
2848 @end example
2849 The following VID/PID is for Kolja Waschk's USB JTAG:
2850 @example
2851 usb_blaster vid_pid 0x16C0 0x06AD
2852 @end example
2853 @end deffn
2854
2855 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster pin} (@option{pin6}|@option{pin8}) (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{s}|@option{t})
2856 Sets the state or function of the unused GPIO pins on USB-Blasters
2857 (pins 6 and 8 on the female JTAG header). These pins can be used as
2858 SRST and/or TRST provided the appropriate connections are made on the
2859 target board.
2860
2861 For example, to use pin 6 as SRST:
2862 @example
2863 usb_blaster pin pin6 s
2864 reset_config srst_only
2865 @end example
2866 @end deffn
2867
2868 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster lowlevel_driver} (@option{ftdi}|@option{ublast2})
2869 Chooses the low level access method for the adapter. If not specified,
2870 @option{ftdi} is selected unless it wasn't enabled during the
2871 configure stage. USB-Blaster II needs @option{ublast2}.
2872 @end deffn
2873
2874 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster firmware} @var{path}
2875 This command specifies @var{path} to access USB-Blaster II firmware
2876 image. To be used with USB-Blaster II only.
2877 @end deffn
2878
2879 @end deffn
2880
2881 @deffn {Interface Driver} {gw16012}
2882 Gateworks GW16012 JTAG programmer.
2883 This has one driver-specific command:
2884
2885 @deffn {Config Command} {parport port} [port_number]
2886 Display either the address of the I/O port
2887 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2888 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2889 This is a write-once setting.
2890 @end deffn
2891 @end deffn
2892
2893 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jlink}
2894 SEGGER J-Link family of USB adapters. It currently supports JTAG and SWD
2895 transports.
2896
2897 @quotation Compatibility Note
2898 SEGGER released many firmware versions for the many hardware versions they
2899 produced. OpenOCD was extensively tested and intended to run on all of them,
2900 but some combinations were reported as incompatible. As a general
2901 recommendation, it is advisable to use the latest firmware version
2902 available for each hardware version. However the current V8 is a moving
2903 target, and SEGGER firmware versions released after the OpenOCD was
2904 released may not be compatible. In such cases it is recommended to
2905 revert to the last known functional version. For 0.5.0, this is from
2906 "Feb 8 2012 14:30:39", packed with 4.42c. For 0.6.0, the last known
2907 version is from "May 3 2012 18:36:22", packed with 4.46f.
2908 @end quotation
2909
2910 @deffn {Command} {jlink hwstatus}
2911 Display various hardware related information, for example target voltage and pin
2912 states.
2913 @end deffn
2914 @deffn {Command} {jlink freemem}
2915 Display free device internal memory.
2916 @end deffn
2917 @deffn {Command} {jlink jtag} [@option{2}|@option{3}]
2918 Set the JTAG command version to be used. Without argument, show the actual JTAG
2919 command version.
2920 @end deffn
2921 @deffn {Command} {jlink config}
2922 Display the device configuration.
2923 @end deffn
2924 @deffn {Command} {jlink config targetpower} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2925 Set the target power state on JTAG-pin 19. Without argument, show the target
2926 power state.
2927 @end deffn
2928 @deffn {Command} {jlink config mac} [@option{ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff}]
2929 Set the MAC address of the device. Without argument, show the MAC address.
2930 @end deffn
2931 @deffn {Command} {jlink config ip} [@option{A.B.C.D}(@option{/E}|@option{F.G.H.I})]
2932 Set the IP configuration of the device, where A.B.C.D is the IP address, E the
2933 bit of the subnet mask and F.G.H.I the subnet mask. Without arguments, show the
2934 IP configuration.
2935 @end deffn
2936 @deffn {Command} {jlink config usb} [@option{0} to @option{3}]
2937 Set the USB address of the device. This will also change the USB Product ID
2938 (PID) of the device. Without argument, show the USB address.
2939 @end deffn
2940 @deffn {Command} {jlink config reset}
2941 Reset the current configuration.
2942 @end deffn
2943 @deffn {Command} {jlink config write}
2944 Write the current configuration to the internal persistent storage.
2945 @end deffn
2946 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom write} <channel> <data>
2947 Write data to an EMUCOM channel. The data needs to be encoded as hexadecimal
2948 pairs.
2949
2950 The following example shows how to write the three bytes 0xaa, 0x0b and 0x23 to
2951 the EMUCOM channel 0x10:
2952 @example
2953 > jlink emucom write 0x10 aa0b23
2954 @end example
2955 @end deffn
2956 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom read} <channel> <length>
2957 Read data from an EMUCOM channel. The read data is encoded as hexadecimal
2958 pairs.
2959
2960 The following example shows how to read 4 bytes from the EMUCOM channel 0x0:
2961 @example
2962 > jlink emucom read 0x0 4
2963 77a90000
2964 @end example
2965 @end deffn
2966 @deffn {Config Command} {jlink usb} <@option{0} to @option{3}>
2967 Set the USB address of the interface, in case more than one adapter is connected
2968 to the host. If not specified, USB addresses are not considered. Device
2969 selection via USB address is not always unambiguous. It is recommended to use
2970 the serial number instead, if possible.
2971
2972 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2973 @end deffn
2974 @end deffn
2975
2976 @deffn {Interface Driver} {kitprog}
2977 This driver is for Cypress Semiconductor's KitProg adapters. The KitProg is an
2978 SWD-only adapter that is designed to be used with Cypress's PSoC and PRoC device
2979 families, but it is possible to use it with some other devices. If you are using
2980 this adapter with a PSoC or a PRoC, you may need to add
2981 @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} or @command{kitprog acquire_psoc} to your
2982 configuration script.
2983
2984 Note that this driver is for the proprietary KitProg protocol, not the CMSIS-DAP
2985 mode introduced in firmware 2.14. If the KitProg is in CMSIS-DAP mode, it cannot
2986 be used with this driver, and must either be used with the cmsis-dap driver or
2987 switched back to KitProg mode. See the Cypress KitProg User Guide for
2988 instructions on how to switch KitProg modes.
2989
2990 Known limitations:
2991 @itemize @bullet
2992 @item The frequency of SWCLK cannot be configured, and varies between 1.6 MHz
2993 and 2.7 MHz.
2994 @item For firmware versions below 2.14, "JTAG to SWD" sequences are replaced by
2995 "SWD line reset" in the driver. This is for two reasons. First, the KitProg does
2996 not support sending arbitrary SWD sequences, and only firmware 2.14 and later
2997 implement both "JTAG to SWD" and "SWD line reset" in firmware. Earlier firmware
2998 versions only implement "SWD line reset". Second, due to a firmware quirk, an
2999 SWD sequence must be sent after every target reset in order to re-establish
3000 communications with the target.
3001 @item Due in part to the limitation above, KitProg devices with firmware below
3002 version 2.14 will need to use @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} in order to
3003 communicate with PSoC 5LP devices. This is because, assuming debug is not
3004 disabled on the PSoC, the PSoC 5LP needs its JTAG interface switched to SWD
3005 mode before communication can begin, but prior to firmware 2.14, "JTAG to SWD"
3006 could only be sent with an acquisition sequence.
3007 @end itemize
3008
3009 @deffn {Config Command} {kitprog_init_acquire_psoc}
3010 Indicate that a PSoC acquisition sequence needs to be run during adapter init.
3011 Please be aware that the acquisition sequence hard-resets the target.
3012 @end deffn
3013
3014 @deffn {Command} {kitprog acquire_psoc}
3015 Run a PSoC acquisition sequence immediately. Typically, this should not be used
3016 outside of the target-specific configuration scripts since it hard-resets the
3017 target as a side-effect.
3018 This is necessary for "reset halt" on some PSoC 4 series devices.
3019 @end deffn
3020
3021 @deffn {Command} {kitprog info}
3022 Display various adapter information, such as the hardware version, firmware
3023 version, and target voltage.
3024 @end deffn
3025 @end deffn
3026
3027 @deffn {Interface Driver} {parport}
3028 Supports PC parallel port bit-banging cables:
3029 Wigglers, PLD download cable, and more.
3030 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
3031 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
3032
3033 @deffn {Config Command} {parport cable} name
3034 Set the layout of the parallel port cable used to connect to the target.
3035 This is a write-once setting.
3036 Currently valid cable @var{name} values include:
3037
3038 @itemize @minus
3039 @item @b{altium} Altium Universal JTAG cable.
3040 @item @b{arm-jtag} Same as original wiggler except SRST and
3041 TRST connections reversed and TRST is also inverted.
3042 @item @b{chameleon} The Amontec Chameleon's CPLD when operated
3043 in configuration mode. This is only used to
3044 program the Chameleon itself, not a connected target.
3045 @item @b{dlc5} The Xilinx Parallel cable III.
3046 @item @b{flashlink} The ST Parallel cable.
3047 @item @b{lattice} Lattice ispDOWNLOAD Cable
3048 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler} The Wiggler configuration that comes with
3049 some versions of
3050 Amontec's Chameleon Programmer. The new version available from
3051 the website uses the original Wiggler layout ('@var{wiggler}')
3052 @item @b{triton} The parallel port adapter found on the
3053 ``Karo Triton 1 Development Board''.
3054 This is also the layout used by the HollyGates design
3055 (see @uref{http://www.lartmaker.nl/projects/jtag/}).
3056 @item @b{wiggler} The original Wiggler layout, also supported by
3057 several clones, such as the Olimex ARM-JTAG
3058 @item @b{wiggler2} Same as original wiggler except an led is fitted on D5.
3059 @item @b{wiggler_ntrst_inverted} Same as original wiggler except TRST is inverted.
3060 @end itemize
3061 @end deffn
3062
3063 @deffn {Config Command} {parport port} [port_number]
3064 Display either the address of the I/O port
3065 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
3066 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
3067 This is a write-once setting.
3068
3069 When using PPDEV to access the parallel port, use the number of the parallel port:
3070 @option{parport port 0} (the default). If @option{parport port 0x378} is specified
3071 you may encounter a problem.
3072 @end deffn
3073
3074 @deffn {Config Command} {parport toggling_time} [nanoseconds]
3075 Displays how many nanoseconds the hardware needs to toggle TCK;
3076 the parport driver uses this value to obey the
3077 @command{adapter speed} configuration.
3078 When the optional @var{nanoseconds} parameter is given,
3079 that setting is changed before displaying the current value.
3080
3081 The default setting should work reasonably well on commodity PC hardware.
3082 However, you may want to calibrate for your specific hardware.
3083 @quotation Tip
3084 To measure the toggling time with a logic analyzer or a digital storage
3085 oscilloscope, follow the procedure below:
3086 @example
3087 > parport toggling_time 1000
3088 > adapter speed 500
3089 @end example
3090 This sets the maximum JTAG clock speed of the hardware, but
3091 the actual speed probably deviates from the requested 500 kHz.
3092 Now, measure the time between the two closest spaced TCK transitions.
3093 You can use @command{runtest 1000} or something similar to generate a
3094 large set of samples.
3095 Update the setting to match your measurement:
3096 @example
3097 > parport toggling_time <measured nanoseconds>
3098 @end example
3099 Now the clock speed will be a better match for @command{adapter speed}
3100 command given in OpenOCD scripts and event handlers.
3101
3102 You can do something similar with many digital multimeters, but note
3103 that you'll probably need to run the clock continuously for several
3104 seconds before it decides what clock rate to show. Adjust the
3105 toggling time up or down until the measured clock rate is a good
3106 match with the rate you specified in the @command{adapter speed} command;
3107 be conservative.
3108 @end quotation
3109 @end deffn
3110
3111 @deffn {Config Command} {parport write_on_exit} (@option{on}|@option{off})
3112 This will configure the parallel driver to write a known
3113 cable-specific value to the parallel interface on exiting OpenOCD.
3114 @end deffn
3115
3116 For example, the interface configuration file for a
3117 classic ``Wiggler'' cable on LPT2 might look something like this:
3118
3119 @example
3120 adapter driver parport
3121 parport port 0x278
3122 parport cable wiggler
3123 @end example
3124 @end deffn
3125
3126 @deffn {Interface Driver} {presto}
3127 ASIX PRESTO USB JTAG programmer.
3128 @end deffn
3129
3130 @deffn {Interface Driver} {rlink}
3131 Raisonance RLink USB adapter
3132 @end deffn
3133
3134 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usbprog}
3135 usbprog is a freely programmable USB adapter.
3136 @end deffn
3137
3138 @deffn {Interface Driver} {vsllink}
3139 vsllink is part of Versaloon which is a versatile USB programmer.
3140
3141 @quotation Note
3142 This defines quite a few driver-specific commands,
3143 which are not currently documented here.
3144 @end quotation
3145 @end deffn
3146
3147 @anchor{hla_interface}
3148 @deffn {Interface Driver} {hla}
3149 This is a driver that supports multiple High Level Adapters.
3150 This type of adapter does not expose some of the lower level api's
3151 that OpenOCD would normally use to access the target.
3152
3153 Currently supported adapters include the STMicroelectronics ST-LINK, TI ICDI
3154 and Nuvoton Nu-Link.
3155 ST-LINK firmware version >= V2.J21.S4 recommended due to issues with earlier
3156 versions of firmware where serial number is reset after first use. Suggest
3157 using ST firmware update utility to upgrade ST-LINK firmware even if current
3158 version reported is V2.J21.S4.
3159
3160 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_device_desc} description
3161 Currently Not Supported.
3162 @end deffn
3163
3164 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_layout} (@option{stlink}|@option{icdi}|@option{nulink})
3165 Specifies the adapter layout to use.
3166 @end deffn
3167
3168 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
3169 Pairs of vendor IDs and product IDs of the device.
3170 @end deffn
3171
3172 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_stlink_backend} (usb | tcp [port])
3173 @emph{ST-Link only:} Choose between 'exclusive' USB communication (the default backend) or
3174 'shared' mode using ST-Link TCP server (the default port is 7184).
3175
3176 @emph{Note:} ST-Link TCP server is a binary application provided by ST
3177 available from @url{https://www.st.com/en/development-tools/st-link-server.html,
3178 ST-LINK server software module}.
3179 @end deffn
3180
3181 @deffn {Command} {hla_command} command
3182 Execute a custom adapter-specific command. The @var{command} string is
3183 passed as is to the underlying adapter layout handler.
3184 @end deffn
3185 @end deffn
3186
3187 @anchor{st_link_dap_interface}
3188 @deffn {Interface Driver} {st-link}
3189 This is a driver that supports STMicroelectronics adapters ST-LINK/V2
3190 (from firmware V2J24) and STLINK-V3, thanks to a new API that provides
3191 directly access the arm ADIv5 DAP.
3192
3193 The new API provide access to multiple AP on the same DAP, but the
3194 maximum number of the AP port is limited by the specific firmware version
3195 (e.g. firmware V2J29 has 3 as maximum AP number, while V2J32 has 8).
3196 An error is returned for any AP number above the maximum allowed value.
3197
3198 @emph{Note:} Either these same adapters and their older versions are
3199 also supported by @ref{hla_interface, the hla interface driver}.
3200
3201 @deffn {Config Command} {st-link backend} (usb | tcp [port])
3202 Choose between 'exclusive' USB communication (the default backend) or
3203 'shared' mode using ST-Link TCP server (the default port is 7184).
3204
3205 @emph{Note:} ST-Link TCP server is a binary application provided by ST
3206 available from @url{https://www.st.com/en/development-tools/st-link-server.html,
3207 ST-LINK server software module}.
3208
3209 @emph{Note:} ST-Link TCP server does not support the SWIM transport.
3210 @end deffn
3211
3212 @deffn {Config Command} {st-link vid_pid} [vid pid]+
3213 Pairs of vendor IDs and product IDs of the device.
3214 @end deffn
3215
3216 @deffn {Command} {st-link cmd} rx_n (tx_byte)+
3217 Sends an arbitrary command composed by the sequence of bytes @var{tx_byte}
3218 and receives @var{rx_n} bytes.
3219
3220 For example, the command to read the target's supply voltage is one byte 0xf7 followed
3221 by 15 bytes zero. It returns 8 bytes, where the first 4 bytes represent the ADC sampling
3222 of the reference voltage 1.2V and the last 4 bytes represent the ADC sampling of half
3223 the target's supply voltage.
3224 @example
3225 > st-link cmd 8 0xf7 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
3226 0xf1 0x05 0x00 0x00 0x0b 0x08 0x00 0x00
3227 @end example
3228 The result can be converted to Volts (ignoring the most significant bytes, always zero)
3229 @example
3230 > set a [st-link cmd 8 0xf7 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0]
3231 > set n [expr @{[lindex $a 4] + 256 * [lindex $a 5]@}]
3232 > set d [expr @{[lindex $a 0] + 256 * [lindex $a 1]@}]
3233 > echo [expr @{2 * 1.2 * $n / $d@}]
3234 3.24891518738
3235 @end example
3236 @end deffn
3237 @end deffn
3238
3239 @deffn {Interface Driver} {opendous}
3240 opendous-jtag is a freely programmable USB adapter.
3241 @end deffn
3242
3243 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ulink}
3244 This is the Keil ULINK v1 JTAG debugger.
3245 @end deffn
3246
3247 @deffn {Interface Driver} {xds110}
3248 The XDS110 is included as the embedded debug probe on many Texas Instruments
3249 LaunchPad evaluation boards. The XDS110 is also available as a stand-alone USB
3250 debug probe with the added capability to supply power to the target board. The
3251 following commands are supported by the XDS110 driver:
3252
3253 @deffn {Config Command} {xds110 supply} voltage_in_millivolts
3254 Available only on the XDS110 stand-alone probe. Sets the voltage level of the
3255 XDS110 power supply. A value of 0 leaves the supply off. Otherwise, the supply
3256 can be set to any value in the range 1800 to 3600 millivolts.
3257 @end deffn
3258
3259 @deffn {Command} {xds110 info}
3260 Displays information about the connected XDS110 debug probe (e.g. firmware
3261 version).
3262 @end deffn
3263 @end deffn
3264
3265 @deffn {Interface Driver} {xlnx_pcie_xvc}
3266 This driver supports the Xilinx Virtual Cable (XVC) over PCI Express.
3267 It is commonly found in Xilinx based PCI Express designs. It allows debugging
3268 fabric based JTAG/SWD devices such as Cortex-M1/M3 microcontrollers. Access to this is
3269 exposed via extended capability registers in the PCI Express configuration space.
3270
3271 For more information see Xilinx PG245 (Section on From_PCIE_to_JTAG mode).
3272
3273 @deffn {Config Command} {xlnx_pcie_xvc config} device
3274 Specifies the PCI Express device via parameter @var{device} to use.
3275
3276 The correct value for @var{device} can be obtained by looking at the output
3277 of lscpi -D (first column) for the corresponding device.
3278
3279 The string will be of the format "DDDD:BB:SS.F" such as "0000:65:00.1".
3280
3281 @end deffn
3282 @end deffn
3283
3284 @deffn {Interface Driver} {bcm2835gpio}
3285 This SoC is present in Raspberry Pi which is a cheap single-board computer
3286 exposing some GPIOs on its expansion header.
3287
3288 The driver accesses memory-mapped GPIO peripheral registers directly
3289 for maximum performance, but the only possible race condition is for
3290 the pins' modes/muxing (which is highly unlikely), so it should be
3291 able to coexist nicely with both sysfs bitbanging and various
3292 peripherals' kernel drivers. The driver restores the previous
3293 configuration on exit.
3294
3295 GPIO numbers >= 32 can't be used for performance reasons. GPIO configuration is
3296 handled by the generic command @ref{adapter gpio, @command{adapter gpio}}.
3297
3298 See @file{interface/raspberrypi-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3299 pinout.
3300
3301 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio speed_coeffs} @var{speed_coeff} @var{speed_offset}
3302 Set SPEED_COEFF and SPEED_OFFSET for delay calculations. If unspecified,
3303 speed_coeff defaults to 113714, and speed_offset defaults to 28.
3304 @end deffn
3305
3306 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio peripheral_base} @var{base}
3307 Set the peripheral base register address to access GPIOs. For the RPi1, use
3308 0x20000000. For RPi2 and RPi3, use 0x3F000000. For RPi4, use 0xFE000000. A full
3309 list can be found in the
3310 @uref{https://www.raspberrypi.org/documentation/hardware/raspberrypi/peripheral_addresses.md, official guide}.
3311 @end deffn
3312
3313 @end deffn
3314
3315 @deffn {Interface Driver} {imx_gpio}
3316 i.MX SoC is present in many community boards. Wandboard is an example
3317 of the one which is most popular.
3318
3319 This driver is mostly the same as bcm2835gpio.
3320
3321 See @file{interface/imx-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3322 pinout.
3323
3324 @end deffn
3325
3326
3327 @deffn {Interface Driver} {am335xgpio} The AM335x SoC is present in BeagleBone
3328 Black and BeagleBone Green single-board computers which expose some of the GPIOs
3329 on the two expansion headers.
3330
3331 For maximum performance the driver accesses memory-mapped GPIO peripheral
3332 registers directly. The memory mapping requires read and write permission to
3333 kernel memory; if /dev/gpiomem exists it will be used, otherwise /dev/mem will
3334 be used. The driver restores the GPIO state on exit.
3335
3336 All four GPIO ports are available. GPIO configuration is handled by the generic
3337 command @ref{adapter gpio, @command{adapter gpio}}.
3338
3339 @deffn {Config Command} {am335xgpio speed_coeffs} @var{speed_coeff} @var{speed_offset}
3340 Set SPEED_COEFF and SPEED_OFFSET for delay calculations. If unspecified
3341 speed_coeff defaults to 600000 and speed_offset defaults to 575.
3342 @end deffn
3343
3344 See @file{interface/beaglebone-swd-native.cfg} for a sample configuration file.
3345
3346 @end deffn
3347
3348
3349 @deffn {Interface Driver} {linuxgpiod}
3350 Linux provides userspace access to GPIO through libgpiod since Linux kernel
3351 version v4.6. The driver emulates either JTAG or SWD transport through
3352 bitbanging. There are no driver-specific commands, all GPIO configuration is
3353 handled by the generic command @ref{adapter gpio, @command{adapter gpio}}. This
3354 driver supports the resistor pull options provided by the @command{adapter gpio}
3355 command but the underlying hardware may not be able to support them.
3356
3357 See @file{interface/dln-2-gpiod.cfg} for a sample configuration file.
3358 @end deffn
3359
3360
3361 @deffn {Interface Driver} {sysfsgpio}
3362 Linux legacy userspace access to GPIO through sysfs is deprecated from Linux kernel version v5.3.
3363 Prefer using @b{linuxgpiod}, instead.
3364
3365 See @file{interface/sysfsgpio-raspberrypi.cfg} for a sample config.
3366 @end deffn
3367
3368
3369 @deffn {Interface Driver} {openjtag}
3370 OpenJTAG compatible USB adapter.
3371 This defines some driver-specific commands:
3372
3373 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag variant} variant
3374 Specifies the variant of the OpenJTAG adapter (see @uref{http://www.openjtag.org/}).
3375 Currently valid @var{variant} values include:
3376
3377 @itemize @minus
3378 @item @b{standard} Standard variant (default).
3379 @item @b{cy7c65215} Cypress CY7C65215 Dual Channel USB-Serial Bridge Controller
3380 (see @uref{http://www.cypress.com/?rID=82870}).
3381 @end itemize
3382 @end deffn
3383
3384 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag device_desc} string
3385 The USB device description string of the adapter.
3386 This value is only used with the standard variant.
3387 @end deffn
3388 @end deffn
3389
3390
3391 @deffn {Interface Driver} {vdebug}
3392 Cadence Virtual Debug Interface driver.
3393
3394 @deffn {Config Command} {vdebug server} host:port
3395 Specifies the host and TCP port number where the vdebug server runs.
3396 @end deffn
3397
3398 @deffn {Config Command} {vdebug batching} value
3399 Specifies the batching method for the vdebug request. Possible values are
3400 0 for no batching
3401 1 or wr to batch write transactions together (default)
3402 2 or rw to batch both read and write transactions
3403 @end deffn
3404
3405 @deffn {Config Command} {vdebug polling} min max
3406 Takes two values, representing the polling interval in ms. Lower values mean faster
3407 debugger responsiveness, but lower emulation performance. The minimum should be
3408 around 10, maximum should not exceed 1000, which is the default gdb and keepalive
3409 timeout value.
3410 @end deffn
3411
3412 @deffn {Config Command} {vdebug bfm_path} path clk_period
3413 Specifies the hierarchical path and input clk period of the vdebug BFM in the design.
3414 The hierarchical path uses Verilog notation top.inst.inst
3415 The clock period must include the unit, for instance 40ns.
3416 @end deffn
3417
3418 @deffn {Config Command} {vdebug mem_path} path base size
3419 Specifies the hierarchical path to the design memory instance for backdoor access.
3420 Up to 4 memories can be specified. The hierarchical path uses Verilog notation.
3421 The base specifies start address in the design address space, size its size in bytes.
3422 Both values can use hexadecimal notation with prefix 0x.
3423 @end deffn
3424 @end deffn
3425
3426 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jtag_dpi}
3427 SystemVerilog Direct Programming Interface (DPI) compatible driver for
3428 JTAG devices in emulation. The driver acts as a client for the SystemVerilog
3429 DPI server interface.
3430
3431 @deffn {Config Command} {jtag_dpi set_port} port
3432 Specifies the TCP/IP port number of the SystemVerilog DPI server interface.
3433 @end deffn
3434
3435 @deffn {Config Command} {jtag_dpi set_address} address
3436 Specifies the TCP/IP address of the SystemVerilog DPI server interface.
3437 @end deffn
3438 @end deffn
3439
3440
3441 @deffn {Interface Driver} {buspirate}
3442
3443 This driver is for the Bus Pirate (see @url{http://dangerousprototypes.com/docs/Bus_Pirate}) and compatible devices.
3444 It uses a simple data protocol over a serial port connection.
3445
3446 Most hardware development boards have a UART, a real serial port, or a virtual USB serial device, so this driver
3447 allows you to start building your own JTAG adapter without the complexity of a custom USB connection.
3448
3449 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate port} serial_port
3450 Specify the serial port's filename. For example:
3451 @example
3452 buspirate port /dev/ttyUSB0
3453 @end example
3454 @end deffn
3455
3456 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate speed} (normal|fast)
3457 Set the communication speed to 115k (normal) or 1M (fast). For example:
3458 @example
3459 buspirate speed normal
3460 @end example
3461 @end deffn
3462
3463 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate mode} (normal|open-drain)
3464 Set the Bus Pirate output mode.
3465 @itemize @minus
3466 @item In normal mode (push/pull), do not enable the pull-ups, and do not connect I/O header pin VPU to JTAG VREF.
3467 @item In open drain mode, you will then need to enable the pull-ups.
3468 @end itemize
3469 For example:
3470 @example
3471 buspirate mode normal
3472 @end example
3473 @end deffn
3474
3475 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate pullup} (0|1)
3476 Whether to connect (1) or not (0) the I/O header pin VPU (JTAG VREF)
3477 to the pull-up/pull-down resistors on MOSI (JTAG TDI), CLK (JTAG TCK), MISO (JTAG TDO) and CS (JTAG TMS).
3478 For example:
3479 @example
3480 buspirate pullup 0
3481 @end example
3482 @end deffn
3483
3484 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate vreg} (0|1)
3485 Whether to enable (1) or disable (0) the built-in voltage regulator,
3486 which can be used to supply power to a test circuit through
3487 I/O header pins +3V3 and +5V. For example:
3488 @example
3489 buspirate vreg 0
3490 @end example
3491 @end deffn
3492
3493 @deffn {Command} {buspirate led} (0|1)
3494 Turns the Bus Pirate's LED on (1) or off (0). For example:
3495 @end deffn
3496 @example
3497 buspirate led 1
3498 @end example
3499
3500 @end deffn
3501
3502 @deffn {Interface Driver} {esp_usb_jtag}
3503 Espressif JTAG driver to communicate with ESP32-C3, ESP32-S3 chips and ESP USB Bridge board using OpenOCD.
3504 These chips have built-in JTAG circuitry and can be debugged without any additional hardware.
3505 Only an USB cable connected to the D+/D- pins is necessary.
3506
3507 @deffn {Config Command} {espusbjtag tdo}
3508 Returns the current state of the TDO line
3509 @end deffn
3510
3511 @deffn {Config Command} {espusbjtag setio} setio
3512 Manually set the status of the output lines with the order of (tdi tms tck trst srst)
3513 @example
3514 espusbjtag setio 0 1 0 1 0
3515 @end example
3516 @end deffn
3517
3518 @deffn {Config Command} {espusbjtag vid_pid} vid_pid
3519 Set vendor ID and product ID for the ESP usb jtag driver
3520 @example
3521 espusbjtag vid_pid 0x303a 0x1001
3522 @end example
3523 @end deffn
3524
3525 @deffn {Config Command} {espusbjtag caps_descriptor} caps_descriptor
3526 Set the jtag descriptor to read capabilities of ESP usb jtag driver
3527 @example
3528 espusbjtag caps_descriptor 0x2000
3529 @end example
3530 @end deffn
3531
3532 @deffn {Config Command} {espusbjtag chip_id} chip_id
3533 Set chip id to transfer to the ESP USB bridge board
3534 @example
3535 espusbjtag chip_id 1
3536 @end example
3537 @end deffn
3538
3539 @end deffn
3540
3541 @section Transport Configuration
3542 @cindex Transport
3543 As noted earlier, depending on the version of OpenOCD you use,
3544 and the debug adapter you are using,
3545 several transports may be available to
3546 communicate with debug targets (or perhaps to program flash memory).
3547 @deffn {Command} {transport list}
3548 displays the names of the transports supported by this
3549 version of OpenOCD.
3550 @end deffn
3551
3552 @deffn {Command} {transport select} @option{transport_name}
3553 Select which of the supported transports to use in this OpenOCD session.
3554
3555 When invoked with @option{transport_name}, attempts to select the named
3556 transport. The transport must be supported by the debug adapter
3557 hardware and by the version of OpenOCD you are using (including the
3558 adapter's driver).
3559
3560 If no transport has been selected and no @option{transport_name} is
3561 provided, @command{transport select} auto-selects the first transport
3562 supported by the debug adapter.
3563
3564 @command{transport select} always returns the name of the session's selected
3565 transport, if any.
3566 @end deffn
3567
3568 @subsection JTAG Transport
3569 @cindex JTAG
3570 JTAG is the original transport supported by OpenOCD, and most
3571 of the OpenOCD commands support it.
3572 JTAG transports expose a chain of one or more Test Access Points (TAPs),
3573 each of which must be explicitly declared.
3574 JTAG supports both debugging and boundary scan testing.
3575 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3576
3577 JTAG transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3578 jtag}. Unless your adapter uses either @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3579 driver} (in which case the command is @command{transport select hla_jtag})
3580 or @ref{st_link_dap_interface,the st-link interface driver} (in which case
3581 the command is @command{transport select dapdirect_jtag}).
3582
3583 @subsection SWD Transport
3584 @cindex SWD
3585 @cindex Serial Wire Debug
3586 SWD (Serial Wire Debug) is an ARM-specific transport which exposes one
3587 Debug Access Point (DAP, which must be explicitly declared.
3588 (SWD uses fewer signal wires than JTAG.)
3589 SWD is debug-oriented, and does not support boundary scan testing.
3590 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3591 (Some processors support both JTAG and SWD.)
3592
3593 SWD transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3594 swd}. Unless your adapter uses either @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3595 driver} (in which case the command is @command{transport select hla_swd})
3596 or @ref{st_link_dap_interface,the st-link interface driver} (in which case
3597 the command is @command{transport select dapdirect_swd}).
3598
3599 @deffn {Config Command} {swd newdap} ...
3600 Declares a single DAP which uses SWD transport.
3601 Parameters are currently the same as "jtag newtap" but this is
3602 expected to change.
3603 @end deffn
3604
3605 @cindex SWD multi-drop
3606 The newer SWD devices (SW-DP v2 or SWJ-DP v2) support the multi-drop extension
3607 of SWD protocol: two or more devices can be connected to one SWD adapter.
3608 SWD transport works in multi-drop mode if @ref{dap_create,DAP} is configured
3609 with both @code{-dp-id} and @code{-instance-id} parameters regardless how many
3610 DAPs are created.
3611
3612 Not all adapters and adapter drivers support SWD multi-drop. Only the following
3613 adapter drivers are SWD multi-drop capable:
3614 cmsis_dap (use an adapter with CMSIS-DAP version 2.0), ftdi, all bitbang based.
3615
3616 @subsection SPI Transport
3617 @cindex SPI
3618 @cindex Serial Peripheral Interface
3619 The Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) is a general purpose transport
3620 which uses four wire signaling. Some processors use it as part of a
3621 solution for flash programming.
3622
3623 @anchor{swimtransport}
3624 @subsection SWIM Transport
3625 @cindex SWIM
3626 @cindex Single Wire Interface Module
3627 The Single Wire Interface Module (SWIM) is a low-pin-count debug protocol used
3628 by the STMicroelectronics MCU family STM8 and documented in the
3629 @uref{https://www.st.com/resource/en/user_manual/cd00173911.pdf, User Manual UM470}.
3630
3631 SWIM does not support boundary scan testing nor multiple cores.
3632
3633 The SWIM transport is selected with the command @command{transport select swim}.
3634
3635 The concept of TAPs does not fit in the protocol since SWIM does not implement
3636 a scan chain. Nevertheless, the current SW model of OpenOCD requires defining a
3637 virtual SWIM TAP through the command @command{swim newtap basename tap_type}.
3638 The TAP definition must precede the target definition command
3639 @command{target create target_name stm8 -chain-position basename.tap_type}.
3640
3641 @anchor{jtagspeed}
3642 @section JTAG Speed
3643 JTAG clock setup is part of system setup.
3644 It @emph{does not belong with interface setup} since any interface
3645 only knows a few of the constraints for the JTAG clock speed.
3646 Sometimes the JTAG speed is
3647 changed during the target initialization process: (1) slow at
3648 reset, (2) program the CPU clocks, (3) run fast.
3649 Both the "slow" and "fast" clock rates are functions of the
3650 oscillators used, the chip, the board design, and sometimes
3651 power management software that may be active.
3652
3653 The speed used during reset, and the scan chain verification which
3654 follows reset, can be adjusted using a @code{reset-start}
3655 target event handler.
3656 It can then be reconfigured to a faster speed by a
3657 @code{reset-init} target event handler after it reprograms those
3658 CPU clocks, or manually (if something else, such as a boot loader,
3659 sets up those clocks).
3660 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
3661 When the initial low JTAG speed is a chip characteristic, perhaps
3662 because of a required oscillator speed, provide such a handler
3663 in the target config file.
3664 When that speed is a function of a board-specific characteristic
3665 such as which speed oscillator is used, it belongs in the board
3666 config file instead.
3667 In both cases it's safest to also set the initial JTAG clock rate
3668 to that same slow speed, so that OpenOCD never starts up using a
3669 clock speed that's faster than the scan chain can support.
3670
3671 @example
3672 jtag_rclk 3000
3673 $_TARGET.cpu configure -event reset-start @{ jtag_rclk 3000 @}
3674 @end example
3675
3676 If your system supports adaptive clocking (RTCK), configuring
3677 JTAG to use that is probably the most robust approach.
3678 However, it introduces delays to synchronize clocks; so it
3679 may not be the fastest solution.
3680
3681 @b{NOTE:} Script writers should consider using @command{jtag_rclk}
3682 instead of @command{adapter speed}, but only for (ARM) cores and boards
3683 which support adaptive clocking.
3684
3685 @deffn {Command} {adapter speed} max_speed_kHz
3686 A non-zero speed is in KHZ. Hence: 3000 is 3mhz.
3687 JTAG interfaces usually support a limited number of
3688 speeds. The speed actually used won't be faster
3689 than the speed specified.
3690
3691 Chip data sheets generally include a top JTAG clock rate.
3692 The actual rate is often a function of a CPU core clock,
3693 and is normally less than that peak rate.
3694 For example, most ARM cores accept at most one sixth of the CPU clock.
3695
3696 Speed 0 (khz) selects RTCK method.
3697 @xref{faqrtck,,FAQ RTCK}.
3698 If your system uses RTCK, you won't need to change the
3699 JTAG clocking after setup.
3700 Not all interfaces, boards, or targets support ``rtck''.
3701 If the interface device can not
3702 support it, an error is returned when you try to use RTCK.
3703 @end deffn
3704
3705 @defun jtag_rclk fallback_speed_kHz
3706 @cindex adaptive clocking
3707 @cindex RTCK
3708 This Tcl proc (defined in @file{startup.tcl}) attempts to enable RTCK/RCLK.
3709 If that fails (maybe the interface, board, or target doesn't
3710 support it), falls back to the specified frequency.
3711 @example
3712 # Fall back to 3mhz if RTCK is not supported
3713 jtag_rclk 3000
3714 @end example
3715 @end defun
3716
3717 @node Reset Configuration
3718 @chapter Reset Configuration
3719 @cindex Reset Configuration
3720
3721 Every system configuration may require a different reset
3722 configuration. This can also be quite confusing.
3723 Resets also interact with @var{reset-init} event handlers,
3724 which do things like setting up clocks and DRAM, and
3725 JTAG clock rates. (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.)
3726 They can also interact with JTAG routers.
3727 Please see the various board files for examples.
3728
3729 @quotation Note
3730 To maintainers and integrators:
3731 Reset configuration touches several things at once.
3732 Normally the board configuration file
3733 should define it and assume that the JTAG adapter supports
3734 everything that's wired up to the board's JTAG connector.
3735
3736 However, the target configuration file could also make note
3737 of something the silicon vendor has done inside the chip,
3738 which will be true for most (or all) boards using that chip.
3739 And when the JTAG adapter doesn't support everything, the
3740 user configuration file will need to override parts of
3741 the reset configuration provided by other files.
3742 @end quotation
3743
3744 @section Types of Reset
3745
3746 There are many kinds of reset possible through JTAG, but
3747 they may not all work with a given board and adapter.
3748 That's part of why reset configuration can be error prone.
3749
3750 @itemize @bullet
3751 @item
3752 @emph{System Reset} ... the @emph{SRST} hardware signal
3753 resets all chips connected to the JTAG adapter, such as processors,
3754 power management chips, and I/O controllers. Normally resets triggered
3755 with this signal behave exactly like pressing a RESET button.
3756 @item
3757 @emph{JTAG TAP Reset} ... the @emph{TRST} hardware signal resets
3758 just the TAP controllers connected to the JTAG adapter.
3759 Such resets should not be visible to the rest of the system; resetting a
3760 device's TAP controller just puts that controller into a known state.
3761 @item
3762 @emph{Emulation Reset} ... many devices can be reset through JTAG
3763 commands. These resets are often distinguishable from system
3764 resets, either explicitly (a "reset reason" register says so)
3765 or implicitly (not all parts of the chip get reset).
3766 @item
3767 @emph{Other Resets} ... system-on-chip devices often support
3768 several other types of reset.
3769 You may need to arrange that a watchdog timer stops
3770 while debugging, preventing a watchdog reset.
3771 There may be individual module resets.
3772 @end itemize
3773
3774 In the best case, OpenOCD can hold SRST, then reset
3775 the TAPs via TRST and send commands through JTAG to halt the
3776 CPU at the reset vector before the 1st instruction is executed.
3777 Then when it finally releases the SRST signal, the system is
3778 halted under debugger control before any code has executed.
3779 This is the behavior required to support the @command{reset halt}
3780 and @command{reset init} commands; after @command{reset init} a
3781 board-specific script might do things like setting up DRAM.
3782 (@xref{resetcommand,,Reset Command}.)
3783
3784 @anchor{srstandtrstissues}
3785 @section SRST and TRST Issues
3786
3787 Because SRST and TRST are hardware signals, they can have a
3788 variety of system-specific constraints. Some of the most
3789 common issues are:
3790
3791 @itemize @bullet
3792
3793 @item @emph{Signal not available} ... Some boards don't wire
3794 SRST or TRST to the JTAG connector. Some JTAG adapters don't
3795 support such signals even if they are wired up.
3796 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{signals} options to say
3797 when either of those signals is not connected.
3798 When SRST is not available, your code might not be able to rely
3799 on controllers having been fully reset during code startup.
3800 Missing TRST is not a problem, since JTAG-level resets can
3801 be triggered using with TMS signaling.
3802
3803 @item @emph{Signals shorted} ... Sometimes a chip, board, or
3804 adapter will connect SRST to TRST, instead of keeping them separate.
3805 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{combination} options to say
3806 when those signals aren't properly independent.
3807
3808 @item @emph{Timing} ... Reset circuitry like a resistor/capacitor
3809 delay circuit, reset supervisor, or on-chip features can extend
3810 the effect of a JTAG adapter's reset for some time after the adapter
3811 stops issuing the reset. For example, there may be chip or board
3812 requirements that all reset pulses last for at least a
3813 certain amount of time; and reset buttons commonly have
3814 hardware debouncing.
3815 Use the @command{adapter srst delay} and @command{jtag_ntrst_delay}
3816 commands to say when extra delays are needed.
3817
3818 @item @emph{Drive type} ... Reset lines often have a pullup
3819 resistor, letting the JTAG interface treat them as open-drain
3820 signals. But that's not a requirement, so the adapter may need
3821 to use push/pull output drivers.
3822 Also, with weak pullups it may be advisable to drive
3823 signals to both levels (push/pull) to minimize rise times.
3824 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{trst_type} and
3825 @var{srst_type} parameters to say how to drive reset signals.
3826
3827 @item @emph{Special initialization} ... Targets sometimes need
3828 special JTAG initialization sequences to handle chip-specific
3829 issues (not limited to errata).
3830 For example, certain JTAG commands might need to be issued while
3831 the system as a whole is in a reset state (SRST active)
3832 but the JTAG scan chain is usable (TRST inactive).
3833 Many systems treat combined assertion of SRST and TRST as a
3834 trigger for a harder reset than SRST alone.
3835 Such custom reset handling is discussed later in this chapter.
3836 @end itemize
3837
3838 There can also be other issues.
3839 Some devices don't fully conform to the JTAG specifications.
3840 Trivial system-specific differences are common, such as
3841 SRST and TRST using slightly different names.
3842 There are also vendors who distribute key JTAG documentation for
3843 their chips only to developers who have signed a Non-Disclosure
3844 Agreement (NDA).
3845
3846 Sometimes there are chip-specific extensions like a requirement to use
3847 the normally-optional TRST signal (precluding use of JTAG adapters which
3848 don't pass TRST through), or needing extra steps to complete a TAP reset.
3849
3850 In short, SRST and especially TRST handling may be very finicky,
3851 needing to cope with both architecture and board specific constraints.
3852
3853 @section Commands for Handling Resets
3854
3855 @deffn {Command} {adapter srst pulse_width} milliseconds
3856 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3857 after asserting nSRST (active-low system reset) before
3858 allowing it to be deasserted.
3859 @end deffn
3860
3861 @deffn {Command} {adapter srst delay} milliseconds
3862 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3863 nSRST (active-low system reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3864 When a board has a reset button connected to SRST line it will
3865 probably have hardware debouncing, implying you should use this.
3866 @end deffn
3867
3868 @deffn {Command} {jtag_ntrst_assert_width} milliseconds
3869 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3870 after asserting nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before
3871 allowing it to be deasserted.
3872 @end deffn
3873
3874 @deffn {Command} {jtag_ntrst_delay} milliseconds
3875 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3876 nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3877 @end deffn
3878
3879 @anchor{reset_config}
3880 @deffn {Command} {reset_config} mode_flag ...
3881 This command displays or modifies the reset configuration
3882 of your combination of JTAG board and target in target
3883 configuration scripts.
3884
3885 Information earlier in this section describes the kind of problems
3886 the command is intended to address (@pxref{srstandtrstissues,,SRST and TRST Issues}).
3887 As a rule this command belongs only in board config files,
3888 describing issues like @emph{board doesn't connect TRST};
3889 or in user config files, addressing limitations derived
3890 from a particular combination of interface and board.
3891 (An unlikely example would be using a TRST-only adapter
3892 with a board that only wires up SRST.)
3893
3894 The @var{mode_flag} options can be specified in any order, but only one
3895 of each type -- @var{signals}, @var{combination}, @var{gates},
3896 @var{trst_type}, @var{srst_type} and @var{connect_type}
3897 -- may be specified at a time.
3898 If you don't provide a new value for a given type, its previous
3899 value (perhaps the default) is unchanged.
3900 For example, this means that you don't need to say anything at all about
3901 TRST just to declare that if the JTAG adapter should want to drive SRST,
3902 it must explicitly be driven high (@option{srst_push_pull}).
3903
3904 @itemize
3905 @item
3906 @var{signals} can specify which of the reset signals are connected.
3907 For example, If the JTAG interface provides SRST, but the board doesn't
3908 connect that signal properly, then OpenOCD can't use it.
3909 Possible values are @option{none} (the default), @option{trst_only},
3910 @option{srst_only} and @option{trst_and_srst}.
3911
3912 @quotation Tip
3913 If your board provides SRST and/or TRST through the JTAG connector,
3914 you must declare that so those signals can be used.
3915 @end quotation
3916
3917 @item
3918 The @var{combination} is an optional value specifying broken reset
3919 signal implementations.
3920 The default behaviour if no option given is @option{separate},
3921 indicating everything behaves normally.
3922 @option{srst_pulls_trst} states that the
3923 test logic is reset together with the reset of the system (e.g. NXP
3924 LPC2000, "broken" board layout), @option{trst_pulls_srst} says that
3925 the system is reset together with the test logic (only hypothetical, I
3926 haven't seen hardware with such a bug, and can be worked around).
3927 @option{combined} implies both @option{srst_pulls_trst} and
3928 @option{trst_pulls_srst}.
3929
3930 @item
3931 The @var{gates} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3932 JTAG may be unavailable during reset.
3933 @option{srst_gates_jtag} (default)
3934 indicates that asserting SRST gates the
3935 JTAG clock. This means that no communication can happen on JTAG
3936 while SRST is asserted.
3937 Its converse is @option{srst_nogate}, indicating that JTAG commands
3938 can safely be issued while SRST is active.
3939
3940 @item
3941 The @var{connect_type} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3942 SRST is asserted while connecting to the target. @option{srst_nogate}
3943 is required to use this option.
3944 @option{connect_deassert_srst} (default)
3945 indicates that SRST will not be asserted while connecting to the target.
3946 Its converse is @option{connect_assert_srst}, indicating that SRST will
3947 be asserted before any target connection.
3948 Only some targets support this feature, STM32 and STR9 are examples.
3949 This feature is useful if you are unable to connect to your target due
3950 to incorrect options byte config or illegal program execution.
3951 @end itemize
3952
3953 The optional @var{trst_type} and @var{srst_type} parameters allow the
3954 driver mode of each reset line to be specified. These values only affect
3955 JTAG interfaces with support for different driver modes, like the Amontec
3956 JTAGkey and JTAG Accelerator. Also, they are necessarily ignored if the
3957 relevant signal (TRST or SRST) is not connected.
3958
3959 @itemize
3960 @item
3961 Possible @var{trst_type} driver modes for the test reset signal (TRST)
3962 are the default @option{trst_push_pull}, and @option{trst_open_drain}.
3963 Most boards connect this signal to a pulldown, so the JTAG TAPs
3964 never leave reset unless they are hooked up to a JTAG adapter.
3965
3966 @item
3967 Possible @var{srst_type} driver modes for the system reset signal (SRST)
3968 are the default @option{srst_open_drain}, and @option{srst_push_pull}.
3969 Most boards connect this signal to a pullup, and allow the
3970 signal to be pulled low by various events including system
3971 power-up and pressing a reset button.
3972 @end itemize
3973 @end deffn
3974
3975 @section Custom Reset Handling
3976 @cindex events
3977
3978 OpenOCD has several ways to help support the various reset
3979 mechanisms provided by chip and board vendors.
3980 The commands shown in the previous section give standard parameters.
3981 There are also @emph{event handlers} associated with TAPs or Targets.
3982 Those handlers are Tcl procedures you can provide, which are invoked
3983 at particular points in the reset sequence.
3984
3985 @emph{When SRST is not an option} you must set
3986 up a @code{reset-assert} event handler for your target.
3987 For example, some JTAG adapters don't include the SRST signal;
3988 and some boards have multiple targets, and you won't always
3989 want to reset everything at once.
3990
3991 After configuring those mechanisms, you might still
3992 find your board doesn't start up or reset correctly.
3993 For example, maybe it needs a slightly different sequence
3994 of SRST and/or TRST manipulations, because of quirks that
3995 the @command{reset_config} mechanism doesn't address;
3996 or asserting both might trigger a stronger reset, which
3997 needs special attention.
3998
3999 Experiment with lower level operations, such as
4000 @command{adapter assert}, @command{adapter deassert}
4001 and the @command{jtag arp_*} operations shown here,
4002 to find a sequence of operations that works.
4003 @xref{JTAG Commands}.
4004 When you find a working sequence, it can be used to override
4005 @command{jtag_init}, which fires during OpenOCD startup
4006 (@pxref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage});
4007 or @command{init_reset}, which fires during reset processing.
4008
4009 You might also want to provide some project-specific reset
4010 schemes. For example, on a multi-target board the standard
4011 @command{reset} command would reset all targets, but you
4012 may need the ability to reset only one target at time and
4013 thus want to avoid using the board-wide SRST signal.
4014
4015 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} {init_reset} mode
4016 This is invoked near the beginning of the @command{reset} command,
4017 usually to provide as much of a cold (power-up) reset as practical.
4018 By default it is also invoked from @command{jtag_init} if
4019 the scan chain does not respond to pure JTAG operations.
4020 The @var{mode} parameter is the parameter given to the
4021 low level reset command (@option{halt},
4022 @option{init}, or @option{run}), @option{setup},
4023 or potentially some other value.
4024
4025 The default implementation just invokes @command{jtag arp_init-reset}.
4026 Replacements will normally build on low level JTAG
4027 operations such as @command{adapter assert} and @command{adapter deassert}.
4028 Operations here must not address individual TAPs
4029 (or their associated targets)
4030 until the JTAG scan chain has first been verified to work.
4031
4032 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
4033 they return.
4034 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
4035 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
4036 @end deffn
4037
4038 @deffn {Command} {jtag arp_init}
4039 This validates the scan chain using just the four
4040 standard JTAG signals (TMS, TCK, TDI, TDO).
4041 It starts by issuing a JTAG-only reset.
4042 Then it performs checks to verify that the scan chain configuration
4043 matches the TAPs it can observe.
4044 Those checks include checking IDCODE values for each active TAP,
4045 and verifying the length of their instruction registers using
4046 TAP @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} values.
4047 If these tests all pass, TAP @code{setup} events are
4048 issued to all TAPs with handlers for that event.
4049 @end deffn
4050
4051 @deffn {Command} {jtag arp_init-reset}
4052 This uses TRST and SRST to try resetting
4053 everything on the JTAG scan chain
4054 (and anything else connected to SRST).
4055 It then invokes the logic of @command{jtag arp_init}.
4056 @end deffn
4057
4058
4059 @node TAP Declaration
4060 @chapter TAP Declaration
4061 @cindex TAP declaration
4062 @cindex TAP configuration
4063
4064 @emph{Test Access Ports} (TAPs) are the core of JTAG.
4065 TAPs serve many roles, including:
4066
4067 @itemize @bullet
4068 @item @b{Debug Target} A CPU TAP can be used as a GDB debug target.
4069 @item @b{Flash Programming} Some chips program the flash directly via JTAG.
4070 Others do it indirectly, making a CPU do it.
4071 @item @b{Program Download} Using the same CPU support GDB uses,
4072 you can initialize a DRAM controller, download code to DRAM, and then
4073 start running that code.
4074 @item @b{Boundary Scan} Most chips support boundary scan, which
4075 helps test for board assembly problems like solder bridges
4076 and missing connections.
4077 @end itemize
4078
4079 OpenOCD must know about the active TAPs on your board(s).
4080 Setting up the TAPs is the core task of your configuration files.
4081 Once those TAPs are set up, you can pass their names to code
4082 which sets up CPUs and exports them as GDB targets,
4083 probes flash memory, performs low-level JTAG operations, and more.
4084
4085 @section Scan Chains
4086 @cindex scan chain
4087
4088 TAPs are part of a hardware @dfn{scan chain},
4089 which is a daisy chain of TAPs.
4090 They also need to be added to
4091 OpenOCD's software mirror of that hardware list,
4092 giving each member a name and associating other data with it.
4093 Simple scan chains, with a single TAP, are common in
4094 systems with a single microcontroller or microprocessor.
4095 More complex chips may have several TAPs internally.
4096 Very complex scan chains might have a dozen or more TAPs:
4097 several in one chip, more in the next, and connecting
4098 to other boards with their own chips and TAPs.
4099
4100 You can display the list with the @command{scan_chain} command.
4101 (Don't confuse this with the list displayed by the @command{targets}
4102 command, presented in the next chapter.
4103 That only displays TAPs for CPUs which are configured as
4104 debugging targets.)
4105 Here's what the scan chain might look like for a chip more than one TAP:
4106
4107 @verbatim
4108 TapName Enabled IdCode Expected IrLen IrCap IrMask
4109 -- ------------------ ------- ---------- ---------- ----- ----- ------
4110 0 omap5912.dsp Y 0x03df1d81 0x03df1d81 38 0x01 0x03
4111 1 omap5912.arm Y 0x0692602f 0x0692602f 4 0x01 0x0f
4112 2 omap5912.unknown Y 0x00000000 0x00000000 8 0x01 0x03
4113 @end verbatim
4114
4115 OpenOCD can detect some of that information, but not all
4116 of it. @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
4117 Unfortunately, those TAPs can't always be autoconfigured,
4118 because not all devices provide good support for that.
4119 JTAG doesn't require supporting IDCODE instructions, and
4120 chips with JTAG routers may not link TAPs into the chain
4121 until they are told to do so.
4122
4123 The configuration mechanism currently supported by OpenOCD
4124 requires explicit configuration of all TAP devices using
4125 @command{jtag newtap} commands, as detailed later in this chapter.
4126 A command like this would declare one tap and name it @code{chip1.cpu}:
4127
4128 @example
4129 jtag newtap chip1 cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id 0x3ba00477
4130 @end example
4131
4132 Each target configuration file lists the TAPs provided
4133 by a given chip.
4134 Board configuration files combine all the targets on a board,
4135 and so forth.
4136 Note that @emph{the order in which TAPs are declared is very important.}
4137 That declaration order must match the order in the JTAG scan chain,
4138 both inside a single chip and between them.
4139 @xref{faqtaporder,,FAQ TAP Order}.
4140
4141 For example, the STMicroelectronics STR912 chip has
4142 three separate TAPs@footnote{See the ST
4143 document titled: @emph{STR91xFAxxx, Section 3.15 Jtag Interface, Page:
4144 28/102, Figure 3: JTAG chaining inside the STR91xFA}.
4145 @url{http://eu.st.com/stonline/products/literature/ds/13495.pdf}}.
4146 To configure those taps, @file{target/str912.cfg}
4147 includes commands something like this:
4148
4149 @example
4150 jtag newtap str912 flash ... params ...
4151 jtag newtap str912 cpu ... params ...
4152 jtag newtap str912 bs ... params ...
4153 @end example
4154
4155 Actual config files typically use a variable such as @code{$_CHIPNAME}
4156 instead of literals like @option{str912}, to support more than one chip
4157 of each type. @xref{Config File Guidelines}.
4158
4159 @deffn {Command} {jtag names}
4160 Returns the names of all current TAPs in the scan chain.
4161 Use @command{jtag cget} or @command{jtag tapisenabled}
4162 to examine attributes and state of each TAP.
4163 @example
4164 foreach t [jtag names] @{
4165 puts [format "TAP: %s\n" $t]
4166 @}
4167 @end example
4168 @end deffn
4169
4170 @deffn {Command} {scan_chain}
4171 Displays the TAPs in the scan chain configuration,
4172 and their status.
4173 The set of TAPs listed by this command is fixed by
4174 exiting the OpenOCD configuration stage,
4175 but systems with a JTAG router can
4176 enable or disable TAPs dynamically.
4177 @end deffn
4178
4179 @c FIXME! "jtag cget" should be able to return all TAP
4180 @c attributes, like "$target_name cget" does for targets.
4181
4182 @c Probably want "jtag eventlist", and a "tap-reset" event
4183 @c (on entry to RESET state).
4184
4185 @section TAP Names
4186 @cindex dotted name
4187
4188 When TAP objects are declared with @command{jtag newtap},
4189 a @dfn{dotted.name} is created for the TAP, combining the
4190 name of a module (usually a chip) and a label for the TAP.
4191 For example: @code{xilinx.tap}, @code{str912.flash},
4192 @code{omap3530.jrc}, @code{dm6446.dsp}, or @code{stm32.cpu}.
4193 Many other commands use that dotted.name to manipulate or
4194 refer to the TAP. For example, CPU configuration uses the
4195 name, as does declaration of NAND or NOR flash banks.
4196
4197 The components of a dotted name should follow ``C'' symbol
4198 name rules: start with an alphabetic character, then numbers
4199 and underscores are OK; while others (including dots!) are not.
4200
4201 @section TAP Declaration Commands
4202
4203 @deffn {Config Command} {jtag newtap} chipname tapname configparams...
4204 Declares a new TAP with the dotted name @var{chipname}.@var{tapname},
4205 and configured according to the various @var{configparams}.
4206
4207 The @var{chipname} is a symbolic name for the chip.
4208 Conventionally target config files use @code{$_CHIPNAME},
4209 defaulting to the model name given by the chip vendor but
4210 overridable.
4211
4212 @cindex TAP naming convention
4213 The @var{tapname} reflects the role of that TAP,
4214 and should follow this convention:
4215
4216 @itemize @bullet
4217 @item @code{bs} -- For boundary scan if this is a separate TAP;
4218 @item @code{cpu} -- The main CPU of the chip, alternatively
4219 @code{arm} and @code{dsp} on chips with both ARM and DSP CPUs,
4220 @code{arm1} and @code{arm2} on chips with two ARMs, and so forth;
4221 @item @code{etb} -- For an embedded trace buffer (example: an ARM ETB11);
4222 @item @code{flash} -- If the chip has a flash TAP, like the str912;
4223 @item @code{jrc} -- For JTAG route controller (example: the ICEPick modules
4224 on many Texas Instruments chips, like the OMAP3530 on Beagleboards);
4225 @item @code{tap} -- Should be used only for FPGA- or CPLD-like devices
4226 with a single TAP;
4227 @item @code{unknownN} -- If you have no idea what the TAP is for (N is a number);
4228 @item @emph{when in doubt} -- Use the chip maker's name in their data sheet.
4229 For example, the Freescale i.MX31 has a SDMA (Smart DMA) with
4230 a JTAG TAP; that TAP should be named @code{sdma}.
4231 @end itemize
4232
4233 Every TAP requires at least the following @var{configparams}:
4234
4235 @itemize @bullet
4236 @item @code{-irlen} @var{NUMBER}
4237 @*The length in bits of the
4238 instruction register, such as 4 or 5 bits.
4239 @end itemize
4240
4241 A TAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
4242
4243 @itemize @bullet
4244 @item @code{-disable} (or @code{-enable})
4245 @*Use the @code{-disable} parameter to flag a TAP which is not
4246 linked into the scan chain after a reset using either TRST
4247 or the JTAG state machine's @sc{reset} state.
4248 You may use @code{-enable} to highlight the default state
4249 (the TAP is linked in).
4250 @xref{enablinganddisablingtaps,,Enabling and Disabling TAPs}.
4251 @item @code{-expected-id} @var{NUMBER}
4252 @*A non-zero @var{number} represents a 32-bit IDCODE
4253 which you expect to find when the scan chain is examined.
4254 These codes are not required by all JTAG devices.
4255 @emph{Repeat the option} as many times as required if more than one
4256 ID code could appear (for example, multiple versions).
4257 Specify @var{number} as zero to suppress warnings about IDCODE
4258 values that were found but not included in the list.
4259
4260 Provide this value if at all possible, since it lets OpenOCD
4261 tell when the scan chain it sees isn't right. These values
4262 are provided in vendors' chip documentation, usually a technical
4263 reference manual. Sometimes you may need to probe the JTAG
4264 hardware to find these values.
4265 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
4266 @item @code{-ignore-version}
4267 @*Specify this to ignore the JTAG version field in the @code{-expected-id}
4268 option. When vendors put out multiple versions of a chip, or use the same
4269 JTAG-level ID for several largely-compatible chips, it may be more practical
4270 to ignore the version field than to update config files to handle all of
4271 the various chip IDs. The version field is defined as bit 28-31 of the IDCODE.
4272 @item @code{-ignore-bypass}
4273 @*Specify this to ignore the 'bypass' bit of the idcode. Some vendor put
4274 an invalid idcode regarding this bit. Specify this to ignore this bit and
4275 to not consider this tap in bypass mode.
4276 @item @code{-ircapture} @var{NUMBER}
4277 @*The bit pattern loaded by the TAP into the JTAG shift register
4278 on entry to the @sc{ircapture} state, such as 0x01.
4279 JTAG requires the two LSBs of this value to be 01.
4280 By default, @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} are set
4281 up to verify that two-bit value. You may provide
4282 additional bits if you know them, or indicate that
4283 a TAP doesn't conform to the JTAG specification.
4284 @item @code{-irmask} @var{NUMBER}
4285 @*A mask used with @code{-ircapture}
4286 to verify that instruction scans work correctly.
4287 Such scans are not used by OpenOCD except to verify that
4288 there seems to be no problems with JTAG scan chain operations.
4289 @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
4290 @*Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
4291 register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
4292 This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
4293 devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
4294 @end itemize
4295 @end deffn
4296
4297 @section Other TAP commands
4298
4299 @deffn {Command} {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-idcode}
4300 Get the value of the IDCODE found in hardware.
4301 @end deffn
4302
4303 @deffn {Command} {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name
4304 @deffnx {Command} {jtag configure} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name handler
4305 At this writing this TAP attribute
4306 mechanism is limited and used mostly for event handling.
4307 (It is not a direct analogue of the @code{cget}/@code{configure}
4308 mechanism for debugger targets.)
4309 See the next section for information about the available events.
4310
4311 The @code{configure} subcommand assigns an event handler,
4312 a TCL string which is evaluated when the event is triggered.
4313 The @code{cget} subcommand returns that handler.
4314 @end deffn
4315
4316 @section TAP Events
4317 @cindex events
4318 @cindex TAP events
4319
4320 OpenOCD includes two event mechanisms.
4321 The one presented here applies to all JTAG TAPs.
4322 The other applies to debugger targets,
4323 which are associated with certain TAPs.
4324
4325 The TAP events currently defined are:
4326
4327 @itemize @bullet
4328 @item @b{post-reset}
4329 @* The TAP has just completed a JTAG reset.
4330 The tap may still be in the JTAG @sc{reset} state.
4331 Handlers for these events might perform initialization sequences
4332 such as issuing TCK cycles, TMS sequences to ensure
4333 exit from the ARM SWD mode, and more.
4334
4335 Because the scan chain has not yet been verified, handlers for these events
4336 @emph{should not issue commands which scan the JTAG IR or DR registers}
4337 of any particular target.
4338 @b{NOTE:} As this is written (September 2009), nothing prevents such access.
4339 @item @b{setup}
4340 @* The scan chain has been reset and verified.
4341 This handler may enable TAPs as needed.
4342 @item @b{tap-disable}
4343 @* The TAP needs to be disabled. This handler should
4344 implement @command{jtag tapdisable}
4345 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
4346 @item @b{tap-enable}
4347 @* The TAP needs to be enabled. This handler should
4348 implement @command{jtag tapenable}
4349 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
4350 @end itemize
4351
4352 If you need some action after each JTAG reset which isn't actually
4353 specific to any TAP (since you can't yet trust the scan chain's
4354 contents to be accurate), you might:
4355
4356 @example
4357 jtag configure CHIP.jrc -event post-reset @{
4358 echo "JTAG Reset done"
4359 ... non-scan jtag operations to be done after reset
4360 @}
4361 @end example
4362
4363
4364 @anchor{enablinganddisablingtaps}
4365 @section Enabling and Disabling TAPs
4366 @cindex JTAG Route Controller
4367 @cindex jrc
4368
4369 In some systems, a @dfn{JTAG Route Controller} (JRC)
4370 is used to enable and/or disable specific JTAG TAPs.
4371 Many ARM-based chips from Texas Instruments include
4372 an ``ICEPick'' module, which is a JRC.
4373 Such chips include DaVinci and OMAP3 processors.
4374
4375 A given TAP may not be visible until the JRC has been
4376 told to link it into the scan chain; and if the JRC
4377 has been told to unlink that TAP, it will no longer
4378 be visible.
4379 Such routers address problems that JTAG ``bypass mode''
4380 ignores, such as:
4381
4382 @itemize
4383 @item The scan chain can only go as fast as its slowest TAP.
4384 @item Having many TAPs slows instruction scans, since all
4385 TAPs receive new instructions.
4386 @item TAPs in the scan chain must be powered up, which wastes
4387 power and prevents debugging some power management mechanisms.
4388 @end itemize
4389
4390 The IEEE 1149.1 JTAG standard has no concept of a ``disabled'' tap,
4391 as implied by the existence of JTAG routers.
4392 However, the upcoming IEEE 1149.7 framework (layered on top of JTAG)
4393 does include a kind of JTAG router functionality.
4394
4395 @c (a) currently the event handlers don't seem to be able to
4396 @c fail in a way that could lead to no-change-of-state.
4397
4398 In OpenOCD, tap enabling/disabling is invoked by the Tcl commands
4399 shown below, and is implemented using TAP event handlers.
4400 So for example, when defining a TAP for a CPU connected to
4401 a JTAG router, your @file{target.cfg} file
4402 should define TAP event handlers using
4403 code that looks something like this:
4404
4405 @example
4406 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-enable @{
4407 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
4408 @}
4409 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-disable @{
4410 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
4411 @}
4412 @end example
4413
4414 Then you might want that CPU's TAP enabled almost all the time:
4415
4416 @example
4417 jtag configure $CHIP.jrc -event setup "jtag tapenable $CHIP.cpu"
4418 @end example
4419
4420 Note how that particular setup event handler declaration
4421 uses quotes to evaluate @code{$CHIP} when the event is configured.
4422 Using brackets @{ @} would cause it to be evaluated later,
4423 at runtime, when it might have a different value.
4424
4425 @deffn {Command} {jtag tapdisable} dotted.name
4426 If necessary, disables the tap
4427 by sending it a @option{tap-disable} event.
4428 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4429 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4430 and "0" if it is disabled.
4431 @end deffn
4432
4433 @deffn {Command} {jtag tapenable} dotted.name
4434 If necessary, enables the tap
4435 by sending it a @option{tap-enable} event.
4436 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4437 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4438 and "0" if it is disabled.
4439 @end deffn
4440
4441 @deffn {Command} {jtag tapisenabled} dotted.name
4442 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4443 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4444 and "0" if it is disabled.
4445
4446 @quotation Note
4447 Humans will find the @command{scan_chain} command more helpful
4448 for querying the state of the JTAG taps.
4449 @end quotation
4450 @end deffn
4451
4452 @anchor{autoprobing}
4453 @section Autoprobing
4454 @cindex autoprobe
4455 @cindex JTAG autoprobe
4456
4457 TAP configuration is the first thing that needs to be done
4458 after interface and reset configuration. Sometimes it's
4459 hard finding out what TAPs exist, or how they are identified.
4460 Vendor documentation is not always easy to find and use.
4461
4462 To help you get past such problems, OpenOCD has a limited
4463 @emph{autoprobing} ability to look at the scan chain, doing
4464 a @dfn{blind interrogation} and then reporting the TAPs it finds.
4465 To use this mechanism, start the OpenOCD server with only data
4466 that configures your JTAG interface, and arranges to come up
4467 with a slow clock (many devices don't support fast JTAG clocks
4468 right when they come out of reset).
4469
4470 For example, your @file{openocd.cfg} file might have:
4471
4472 @example
4473 source [find interface/olimex-arm-usb-tiny-h.cfg]
4474 reset_config trst_and_srst
4475 jtag_rclk 8
4476 @end example
4477
4478 When you start the server without any TAPs configured, it will
4479 attempt to autoconfigure the TAPs. There are two parts to this:
4480
4481 @enumerate
4482 @item @emph{TAP discovery} ...
4483 After a JTAG reset (sometimes a system reset may be needed too),
4484 each TAP's data registers will hold the contents of either the
4485 IDCODE or BYPASS register.
4486 If JTAG communication is working, OpenOCD will see each TAP,
4487 and report what @option{-expected-id} to use with it.
4488 @item @emph{IR Length discovery} ...
4489 Unfortunately JTAG does not provide a reliable way to find out
4490 the value of the @option{-irlen} parameter to use with a TAP
4491 that is discovered.
4492 If OpenOCD can discover the length of a TAP's instruction
4493 register, it will report it.
4494 Otherwise you may need to consult vendor documentation, such
4495 as chip data sheets or BSDL files.
4496 @end enumerate
4497
4498 In many cases your board will have a simple scan chain with just
4499 a single device. Here's what OpenOCD reported with one board
4500 that's a bit more complex:
4501
4502 @example
4503 clock speed 8 kHz
4504 There are no enabled taps. AUTO PROBING MIGHT NOT WORK!!
4505 AUTO auto0.tap - use "jtag newtap auto0 tap -expected-id 0x2b900f0f ..."
4506 AUTO auto1.tap - use "jtag newtap auto1 tap -expected-id 0x07926001 ..."
4507 AUTO auto2.tap - use "jtag newtap auto2 tap -expected-id 0x0b73b02f ..."
4508 AUTO auto0.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4509 AUTO auto1.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4510 AUTO auto2.tap - use "... -irlen 6"
4511 no gdb ports allocated as no target has been specified
4512 @end example
4513
4514 Given that information, you should be able to either find some existing
4515 config files to use, or create your own. If you create your own, you
4516 would configure from the bottom up: first a @file{target.cfg} file
4517 with these TAPs, any targets associated with them, and any on-chip
4518 resources; then a @file{board.cfg} with off-chip resources, clocking,
4519 and so forth.
4520
4521 @anchor{dapdeclaration}
4522 @section DAP declaration (ARMv6-M, ARMv7 and ARMv8 targets)
4523 @cindex DAP declaration
4524
4525 Since OpenOCD version 0.11.0, the Debug Access Port (DAP) is
4526 no longer implicitly created together with the target. It must be
4527 explicitly declared using the @command{dap create} command. For all ARMv6-M, ARMv7
4528 and ARMv8 targets, the option "@option{-dap} @var{dap_name}" has to be used
4529 instead of "@option{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name}" when the target is created.
4530
4531 The @command{dap} command group supports the following sub-commands:
4532
4533 @anchor{dap_create}
4534 @deffn {Command} {dap create} dap_name @option{-chain-position} dotted.name configparams...
4535 Declare a DAP instance named @var{dap_name} linked to the JTAG tap
4536 @var{dotted.name}. This also creates a new command (@command{dap_name})
4537 which is used for various purposes including additional configuration.
4538 There can only be one DAP for each JTAG tap in the system.
4539
4540 A DAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
4541
4542 @itemize @bullet
4543 @item @code{-adiv5}
4544 Specify that it's an ADIv5 DAP. This is the default if not specified.
4545 @item @code{-adiv6}
4546 Specify that it's an ADIv6 DAP.
4547 @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
4548 Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
4549 register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
4550 This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
4551 devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
4552
4553 @item @code{-dp-id} @var{number}
4554 @*Debug port identification number for SWD DPv2 multidrop.
4555 The @var{number} is written to bits 0..27 of DP TARGETSEL during DP selection.
4556 To find the id number of a single connected device read DP TARGETID:
4557 @code{device.dap dpreg 0x24}
4558 Use bits 0..27 of TARGETID.
4559
4560 @item @code{-instance-id} @var{number}
4561 @*Instance identification number for SWD DPv2 multidrop.
4562 The @var{number} is written to bits 28..31 of DP TARGETSEL during DP selection.
4563 To find the instance number of a single connected device read DP DLPIDR:
4564 @code{device.dap dpreg 0x34}
4565 The instance number is in bits 28..31 of DLPIDR value.
4566 @end itemize
4567 @end deffn
4568
4569 @deffn {Command} {dap names}
4570 This command returns a list of all registered DAP objects. It it useful mainly
4571 for TCL scripting.
4572 @end deffn
4573
4574 @deffn {Command} {dap info} [@var{num}|@option{root}]
4575 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4576 defaulting to the currently selected AP of the currently selected target.
4577 On ADIv5 DAP @var{num} is the numeric index of the AP.
4578 On ADIv6 DAP @var{num} is the base address of the AP.
4579 With ADIv6 only, @option{root} specifies the root ROM table.
4580 @end deffn
4581
4582 @deffn {Command} {dap init}
4583 Initialize all registered DAPs. This command is used internally
4584 during initialization. It can be issued at any time after the
4585 initialization, too.
4586 @end deffn
4587
4588 The following commands exist as subcommands of DAP instances:
4589
4590 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name info} [@var{num}|@option{root}]
4591 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4592 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4593 On ADIv5 DAP @var{num} is the numeric index of the AP.
4594 On ADIv6 DAP @var{num} is the base address of the AP.
4595 With ADIv6 only, @option{root} specifies the root ROM table.
4596 @end deffn
4597
4598 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apid} [num]
4599 Displays ID register from AP @var{num}, defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4600 On ADIv5 DAP @var{num} is the numeric index of the AP.
4601 On ADIv6 DAP @var{num} is the base address of the AP.
4602 @end deffn
4603
4604 @anchor{DAP subcommand apreg}
4605 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apreg} ap_num reg [value]
4606 Displays content of a register @var{reg} from AP @var{ap_num}
4607 or set a new value @var{value}.
4608 On ADIv5 DAP @var{ap_num} is the numeric index of the AP.
4609 On ADIv6 DAP @var{ap_num} is the base address of the AP.
4610 @var{reg} is byte address of a word register, 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
4611 @end deffn
4612
4613 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apsel} [num]
4614 Select AP @var{num}, defaulting to 0.
4615 On ADIv5 DAP @var{num} is the numeric index of the AP.
4616 On ADIv6 DAP @var{num} is the base address of the AP.
4617 @end deffn
4618
4619 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name dpreg} reg [value]
4620 Displays the content of DP register at address @var{reg}, or set it to a new
4621 value @var{value}.
4622
4623 In case of SWD, @var{reg} is a value in packed format
4624 @math{dpbanksel << 4 | addr} and assumes values 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
4625 In case of JTAG it only assumes values 0, 4, 8 and 0xc.
4626
4627 @emph{Note:} Consider using @command{poll off} to avoid any disturbing
4628 background activity by OpenOCD while you are operating at such low-level.
4629 @end deffn
4630
4631 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name baseaddr} [num]
4632 Displays debug base address from MEM-AP @var{num},
4633 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4634 On ADIv5 DAP @var{num} is the numeric index of the AP.
4635 On ADIv6 DAP @var{num} is the base address of the AP.
4636 @end deffn
4637
4638 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name memaccess} [value]
4639 Displays the number of extra tck cycles in the JTAG idle to use for MEM-AP
4640 memory bus access [0-255], giving additional time to respond to reads.
4641 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
4642 @end deffn
4643
4644 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apcsw} [value [mask]]
4645 Displays or changes CSW bit pattern for MEM-AP transfers.
4646
4647 At the begin of each memory access the CSW pattern is extended (bitwise or-ed)
4648 by @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} bit-fields according to transfer requirements
4649 and the result is written to the real CSW register. All bits except dynamically
4650 updated fields @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} can be changed by changing
4651 the CSW pattern. Refer to ARM ADI v5 manual chapter 7.6.4 and appendix A
4652 for details.
4653
4654 Use @var{value} only syntax if you want to set the new CSW pattern as a whole.
4655 The example sets HPROT1 bit (required by Cortex-M) and clears the rest of
4656 the pattern:
4657 @example
4658 kx.dap apcsw 0x2000000
4659 @end example
4660
4661 If @var{mask} is also used, the CSW pattern is changed only on bit positions
4662 where the mask bit is 1. The following example sets HPROT3 (cacheable)
4663 and leaves the rest of the pattern intact. It configures memory access through
4664 DCache on Cortex-M7.
4665 @example
4666 set CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE [expr @{1 << 27@}]
4667 samv.dap apcsw $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE
4668 @end example
4669
4670 Another example clears SPROT bit and leaves the rest of pattern intact:
4671 @example
4672 set CSW_SPROT [expr @{1 << 30@}]
4673 samv.dap apcsw 0 $CSW_SPROT
4674 @end example
4675
4676 @emph{Note:} If you want to check the real value of CSW, not CSW pattern, use
4677 @code{xxx.dap apreg 0}. @xref{DAP subcommand apreg,,}.
4678
4679 @emph{Warning:} Some of the CSW bits are vital for working memory transfer.
4680 If you set a wrong CSW pattern and MEM-AP stopped working, use the following
4681 example with a proper dap name:
4682 @example
4683 xxx.dap apcsw default
4684 @end example
4685 @end deffn
4686
4687 @deffn {Config Command} {$dap_name ti_be_32_quirks} [@option{enable}]
4688 Set/get quirks mode for TI TMS450/TMS570 processors
4689 Disabled by default
4690 @end deffn
4691
4692 @deffn {Config Command} {$dap_name nu_npcx_quirks} [@option{enable}]
4693 Set/get quirks mode for Nuvoton NPCX/NPCD MCU families
4694 Disabled by default
4695 @end deffn
4696
4697 @node CPU Configuration
4698 @chapter CPU Configuration
4699 @cindex GDB target
4700
4701 This chapter discusses how to set up GDB debug targets for CPUs.
4702 You can also access these targets without GDB
4703 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands},
4704 and @ref{targetstatehandling,,Target State handling}) and
4705 through various kinds of NAND and NOR flash commands.
4706 If you have multiple CPUs you can have multiple such targets.
4707
4708 We'll start by looking at how to examine the targets you have,
4709 then look at how to add one more target and how to configure it.
4710
4711 @section Target List
4712 @cindex target, current
4713 @cindex target, list
4714
4715 All targets that have been set up are part of a list,
4716 where each member has a name.
4717 That name should normally be the same as the TAP name.
4718 You can display the list with the @command{targets}
4719 (plural!) command.
4720 This display often has only one CPU; here's what it might
4721 look like with more than one:
4722 @verbatim
4723 TargetName Type Endian TapName State
4724 -- ------------------ ---------- ------ ------------------ ------------
4725 0* at91rm9200.cpu arm920t little at91rm9200.cpu running
4726 1 MyTarget cortex_m little mychip.foo tap-disabled
4727 @end verbatim
4728
4729 One member of that list is the @dfn{current target}, which
4730 is implicitly referenced by many commands.
4731 It's the one marked with a @code{*} near the target name.
4732 In particular, memory addresses often refer to the address
4733 space seen by that current target.
4734 Commands like @command{mdw} (memory display words)
4735 and @command{flash erase_address} (erase NOR flash blocks)
4736 are examples; and there are many more.
4737
4738 Several commands let you examine the list of targets:
4739
4740 @deffn {Command} {target current}
4741 Returns the name of the current target.
4742 @end deffn
4743
4744 @deffn {Command} {target names}
4745 Lists the names of all current targets in the list.
4746 @example
4747 foreach t [target names] @{
4748 puts [format "Target: %s\n" $t]
4749 @}
4750 @end example
4751 @end deffn
4752
4753 @c yep, "target list" would have been better.
4754 @c plus maybe "target setdefault".
4755
4756 @deffn {Command} {targets} [name]
4757 @emph{Note: the name of this command is plural. Other target
4758 command names are singular.}
4759
4760 With no parameter, this command displays a table of all known
4761 targets in a user friendly form.
4762
4763 With a parameter, this command sets the current target to
4764 the given target with the given @var{name}; this is
4765 only relevant on boards which have more than one target.
4766 @end deffn
4767
4768 @section Target CPU Types
4769 @cindex target type
4770 @cindex CPU type
4771
4772 Each target has a @dfn{CPU type}, as shown in the output of
4773 the @command{targets} command. You need to specify that type
4774 when calling @command{target create}.
4775 The CPU type indicates more than just the instruction set.
4776 It also indicates how that instruction set is implemented,
4777 what kind of debug support it integrates,
4778 whether it has an MMU (and if so, what kind),
4779 what core-specific commands may be available
4780 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands}),
4781 and more.
4782
4783 It's easy to see what target types are supported,
4784 since there's a command to list them.
4785
4786 @anchor{targettypes}
4787 @deffn {Command} {target types}
4788 Lists all supported target types.
4789 At this writing, the supported CPU types are:
4790
4791 @itemize @bullet
4792 @item @code{aarch64} -- this is an ARMv8-A core with an MMU.
4793 @item @code{arm11} -- this is a generation of ARMv6 cores.
4794 @item @code{arm720t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU.
4795 @item @code{arm7tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core.
4796 @item @code{arm920t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU.
4797 @item @code{arm926ejs} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU.
4798 @item @code{arm946e} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU.
4799 @item @code{arm966e} -- this is an ARMv5 core.
4800 @item @code{arm9tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core.
4801 @item @code{avr} -- implements Atmel's 8-bit AVR instruction set.
4802 (Support for this is preliminary and incomplete.)
4803 @item @code{avr32_ap7k} -- this an AVR32 core.
4804 @item @code{cortex_a} -- this is an ARMv7-A core with an MMU.
4805 @item @code{cortex_m} -- this is an ARMv7-M core, supporting only the
4806 compact Thumb2 instruction set. Supports also ARMv6-M and ARMv8-M cores
4807 @item @code{cortex_r4} -- this is an ARMv7-R core.
4808 @item @code{dragonite} -- resembles arm966e.
4809 @item @code{dsp563xx} -- implements Freescale's 24-bit DSP.
4810 (Support for this is still incomplete.)
4811 @item @code{dsp5680xx} -- implements Freescale's 5680x DSP.
4812 @item @code{esirisc} -- this is an EnSilica eSi-RISC core.
4813 The current implementation supports eSi-32xx cores.
4814 @item @code{esp32} -- this is an Espressif SoC with dual Xtensa cores.
4815 @item @code{esp32s2} -- this is an Espressif SoC with single Xtensa core.
4816 @item @code{esp32s3} -- this is an Espressif SoC with dual Xtensa cores.
4817 @item @code{fa526} -- resembles arm920 (w/o Thumb).
4818 @item @code{feroceon} -- resembles arm926.
4819 @item @code{hla_target} -- a Cortex-M alternative to work with HL adapters like ST-Link.
4820 @item @code{ls1_sap} -- this is the SAP on NXP LS102x CPUs,
4821 allowing access to physical memory addresses independently of CPU cores.
4822 @item @code{mem_ap} -- this is an ARM debug infrastructure Access Port without
4823 a CPU, through which bus read and write cycles can be generated; it may be
4824 useful for working with non-CPU hardware behind an AP or during development of
4825 support for new CPUs.
4826 It's possible to connect a GDB client to this target (the GDB port has to be
4827 specified, @xref{gdbportoverride,,option -gdb-port}.), and a fake ARM core will
4828 be emulated to comply to GDB remote protocol.
4829 @item @code{mips_m4k} -- a MIPS core.
4830 @item @code{mips_mips64} -- a MIPS64 core.
4831 @item @code{nds32_v2} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v2 core (deprecated; would be removed in v0.13.0).
4832 @item @code{nds32_v3} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v3 core (deprecated; would be removed in v0.13.0).
4833 @item @code{nds32_v3m} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v3m core (deprecated; would be removed in v0.13.0).
4834 @item @code{or1k} -- this is an OpenRISC 1000 core.
4835 The current implementation supports three JTAG TAP cores:
4836 @itemize @minus
4837 @item @code{OpenCores TAP} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}jtag})
4838 @item @code{Altera Virtual JTAG TAP} (See: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_virtualjtag.pdf})
4839 @item @code{Xilinx BSCAN_* virtual JTAG interface} (See: @url{http://www.xilinx.com/support/documentation/sw_manuals/xilinx14_2/spartan6_hdl.pdf})
4840 @end itemize
4841 And two debug interfaces cores:
4842 @itemize @minus
4843 @item @code{Advanced debug interface}
4844 @*(See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}adv_debug_sys})
4845 @item @code{SoC Debug Interface}
4846 @*(See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}dbg_interface})
4847 @end itemize
4848 @item @code{quark_d20xx} -- an Intel Quark D20xx core.
4849 @item @code{quark_x10xx} -- an Intel Quark X10xx core.
4850 @item @code{riscv} -- a RISC-V core.
4851 @item @code{stm8} -- implements an STM8 core.
4852 @item @code{testee} -- a dummy target for cases without a real CPU, e.g. CPLD.
4853 @item @code{xscale} -- this is actually an architecture,
4854 not a CPU type. It is based on the ARMv5 architecture.
4855 @item @code{xtensa} -- this is a generic Cadence/Tensilica Xtensa core.
4856 @end itemize
4857 @end deffn
4858
4859 To avoid being confused by the variety of ARM based cores, remember
4860 this key point: @emph{ARM is a technology licencing company}.
4861 (See: @url{http://www.arm.com}.)
4862 The CPU name used by OpenOCD will reflect the CPU design that was
4863 licensed, not a vendor brand which incorporates that design.
4864 Name prefixes like arm7, arm9, arm11, and cortex
4865 reflect design generations;
4866 while names like ARMv4, ARMv5, ARMv6, ARMv7 and ARMv8
4867 reflect an architecture version implemented by a CPU design.
4868
4869 @anchor{targetconfiguration}
4870 @section Target Configuration
4871
4872 Before creating a ``target'', you must have added its TAP to the scan chain.
4873 When you've added that TAP, you will have a @code{dotted.name}
4874 which is used to set up the CPU support.
4875 The chip-specific configuration file will normally configure its CPU(s)
4876 right after it adds all of the chip's TAPs to the scan chain.
4877
4878 Although you can set up a target in one step, it's often clearer if you
4879 use shorter commands and do it in two steps: create it, then configure
4880 optional parts.
4881 All operations on the target after it's created will use a new
4882 command, created as part of target creation.
4883
4884 The two main things to configure after target creation are
4885 a work area, which usually has target-specific defaults even
4886 if the board setup code overrides them later;
4887 and event handlers (@pxref{targetevents,,Target Events}), which tend
4888 to be much more board-specific.
4889 The key steps you use might look something like this
4890
4891 @example
4892 dap create mychip.dap -chain-position mychip.cpu
4893 target create MyTarget cortex_m -dap mychip.dap
4894 MyTarget configure -work-area-phys 0x08000 -work-area-size 8096
4895 MyTarget configure -event reset-deassert-pre @{ jtag_rclk 5 @}
4896 MyTarget configure -event reset-init @{ myboard_reinit @}
4897 @end example
4898
4899 You should specify a working area if you can; typically it uses some
4900 on-chip SRAM.
4901 Such a working area can speed up many things, including bulk
4902 writes to target memory;
4903 flash operations like checking to see if memory needs to be erased;
4904 GDB memory checksumming;
4905 and more.
4906
4907 @quotation Warning
4908 On more complex chips, the work area can become
4909 inaccessible when application code
4910 (such as an operating system)
4911 enables or disables the MMU.
4912 For example, the particular MMU context used to access the virtual
4913 address will probably matter ... and that context might not have
4914 easy access to other addresses needed.
4915 At this writing, OpenOCD doesn't have much MMU intelligence.
4916 @end quotation
4917
4918 It's often very useful to define a @code{reset-init} event handler.
4919 For systems that are normally used with a boot loader,
4920 common tasks include updating clocks and initializing memory
4921 controllers.
4922 That may be needed to let you write the boot loader into flash,
4923 in order to ``de-brick'' your board; or to load programs into
4924 external DDR memory without having run the boot loader.
4925
4926 @deffn {Config Command} {target create} target_name type configparams...
4927 This command creates a GDB debug target that refers to a specific JTAG tap.
4928 It enters that target into a list, and creates a new
4929 command (@command{@var{target_name}}) which is used for various
4930 purposes including additional configuration.
4931
4932 @itemize @bullet
4933 @item @var{target_name} ... is the name of the debug target.
4934 By convention this should be the same as the @emph{dotted.name}
4935 of the TAP associated with this target, which must be specified here
4936 using the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} configparam.
4937
4938 This name is also used to create the target object command,
4939 referred to here as @command{$target_name},
4940 and in other places the target needs to be identified.
4941 @item @var{type} ... specifies the target type. @xref{targettypes,,target types}.
4942 @item @var{configparams} ... all parameters accepted by
4943 @command{$target_name configure} are permitted.
4944 If the target is big-endian, set it here with @code{-endian big}.
4945
4946 You @emph{must} set the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} or
4947 @code{-dap @var{dap_name}} here.
4948 @end itemize
4949 @end deffn
4950
4951 @deffn {Command} {$target_name configure} configparams...
4952 The options accepted by this command may also be
4953 specified as parameters to @command{target create}.
4954 Their values can later be queried one at a time by
4955 using the @command{$target_name cget} command.
4956
4957 @emph{Warning:} changing some of these after setup is dangerous.
4958 For example, moving a target from one TAP to another;
4959 and changing its endianness.
4960
4961 @itemize @bullet
4962
4963 @item @code{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name} -- names the TAP
4964 used to access this target.
4965
4966 @item @code{-dap} @var{dap_name} -- names the DAP used to access
4967 this target. @xref{dapdeclaration,,DAP declaration}, on how to
4968 create and manage DAP instances.
4969
4970 @item @code{-endian} (@option{big}|@option{little}) -- specifies
4971 whether the CPU uses big or little endian conventions
4972
4973 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} @var{event_body} --
4974 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4975 Note that this updates a list of named event handlers.
4976 Calling this twice with two different event names assigns
4977 two different handlers, but calling it twice with the
4978 same event name assigns only one handler.
4979
4980 Current target is temporarily overridden to the event issuing target
4981 before handler code starts and switched back after handler is done.
4982
4983 @item @code{-work-area-backup} (@option{0}|@option{1}) -- says
4984 whether the work area gets backed up; by default,
4985 @emph{it is not backed up.}
4986 When possible, use a working_area that doesn't need to be backed up,
4987 since performing a backup slows down operations.
4988 For example, the beginning of an SRAM block is likely to
4989 be used by most build systems, but the end is often unused.
4990
4991 @item @code{-work-area-size} @var{size} -- specify work are size,
4992 in bytes. The same size applies regardless of whether its physical
4993 or virtual address is being used.
4994
4995 @item @code{-work-area-phys} @var{address} -- set the work area
4996 base @var{address} to be used when no MMU is active.
4997
4998 @item @code{-work-area-virt} @var{address} -- set the work area
4999 base @var{address} to be used when an MMU is active.
5000 @emph{Do not specify a value for this except on targets with an MMU.}
5001 The value should normally correspond to a static mapping for the
5002 @code{-work-area-phys} address, set up by the current operating system.
5003
5004 @anchor{rtostype}
5005 @item @code{-rtos} @var{rtos_type} -- enable rtos support for target,
5006 @var{rtos_type} can be one of @option{auto}, @option{none}, @option{eCos},
5007 @option{ThreadX}, @option{FreeRTOS}, @option{linux}, @option{ChibiOS},
5008 @option{embKernel}, @option{mqx}, @option{uCOS-III}, @option{nuttx},
5009 @option{RIOT}, @option{Zephyr}
5010 @xref{gdbrtossupport,,RTOS Support}.
5011
5012 @item @code{-defer-examine} -- skip target examination at initial JTAG chain
5013 scan and after a reset. A manual call to arp_examine is required to
5014 access the target for debugging.
5015
5016 @item @code{-ap-num} @var{ap_number} -- set DAP access port for target.
5017 On ADIv5 DAP @var{ap_number} is the numeric index of the DAP AP the target is connected to.
5018 On ADIv6 DAP @var{ap_number} is the base address of the DAP AP the target is connected to.
5019 Use this option with systems where multiple, independent cores are connected
5020 to separate access ports of the same DAP.
5021
5022 @item @code{-cti} @var{cti_name} -- set Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) connected
5023 to the target. Currently, only the @code{aarch64} target makes use of this option,
5024 where it is a mandatory configuration for the target run control.
5025 @xref{armcrosstrigger,,ARM Cross-Trigger Interface},
5026 for instruction on how to declare and control a CTI instance.
5027
5028 @anchor{gdbportoverride}
5029 @item @code{-gdb-port} @var{number} -- see command @command{gdb_port} for the
5030 possible values of the parameter @var{number}, which are not only numeric values.
5031 Use this option to override, for this target only, the global parameter set with
5032 command @command{gdb_port}.
5033 @xref{gdb_port,,command gdb_port}.
5034
5035 @item @code{-gdb-max-connections} @var{number} -- EXPERIMENTAL: set the maximum
5036 number of GDB connections that are allowed for the target. Default is 1.
5037 A negative value for @var{number} means unlimited connections.
5038 See @xref{gdbmeminspect,,Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector}.
5039 @end itemize
5040 @end deffn
5041
5042 @section Other $target_name Commands
5043 @cindex object command
5044
5045 The Tcl/Tk language has the concept of object commands,
5046 and OpenOCD adopts that same model for targets.
5047
5048 A good Tk example is a on screen button.
5049 Once a button is created a button
5050 has a name (a path in Tk terms) and that name is useable as a first
5051 class command. For example in Tk, one can create a button and later
5052 configure it like this:
5053
5054 @example
5055 # Create
5056 button .foobar -background red -command @{ foo @}
5057 # Modify
5058 .foobar configure -foreground blue
5059 # Query
5060 set x [.foobar cget -background]
5061 # Report
5062 puts [format "The button is %s" $x]
5063 @end example
5064
5065 In OpenOCD's terms, the ``target'' is an object just like a Tcl/Tk
5066 button, and its object commands are invoked the same way.
5067
5068 @example
5069 str912.cpu mww 0x1234 0x42
5070 omap3530.cpu mww 0x5555 123
5071 @end example
5072
5073 The commands supported by OpenOCD target objects are:
5074
5075 @deffn {Command} {$target_name arp_examine} @option{allow-defer}
5076 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_halt}
5077 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_poll}
5078 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_reset}
5079 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_waitstate}
5080 Internal OpenOCD scripts (most notably @file{startup.tcl})
5081 use these to deal with specific reset cases.
5082 They are not otherwise documented here.
5083 @end deffn
5084
5085 @deffn {Command} {$target_name set_reg} dict
5086 Set register values of the target.
5087
5088 @itemize
5089 @item @var{dict} ... Tcl dictionary with pairs of register names and values.
5090 @end itemize
5091
5092 For example, the following command sets the value 0 to the program counter (pc)
5093 register and 0x1000 to the stack pointer (sp) register:
5094
5095 @example
5096 set_reg @{pc 0 sp 0x1000@}
5097 @end example
5098 @end deffn
5099
5100 @deffn {Command} {$target_name get_reg} [-force] list
5101 Get register values from the target and return them as Tcl dictionary with pairs
5102 of register names and values.
5103 If option "-force" is set, the register values are read directly from the
5104 target, bypassing any caching.
5105
5106 @itemize
5107 @item @var{list} ... List of register names
5108 @end itemize
5109
5110 For example, the following command retrieves the values from the program
5111 counter (pc) and stack pointer (sp) register:
5112
5113 @example
5114 get_reg @{pc sp@}
5115 @end example
5116 @end deffn
5117
5118 @deffn {Command} {$target_name write_memory} address width data ['phys']
5119 This function provides an efficient way to write to the target memory from a Tcl
5120 script.
5121
5122 @itemize
5123 @item @var{address} ... target memory address
5124 @item @var{width} ... memory access bit size, can be 8, 16, 32 or 64
5125 @item @var{data} ... Tcl list with the elements to write
5126 @item ['phys'] ... treat the memory address as physical instead of virtual address
5127 @end itemize
5128
5129 For example, the following command writes two 32 bit words into the target
5130 memory at address 0x20000000:
5131
5132 @example
5133 write_memory 0x20000000 32 @{0xdeadbeef 0x00230500@}
5134 @end example
5135 @end deffn
5136
5137 @deffn {Command} {$target_name read_memory} address width count ['phys']
5138 This function provides an efficient way to read the target memory from a Tcl
5139 script.
5140 A Tcl list containing the requested memory elements is returned by this function.
5141
5142 @itemize
5143 @item @var{address} ... target memory address
5144 @item @var{width} ... memory access bit size, can be 8, 16, 32 or 64
5145 @item @var{count} ... number of elements to read
5146 @item ['phys'] ... treat the memory address as physical instead of virtual address
5147 @end itemize
5148
5149 For example, the following command reads two 32 bit words from the target
5150 memory at address 0x20000000:
5151
5152 @example
5153 read_memory 0x20000000 32 2
5154 @end example
5155 @end deffn
5156
5157 @deffn {Command} {$target_name cget} queryparm
5158 Each configuration parameter accepted by
5159 @command{$target_name configure}
5160 can be individually queried, to return its current value.
5161 The @var{queryparm} is a parameter name
5162 accepted by that command, such as @code{-work-area-phys}.
5163 There are a few special cases:
5164
5165 @itemize @bullet
5166 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} -- returns the handler for the
5167 event named @var{event_name}.
5168 This is a special case because setting a handler requires
5169 two parameters.
5170 @item @code{-type} -- returns the target type.
5171 This is a special case because this is set using
5172 @command{target create} and can't be changed
5173 using @command{$target_name configure}.
5174 @end itemize
5175
5176 For example, if you wanted to summarize information about
5177 all the targets you might use something like this:
5178
5179 @example
5180 foreach name [target names] @{
5181 set y [$name cget -endian]
5182 set z [$name cget -type]
5183 puts [format "Chip %d is %s, Endian: %s, type: %s" \
5184 $x $name $y $z]
5185 @}
5186 @end example
5187 @end deffn
5188
5189 @anchor{targetcurstate}
5190 @deffn {Command} {$target_name curstate}
5191 Displays the current target state:
5192 @code{debug-running},
5193 @code{halted},
5194 @code{reset},
5195 @code{running}, or @code{unknown}.
5196 (Also, @pxref{eventpolling,,Event Polling}.)
5197 @end deffn
5198
5199 @deffn {Command} {$target_name eventlist}
5200 Displays a table listing all event handlers
5201 currently associated with this target.
5202 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
5203 @end deffn
5204
5205 @deffn {Command} {$target_name invoke-event} event_name
5206 Invokes the handler for the event named @var{event_name}.
5207 (This is primarily intended for use by OpenOCD framework
5208 code, for example by the reset code in @file{startup.tcl}.)
5209 @end deffn
5210
5211 @deffn {Command} {$target_name mdd} [phys] addr [count]
5212 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mdw} [phys] addr [count]
5213 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mdh} [phys] addr [count]
5214 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mdb} [phys] addr [count]
5215 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
5216 64-bit doublewords (@command{mdd}),
5217 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
5218 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
5219 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
5220 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
5221 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
5222 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
5223 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
5224 (If you want to process the data instead of displaying it,
5225 see the @code{read_memory} primitives.)
5226 @end deffn
5227
5228 @deffn {Command} {$target_name mwd} [phys] addr doubleword [count]
5229 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mww} [phys] addr word [count]
5230 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mwh} [phys] addr halfword [count]
5231 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mwb} [phys] addr byte [count]
5232 Writes the specified @var{doubleword} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
5233 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
5234 at the specified address @var{addr}.
5235 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
5236 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
5237 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
5238 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
5239 If @var{count} is specified, fills that many units of consecutive address.
5240 @end deffn
5241
5242 @anchor{targetevents}
5243 @section Target Events
5244 @cindex target events
5245 @cindex events
5246 At various times, certain things can happen, or you want them to happen.
5247 For example:
5248 @itemize @bullet
5249 @item What should happen when GDB connects? Should your target reset?
5250 @item When GDB tries to flash the target, do you need to enable the flash via a special command?
5251 @item Is using SRST appropriate (and possible) on your system?
5252 Or instead of that, do you need to issue JTAG commands to trigger reset?
5253 SRST usually resets everything on the scan chain, which can be inappropriate.
5254 @item During reset, do you need to write to certain memory locations
5255 to set up system clocks or
5256 to reconfigure the SDRAM?
5257 How about configuring the watchdog timer, or other peripherals,
5258 to stop running while you hold the core stopped for debugging?
5259 @end itemize
5260
5261 All of the above items can be addressed by target event handlers.
5262 These are set up by @command{$target_name configure -event} or
5263 @command{target create ... -event}.
5264
5265 The programmer's model matches the @code{-command} option used in Tcl/Tk
5266 buttons and events. The two examples below act the same, but one creates
5267 and invokes a small procedure while the other inlines it.
5268
5269 @example
5270 proc my_init_proc @{ @} @{
5271 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
5272 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
5273 @}
5274 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init my_init_proc
5275 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init @{
5276 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
5277 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
5278 @}
5279 @end example
5280
5281 The following target events are defined:
5282
5283 @itemize @bullet
5284 @item @b{debug-halted}
5285 @* The target has halted for debug reasons (i.e.: breakpoint)
5286 @item @b{debug-resumed}
5287 @* The target has resumed (i.e.: GDB said run)
5288 @item @b{early-halted}
5289 @* Occurs early in the halt process
5290 @item @b{examine-start}
5291 @* Before target examine is called.
5292 @item @b{examine-end}
5293 @* After target examine is called with no errors.
5294 @item @b{examine-fail}
5295 @* After target examine fails.
5296 @item @b{gdb-attach}
5297 @* When GDB connects. Issued before any GDB communication with the target
5298 starts. GDB expects the target is halted during attachment.
5299 @xref{gdbmeminspect,,GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector}, how to
5300 connect GDB to running target.
5301 The event can be also used to set up the target so it is possible to probe flash.
5302 Probing flash is necessary during GDB connect if you want to use
5303 @pxref{programmingusinggdb,,programming using GDB}.
5304 Another use of the flash memory map is for GDB to automatically choose
5305 hardware or software breakpoints depending on whether the breakpoint
5306 is in RAM or read only memory.
5307 Default is @code{halt}
5308 @item @b{gdb-detach}
5309 @* When GDB disconnects
5310 @item @b{gdb-end}
5311 @* When the target has halted and GDB is not doing anything (see early halt)
5312 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-start}
5313 @* Before the GDB flash process tries to erase the flash (default is
5314 @code{reset init})
5315 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-end}
5316 @* After the GDB flash process has finished erasing the flash
5317 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-start}
5318 @* Before GDB writes to the flash
5319 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-end}
5320 @* After GDB writes to the flash (default is @code{reset halt})
5321 @item @b{gdb-start}
5322 @* Before the target steps, GDB is trying to start/resume the target
5323 @item @b{halted}
5324 @* The target has halted
5325 @item @b{reset-assert-pre}
5326 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5327 after @command{reset-start} was triggered
5328 but before either SRST alone is asserted on the scan chain,
5329 or @code{reset-assert} is triggered.
5330 @item @b{reset-assert}
5331 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5332 after @command{reset-assert-pre} was triggered.
5333 When such a handler is present, cores which support this event will use
5334 it instead of asserting SRST.
5335 This support is essential for debugging with JTAG interfaces which
5336 don't include an SRST line (JTAG doesn't require SRST), and for
5337 selective reset on scan chains that have multiple targets.
5338 @item @b{reset-assert-post}
5339 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5340 after @code{reset-assert} has been triggered.
5341 or the target asserted SRST on the entire scan chain.
5342 @item @b{reset-deassert-pre}
5343 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5344 after @code{reset-assert-post} has been triggered.
5345 @item @b{reset-deassert-post}
5346 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5347 after @code{reset-deassert-pre} has been triggered
5348 and (if the target is using it) after SRST has been
5349 released on the scan chain.
5350 @item @b{reset-end}
5351 @* Issued as the final step in @command{reset} processing.
5352 @item @b{reset-init}
5353 @* Used by @b{reset init} command for board-specific initialization.
5354 This event fires after @emph{reset-deassert-post}.
5355
5356 This is where you would configure PLLs and clocking, set up DRAM so
5357 you can download programs that don't fit in on-chip SRAM, set up pin
5358 multiplexing, and so on.
5359 (You may be able to switch to a fast JTAG clock rate here, after
5360 the target clocks are fully set up.)
5361 @item @b{reset-start}
5362 @* Issued as the first step in @command{reset} processing
5363 before @command{reset-assert-pre} is called.
5364
5365 This is the most robust place to use @command{jtag_rclk}
5366 or @command{adapter speed} to switch to a low JTAG clock rate,
5367 when reset disables PLLs needed to use a fast clock.
5368 @item @b{resume-start}
5369 @* Before any target is resumed
5370 @item @b{resume-end}
5371 @* After all targets have resumed
5372 @item @b{resumed}
5373 @* Target has resumed
5374 @item @b{step-start}
5375 @* Before a target is single-stepped
5376 @item @b{step-end}
5377 @* After single-step has completed
5378 @item @b{trace-config}
5379 @* After target hardware trace configuration was changed
5380 @item @b{semihosting-user-cmd-0x100}
5381 @* The target made a semihosting call with user-defined operation number 0x100
5382 @item @b{semihosting-user-cmd-0x101}
5383 @* The target made a semihosting call with user-defined operation number 0x101
5384 @item @b{semihosting-user-cmd-0x102}
5385 @* The target made a semihosting call with user-defined operation number 0x102
5386 @item @b{semihosting-user-cmd-0x103}
5387 @* The target made a semihosting call with user-defined operation number 0x103
5388 @item @b{semihosting-user-cmd-0x104}
5389 @* The target made a semihosting call with user-defined operation number 0x104
5390 @item @b{semihosting-user-cmd-0x105}
5391 @* The target made a semihosting call with user-defined operation number 0x105
5392 @item @b{semihosting-user-cmd-0x106}
5393 @* The target made a semihosting call with user-defined operation number 0x106
5394 @item @b{semihosting-user-cmd-0x107}
5395 @* The target made a semihosting call with user-defined operation number 0x107
5396 @end itemize
5397
5398 @quotation Note
5399 OpenOCD events are not supposed to be preempt by another event, but this
5400 is not enforced in current code. Only the target event @b{resumed} is
5401 executed with polling disabled; this avoids polling to trigger the event
5402 @b{halted}, reversing the logical order of execution of their handlers.
5403 Future versions of OpenOCD will prevent the event preemption and will
5404 disable the schedule of polling during the event execution. Do not rely
5405 on polling in any event handler; this means, don't expect the status of
5406 a core to change during the execution of the handler. The event handler
5407 will have to enable polling or use @command{$target_name arp_poll} to
5408 check if the core has changed status.
5409 @end quotation
5410
5411 @node Flash Commands
5412 @chapter Flash Commands
5413
5414 OpenOCD has different commands for NOR and NAND flash;
5415 the ``flash'' command works with NOR flash, while
5416 the ``nand'' command works with NAND flash.
5417 This partially reflects different hardware technologies:
5418 NOR flash usually supports direct CPU instruction and data bus access,
5419 while data from a NAND flash must be copied to memory before it can be
5420 used. (SPI flash must also be copied to memory before use.)
5421 However, the documentation also uses ``flash'' as a generic term;
5422 for example, ``Put flash configuration in board-specific files''.
5423
5424 Flash Steps:
5425 @enumerate
5426 @item Configure via the command @command{flash bank}
5427 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
5428 passing parameters as needed by the driver.
5429 @item Operate on the flash via @command{flash subcommand}
5430 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
5431 via a script in some automated way. Common tasks include writing a
5432 boot loader, operating system, or other data.
5433 @item GDB Flashing
5434 @* Flashing via GDB requires the flash be configured via ``flash
5435 bank'', and the GDB flash features be enabled.
5436 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
5437 @end enumerate
5438
5439 Many CPUs have the ability to ``boot'' from the first flash bank.
5440 This means that misprogramming that bank can ``brick'' a system,
5441 so that it can't boot.
5442 JTAG tools, like OpenOCD, are often then used to ``de-brick'' the
5443 board by (re)installing working boot firmware.
5444
5445 @anchor{norconfiguration}
5446 @section Flash Configuration Commands
5447 @cindex flash configuration
5448
5449 @deffn {Config Command} {flash bank} name driver base size chip_width bus_width target [driver_options]
5450 Configures a flash bank which provides persistent storage
5451 for addresses from @math{base} to @math{base + size - 1}.
5452 These banks will often be visible to GDB through the target's memory map.
5453 In some cases, configuring a flash bank will activate extra commands;
5454 see the driver-specific documentation.
5455
5456 @itemize @bullet
5457 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the flash bank
5458 in other flash commands. A number is also available.
5459 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the controller driver
5460 associated with the flash bank being declared.
5461 This is usually @code{cfi} for external flash, or else
5462 the name of a microcontroller with embedded flash memory.
5463 @xref{flashdriverlist,,Flash Driver List}.
5464 @item @var{base} ... Base address of the flash chip.
5465 @item @var{size} ... Size of the chip, in bytes.
5466 For some drivers, this value is detected from the hardware.
5467 @item @var{chip_width} ... Width of the flash chip, in bytes;
5468 ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
5469 @item @var{bus_width} ... Width of the data bus used to access the
5470 chip, in bytes; ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
5471 @item @var{target} ... Names the target used to issue
5472 commands to the flash controller.
5473 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
5474 @item @var{driver_options} ... drivers may support, or require,
5475 additional parameters. See the driver-specific documentation
5476 for more information.
5477 @end itemize
5478 @quotation Note
5479 This command is not available after OpenOCD initialization has completed.
5480 Use it in board specific configuration files, not interactively.
5481 @end quotation
5482 @end deffn
5483
5484 @comment less confusing would be: "flash list" (like "nand list")
5485 @deffn {Command} {flash banks}
5486 Prints a one-line summary of each device that was
5487 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
5488 Note that this is the @emph{plural} form;
5489 the @emph{singular} form is a very different command.
5490 @end deffn
5491
5492 @deffn {Command} {flash list}
5493 Retrieves a list of associative arrays for each device that was
5494 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
5495 This returned list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
5496 @end deffn
5497
5498 @deffn {Command} {flash probe} num
5499 Identify the flash, or validate the parameters of the configured flash. Operation
5500 depends on the flash type.
5501 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5502 Most flash commands will implicitly @emph{autoprobe} the bank;
5503 flash drivers can distinguish between probing and autoprobing,
5504 but most don't bother.
5505 @end deffn
5506
5507 @section Preparing a Target before Flash Programming
5508
5509 The target device should be in well defined state before the flash programming
5510 begins.
5511
5512 @emph{Always issue} @command{reset init} before @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
5513 Do not issue another @command{reset} or @command{reset halt} or @command{resume}
5514 until the programming session is finished.
5515
5516 If you use @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
5517 the target is prepared automatically in the event gdb-flash-erase-start
5518
5519 The jimtcl script @command{program} calls @command{reset init} explicitly.
5520
5521 @section Erasing, Reading, Writing to Flash
5522 @cindex flash erasing
5523 @cindex flash reading
5524 @cindex flash writing
5525 @cindex flash programming
5526 @anchor{flashprogrammingcommands}
5527
5528 One feature distinguishing NOR flash from NAND or serial flash technologies
5529 is that for read access, it acts exactly like any other addressable memory.
5530 This means you can use normal memory read commands like @command{mdw} or
5531 @command{dump_image} with it, with no special @command{flash} subcommands.
5532 @xref{memoryaccess,,Memory access}, and @ref{imageaccess,,Image access}.
5533
5534 Write access works differently. Flash memory normally needs to be erased
5535 before it's written. Erasing a sector turns all of its bits to ones, and
5536 writing can turn ones into zeroes. This is why there are special commands
5537 for interactive erasing and writing, and why GDB needs to know which parts
5538 of the address space hold NOR flash memory.
5539
5540 @quotation Note
5541 Most of these erase and write commands leverage the fact that NOR flash
5542 chips consume target address space. They implicitly refer to the current
5543 JTAG target, and map from an address in that target's address space
5544 back to a flash bank.
5545 @comment In May 2009, those mappings may fail if any bank associated
5546 @comment with that target doesn't successfully autoprobe ... bug worth fixing?
5547 A few commands use abstract addressing based on bank and sector numbers,
5548 and don't depend on searching the current target and its address space.
5549 Avoid confusing the two command models.
5550 @end quotation
5551
5552 Some flash chips implement software protection against accidental writes,
5553 since such buggy writes could in some cases ``brick'' a system.
5554 For such systems, erasing and writing may require sector protection to be
5555 disabled first.
5556 Examples include CFI flash such as ``Intel Advanced Bootblock flash'',
5557 and AT91SAM7 on-chip flash.
5558 @xref{flashprotect,,flash protect}.
5559
5560 @deffn {Command} {flash erase_sector} num first last
5561 Erase sectors in bank @var{num}, starting at sector @var{first}
5562 up to and including @var{last}.
5563 Sector numbering starts at 0.
5564 Providing a @var{last} sector of @option{last}
5565 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
5566 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5567 @end deffn
5568
5569 @deffn {Command} {flash erase_address} [@option{pad}] [@option{unlock}] address length
5570 Erase sectors starting at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
5571 Unless @option{pad} is specified, @math{address} must begin a
5572 flash sector, and @math{address + length - 1} must end a sector.
5573 Specifying @option{pad} erases extra data at the beginning and/or
5574 end of the specified region, as needed to erase only full sectors.
5575 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address}, and
5576 the specified length must stay within that bank.
5577 As a special case, when @var{length} is zero and @var{address} is
5578 the start of the bank, the whole flash is erased.
5579 If @option{unlock} is specified, then the flash is unprotected
5580 before erase starts.
5581 @end deffn
5582
5583 @deffn {Command} {flash filld} address double-word length
5584 @deffnx {Command} {flash fillw} address word length
5585 @deffnx {Command} {flash fillh} address halfword length
5586 @deffnx {Command} {flash fillb} address byte length
5587 Fills flash memory with the specified @var{double-word} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
5588 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) pattern,
5589 starting at @var{address} and continuing
5590 for @var{length} units (word/halfword/byte).
5591 No erasure is done before writing; when needed, that must be done
5592 before issuing this command.
5593 Writes are done in blocks of up to 1024 bytes, and each write is
5594 verified by reading back the data and comparing it to what was written.
5595 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
5596 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
5597 @end deffn
5598 @comment no current checks for errors if fill blocks touch multiple banks!
5599
5600 @deffn {Command} {flash mdw} addr [count]
5601 @deffnx {Command} {flash mdh} addr [count]
5602 @deffnx {Command} {flash mdb} addr [count]
5603 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
5604 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
5605 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
5606 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
5607 Reads from flash using the flash driver, therefore it enables reading
5608 from a bank not mapped in target address space.
5609 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
5610 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
5611 @end deffn
5612
5613 @deffn {Command} {flash write_bank} num filename [offset]
5614 Write the binary @file{filename} to flash bank @var{num},
5615 starting at @var{offset} bytes from the beginning of the bank. If @var{offset}
5616 is omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank.
5617 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5618 @end deffn
5619
5620 @deffn {Command} {flash read_bank} num filename [offset [length]]
5621 Read @var{length} bytes from the flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}
5622 and write the contents to the binary @file{filename}. If @var{offset} is
5623 omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank. If @var{length} is omitted,
5624 read the remaining bytes from the flash bank.
5625 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5626 @end deffn
5627
5628 @deffn {Command} {flash verify_bank} num filename [offset]
5629 Compare the contents of the binary file @var{filename} with the contents of the
5630 flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}. If @var{offset} is omitted,
5631 start at the beginning of the flash bank. Fail if the contents do not match.
5632 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5633 @end deffn
5634
5635 @deffn {Command} {flash write_image} [erase] [unlock] filename [offset] [type]
5636 Write the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
5637 Only loadable sections from the image are written.
5638 A relocation @var{offset} may be specified, in which case it is added
5639 to the base address for each section in the image.
5640 The file [@var{type}] can be specified
5641 explicitly as @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
5642 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19).
5643 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
5644 The relevant flash sectors will be erased prior to programming
5645 if the @option{erase} parameter is given. If @option{unlock} is
5646 provided, then the flash banks are unlocked before erase and
5647 program. The flash bank to use is inferred from the address of
5648 each image section.
5649
5650 @quotation Warning
5651 Be careful using the @option{erase} flag when the flash is holding
5652 data you want to preserve.
5653 Portions of the flash outside those described in the image's
5654 sections might be erased with no notice.
5655 @itemize
5656 @item
5657 When a section of the image being written does not fill out all the
5658 sectors it uses, the unwritten parts of those sectors are necessarily
5659 also erased, because sectors can't be partially erased.
5660 @item
5661 Data stored in sector "holes" between image sections are also affected.
5662 For example, "@command{flash write_image erase ...}" of an image with
5663 one byte at the beginning of a flash bank and one byte at the end
5664 erases the entire bank -- not just the two sectors being written.
5665 @end itemize
5666 Also, when flash protection is important, you must re-apply it after
5667 it has been removed by the @option{unlock} flag.
5668 @end quotation
5669
5670 @end deffn
5671
5672 @deffn {Command} {flash verify_image} filename [offset] [type]
5673 Verify the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
5674 Parameters follow the description of 'flash write_image'.
5675 In contrast to the 'verify_image' command, for banks with specific
5676 verify method, that one is used instead of the usual target's read
5677 memory methods. This is necessary for flash banks not readable by
5678 ordinary memory reads.
5679 This command gives only an overall good/bad result for each bank, not
5680 addresses of individual failed bytes as it's intended only as quick
5681 check for successful programming.
5682 @end deffn
5683
5684 @section Other Flash commands
5685 @cindex flash protection
5686
5687 @deffn {Command} {flash erase_check} num
5688 Check erase state of sectors in flash bank @var{num},
5689 and display that status.
5690 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5691 @end deffn
5692
5693 @deffn {Command} {flash info} num [sectors]
5694 Print info about flash bank @var{num}, a list of protection blocks
5695 and their status. Use @option{sectors} to show a list of sectors instead.
5696
5697 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5698 This command will first query the hardware, it does not print cached
5699 and possibly stale information.
5700 @end deffn
5701
5702 @anchor{flashprotect}
5703 @deffn {Command} {flash protect} num first last (@option{on}|@option{off})
5704 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) protection of flash blocks
5705 in flash bank @var{num}, starting at protection block @var{first}
5706 and continuing up to and including @var{last}.
5707 Providing a @var{last} block of @option{last}
5708 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
5709 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5710 The protection block is usually identical to a flash sector.
5711 Some devices may utilize a protection block distinct from flash sector.
5712 See @command{flash info} for a list of protection blocks.
5713 @end deffn
5714
5715 @deffn {Command} {flash padded_value} num value
5716 Sets the default value used for padding any image sections, This should
5717 normally match the flash bank erased value. If not specified by this
5718 command or the flash driver then it defaults to 0xff.
5719 @end deffn
5720
5721 @anchor{program}
5722 @deffn {Command} {program} filename [preverify] [verify] [reset] [exit] [offset]
5723 This is a helper script that simplifies using OpenOCD as a standalone
5724 programmer. The only required parameter is @option{filename}, the others are optional.
5725 @xref{Flash Programming}.
5726 @end deffn
5727
5728 @anchor{flashdriverlist}
5729 @section Flash Driver List
5730 As noted above, the @command{flash bank} command requires a driver name,
5731 and allows driver-specific options and behaviors.
5732 Some drivers also activate driver-specific commands.
5733
5734 @deffn {Flash Driver} {virtual}
5735 This is a special driver that maps a previously defined bank to another
5736 address. All bank settings will be copied from the master physical bank.
5737
5738 The @var{virtual} driver defines one mandatory parameters,
5739
5740 @itemize
5741 @item @var{master_bank} The bank that this virtual address refers to.
5742 @end itemize
5743
5744 So in the following example addresses 0xbfc00000 and 0x9fc00000 refer to
5745 the flash bank defined at address 0x1fc00000. Any command executed on
5746 the virtual banks is actually performed on the physical banks.
5747 @example
5748 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pic32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5749 flash bank vbank0 virtual 0xbfc00000 0 0 0 \
5750 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5751 flash bank vbank1 virtual 0x9fc00000 0 0 0 \
5752 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5753 @end example
5754 @end deffn
5755
5756 @subsection External Flash
5757
5758 @deffn {Flash Driver} {cfi}
5759 @cindex Common Flash Interface
5760 @cindex CFI
5761 The ``Common Flash Interface'' (CFI) is the main standard for
5762 external NOR flash chips, each of which connects to a
5763 specific external chip select on the CPU.
5764 Frequently the first such chip is used to boot the system.
5765 Your board's @code{reset-init} handler might need to
5766 configure additional chip selects using other commands (like: @command{mww} to
5767 configure a bus and its timings), or
5768 perhaps configure a GPIO pin that controls the ``write protect'' pin
5769 on the flash chip.
5770 The CFI driver can use a target-specific working area to significantly
5771 speed up operation.
5772
5773 The CFI driver can accept the following optional parameters, in any order:
5774
5775 @itemize
5776 @item @var{jedec_probe} ... is used to detect certain non-CFI flash ROMs,
5777 like AM29LV010 and similar types.
5778 @item @var{x16_as_x8} ... when a 16-bit flash is hooked up to an 8-bit bus.
5779 @item @var{bus_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be swapped.
5780 @item @var{data_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be
5781 swapped when writing data values (i.e. not CFI commands).
5782 @end itemize
5783
5784 To configure two adjacent banks of 16 MBytes each, both sixteen bits (two bytes)
5785 wide on a sixteen bit bus:
5786
5787 @example
5788 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
5789 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x01000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
5790 @end example
5791
5792 To configure one bank of 32 MBytes
5793 built from two sixteen bit (two byte) wide parts wired in parallel
5794 to create a thirty-two bit (four byte) bus with doubled throughput:
5795
5796 @example
5797 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x02000000 2 4 $_TARGETNAME
5798 @end example
5799
5800 @c "cfi part_id" disabled
5801 @end deffn
5802
5803 @deffn {Flash Driver} {jtagspi}
5804 @cindex Generic JTAG2SPI driver
5805 @cindex SPI
5806 @cindex jtagspi
5807 @cindex bscan_spi
5808 Several FPGAs and CPLDs can retrieve their configuration (bitstream) from a
5809 SPI flash connected to them. To access this flash from the host, the device
5810 is first programmed with a special proxy bitstream that
5811 exposes the SPI flash on the device's JTAG interface. The flash can then be
5812 accessed through JTAG.
5813
5814 Since signaling between JTAG and SPI is compatible, all that is required for
5815 a proxy bitstream is to connect TDI-MOSI, TDO-MISO, TCK-CLK and activate
5816 the flash chip select when the JTAG state machine is in SHIFT-DR. Such
5817 a bitstream for several Xilinx FPGAs can be found in
5818 @file{contrib/loaders/flash/fpga/xilinx_bscan_spi.py}. It requires
5819 @uref{https://github.com/m-labs/migen, migen} and a Xilinx toolchain to build.
5820
5821 This flash bank driver requires a target on a JTAG tap and will access that
5822 tap directly. Since no support from the target is needed, the target can be a
5823 "testee" dummy. Since the target does not expose the flash memory
5824 mapping, target commands that would otherwise be expected to access the flash
5825 will not work. These include all @command{*_image} and
5826 @command{$target_name m*} commands as well as @command{program}. Equivalent
5827 functionality is available through the @command{flash write_bank},
5828 @command{flash read_bank}, and @command{flash verify_bank} commands.
5829
5830 According to device size, 1- to 4-byte addresses are sent. However, some
5831 flash chips additionally have to be switched to 4-byte addresses by an extra
5832 command, see below.
5833
5834 @itemize
5835 @item @var{ir} ... is loaded into the JTAG IR to map the flash as the JTAG DR.
5836 For the bitstreams generated from @file{xilinx_bscan_spi.py} this is the
5837 @var{USER1} instruction.
5838 @end itemize
5839
5840 @example
5841 target create $_TARGETNAME testee -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.fpga
5842 set _XILINX_USER1 0x02
5843 flash bank $_FLASHNAME spi 0x0 0 0 0 \
5844 $_TARGETNAME $_XILINX_USER1
5845 @end example
5846
5847 @deffn Command {jtagspi set} bank_id name total_size page_size read_cmd unused pprg_cmd mass_erase_cmd sector_size sector_erase_cmd
5848 Sets flash parameters: @var{name} human readable string, @var{total_size}
5849 size in bytes, @var{page_size} is write page size. @var{read_cmd} and @var{pprg_cmd}
5850 are commands for read and page program, respectively. @var{mass_erase_cmd},
5851 @var{sector_size} and @var{sector_erase_cmd} are optional.
5852 @example
5853 jtagspi set 0 w25q128 0x1000000 0x100 0x03 0 0x02 0xC7 0x10000 0xD8
5854 @end example
5855 @end deffn
5856
5857 @deffn Command {jtagspi cmd} bank_id resp_num cmd_byte ...
5858 Sends command @var{cmd_byte} and at most 20 following bytes and reads
5859 @var{resp_num} bytes afterwards. E.g. for 'Enter 4-byte address mode'
5860 @example
5861 jtagspi cmd 0 0 0xB7
5862 @end example
5863 @end deffn
5864
5865 @deffn Command {jtagspi always_4byte} bank_id [ on | off ]
5866 Some devices use 4-byte addresses for all commands except the legacy 0x03 read
5867 regardless of device size. This command controls the corresponding hack.
5868 @end deffn
5869 @end deffn
5870
5871 @deffn {Flash Driver} {xcf}
5872 @cindex Xilinx Platform flash driver
5873 @cindex xcf
5874 Xilinx FPGAs can be configured from specialized flash ICs named Platform Flash.
5875 It is (almost) regular NOR flash with erase sectors, program pages, etc. The
5876 only difference is special registers controlling its FPGA specific behavior.
5877 They must be properly configured for successful FPGA loading using
5878 additional @var{xcf} driver command:
5879
5880 @deffn {Command} {xcf ccb} <bank_id>
5881 command accepts additional parameters:
5882 @itemize
5883 @item @var{external|internal} ... selects clock source.
5884 @item @var{serial|parallel} ... selects serial or parallel data bus mode.
5885 @item @var{slave|master} ... selects slave of master mode for flash device.
5886 @item @var{40|20} ... selects clock frequency in MHz for internal clock
5887 in master mode.
5888 @end itemize
5889 @example
5890 xcf ccb 0 external parallel slave 40
5891 @end example
5892 All of them must be specified even if clock frequency is pointless
5893 in slave mode. If only bank id specified than command prints current
5894 CCB register value. Note: there is no need to write this register
5895 every time you erase/program data sectors because it stores in
5896 dedicated sector.
5897 @end deffn
5898
5899 @deffn {Command} {xcf configure} <bank_id>
5900 Initiates FPGA loading procedure. Useful if your board has no "configure"
5901 button.
5902 @example
5903 xcf configure 0
5904 @end example
5905 @end deffn
5906
5907 Additional driver notes:
5908 @itemize
5909 @item Only single revision supported.
5910 @item Driver automatically detects need of bit reverse, but
5911 only "bin" (raw binary, do not confuse it with "bit") and "mcs"
5912 (Intel hex) file types supported.
5913 @item For additional info check xapp972.pdf and ug380.pdf.
5914 @end itemize
5915 @end deffn
5916
5917 @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpcspifi}
5918 @cindex NXP SPI Flash Interface
5919 @cindex SPIFI
5920 @cindex lpcspifi
5921 NXP's LPC43xx and LPC18xx families include a proprietary SPI
5922 Flash Interface (SPIFI) peripheral that can drive and provide
5923 memory mapped access to external SPI flash devices.
5924
5925 The lpcspifi driver initializes this interface and provides
5926 program and erase functionality for these serial flash devices.
5927 Use of this driver @b{requires} a working area of at least 1kB
5928 to be configured on the target device; more than this will
5929 significantly reduce flash programming times.
5930
5931 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter. All
5932 other parameters are ignored, and the flash size and layout
5933 are configured by the driver.
5934
5935 @example
5936 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpcspifi 0x14000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5937 @end example
5938
5939 @end deffn
5940
5941 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stmsmi}
5942 @cindex STMicroelectronics Serial Memory Interface
5943 @cindex SMI
5944 @cindex stmsmi
5945 Some devices from STMicroelectronics (e.g. STR75x MCU family,
5946 SPEAr MPU family) include a proprietary
5947 ``Serial Memory Interface'' (SMI) controller able to drive external
5948 SPI flash devices.
5949 Depending on specific device and board configuration, up to 4 external
5950 flash devices can be connected.
5951
5952 SMI makes the flash content directly accessible in the CPU address
5953 space; each external device is mapped in a memory bank.
5954 CPU can directly read data, execute code and boot from SMI banks.
5955 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
5956 the flash content.
5957
5958 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
5959 to identify the memory bank.
5960 All other parameters are ignored. Additional information, like
5961 flash size, are detected automatically.
5962
5963 @example
5964 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmsmi 0xf8000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5965 @end example
5966
5967 @end deffn
5968
5969 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stmqspi}
5970 @cindex STMicroelectronics QuadSPI/OctoSPI Interface
5971 @cindex QuadSPI
5972 @cindex OctoSPI
5973 @cindex stmqspi
5974 Some devices from STMicroelectronics include a proprietary ``QuadSPI Interface''
5975 (e.g. STM32F4, STM32F7, STM32L4) or ``OctoSPI Interface'' (e.g. STM32L4+)
5976 controller able to drive one or even two (dual mode) external SPI flash devices.
5977 The OctoSPI is a superset of QuadSPI, its presence is detected automatically.
5978 Currently only the regular command mode is supported, whereas the HyperFlash
5979 mode is not.
5980
5981 QuadSPI/OctoSPI makes the flash contents directly accessible in the CPU address
5982 space; in case of dual mode both devices must be of the same type and are
5983 mapped in the same memory bank (even and odd addresses interleaved).
5984 CPU can directly read data, execute code (but not boot) from QuadSPI bank.
5985
5986 The 'flash bank' command only requires the @var{base} parameter and the extra
5987 parameter @var{io_base} in order to identify the memory bank. Both are fixed
5988 by hardware, see datasheet or RM. All other parameters are ignored.
5989
5990 The controller must be initialized after each reset and properly configured
5991 for memory-mapped read operation for the particular flash chip(s), for the full
5992 list of available register settings cf. the controller's RM. This setup is quite
5993 board specific (that's why booting from this memory is not possible). The
5994 flash driver infers all parameters from current controller register values when
5995 'flash probe @var{bank_id}' is executed.
5996
5997 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display the flash content,
5998 but only after proper controller initialization as described above. However,
5999 due to a silicon bug in some devices, attempting to access the very last word
6000 should be avoided.
6001
6002 It is possible to use two (even different) flash chips alternatingly, if individual
6003 bank chip selects are available. For some package variants, this is not the case
6004 due to limited pin count. To switch from one to another, adjust FSEL bit accordingly
6005 and re-issue 'flash probe bank_id'. Note that the bank base address will @emph{not}
6006 change, so the address spaces of both devices will overlap. In dual flash mode
6007 both chips must be identical regarding size and most other properties.
6008
6009 Block or sector protection internal to the flash chip is not handled by this
6010 driver at all, but can be dealt with manually by the 'cmd' command, see below.
6011 The sector protection via 'flash protect' command etc. is completely internal to
6012 openocd, intended only to prevent accidental erase or overwrite and it does not
6013 persist across openocd invocations.
6014
6015 OpenOCD contains a hardcoded list of flash devices with their properties,
6016 these are auto-detected. If a device is not included in this list, SFDP discovery
6017 is attempted. If this fails or gives inappropriate results, manual setting is
6018 required (see 'set' command).
6019
6020 @example
6021 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmqspi 0x90000000 0 0 0 \
6022 $_TARGETNAME 0xA0001000
6023 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmqspi 0x70000000 0 0 0 \
6024 $_TARGETNAME 0xA0001400
6025 @end example
6026
6027 There are three specific commands
6028 @deffn {Command} {stmqspi mass_erase} bank_id
6029 Clears sector protections and performs a mass erase. Works only if there is no
6030 chip specific write protection engaged.
6031 @end deffn
6032
6033 @deffn {Command} {stmqspi set} bank_id name total_size page_size read_cmd fread_cmd pprg_cmd mass_erase_cmd sector_size sector_erase_cmd
6034 Set flash parameters: @var{name} human readable string, @var{total_size} size
6035 in bytes, @var{page_size} is write page size. @var{read_cmd}, @var{fread_cmd} and @var{pprg_cmd}
6036 are commands for reading and page programming. @var{fread_cmd} is used in DPI and QPI modes,
6037 @var{read_cmd} in normal SPI (single line) mode. @var{mass_erase_cmd}, @var{sector_size}
6038 and @var{sector_erase_cmd} are optional.
6039
6040 This command is required if chip id is not hardcoded yet and e.g. for EEPROMs or FRAMs
6041 which don't support an id command.
6042
6043 In dual mode parameters of both chips are set identically. The parameters refer to
6044 a single chip, so the whole bank gets twice the specified capacity etc.
6045 @end deffn
6046
6047 @deffn {Command} {stmqspi cmd} bank_id resp_num cmd_byte ...
6048 If @var{resp_num} is zero, sends command @var{cmd_byte} and following data
6049 bytes. In dual mode command byte is sent to @emph{both} chips but data bytes are
6050 sent @emph{alternatingly} to chip 1 and 2, first to flash 1, second to flash 2, etc.,
6051 i.e. the total number of bytes (including cmd_byte) must be odd.
6052
6053 If @var{resp_num} is not zero, cmd and at most four following data bytes are
6054 sent, in dual mode @emph{simultaneously} to both chips. Then @var{resp_num} bytes
6055 are read interleaved from both chips starting with chip 1. In this case
6056 @var{resp_num} must be even.
6057
6058 Note the hardware dictated subtle difference of those two cases in dual-flash mode.
6059
6060 To check basic communication settings, issue
6061 @example
6062 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x04; stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05
6063 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x06; stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05
6064 @end example
6065 for single flash mode or
6066 @example
6067 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x04; stmqspi cmd bank_id 2 0x05
6068 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x06; stmqspi cmd bank_id 2 0x05
6069 @end example
6070 for dual flash mode. This should return the status register contents.
6071
6072 In 8-line mode, @var{cmd_byte} is sent twice - first time as given, second time
6073 complemented. Additionally, in 8-line mode only, some commands (e.g. Read Status)
6074 need a dummy address, e.g.
6075 @example
6076 stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05 0x00 0x00 0x00 0x00
6077 @end example
6078 should return the status register contents.
6079
6080 @end deffn
6081
6082 @end deffn
6083
6084 @deffn {Flash Driver} {mrvlqspi}
6085 This driver supports QSPI flash controller of Marvell's Wireless
6086 Microcontroller platform.
6087
6088 The flash size is autodetected based on the table of known JEDEC IDs
6089 hardcoded in the OpenOCD sources.
6090
6091 @example
6092 flash bank $_FLASHNAME mrvlqspi 0x0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0x46010000
6093 @end example
6094
6095 @end deffn
6096
6097 @deffn {Flash Driver} {ath79}
6098 @cindex Atheros ath79 SPI driver
6099 @cindex ath79
6100 Members of ATH79 SoC family from Atheros include a SPI interface with 3
6101 chip selects.
6102 On reset a SPI flash connected to the first chip select (CS0) is made
6103 directly read-accessible in the CPU address space (up to 16MBytes)
6104 and is usually used to store the bootloader and operating system.
6105 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
6106 the flash content while it is in memory-mapped mode (only the first
6107 4MBytes are accessible without additional configuration on reset).
6108
6109 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
6110 to identify the memory bank. The actual value for the base address
6111 is not otherwise used by the driver. However the mapping is passed
6112 to gdb. Thus for the memory mapped flash (chipselect CS0) the base
6113 address should be the actual memory mapped base address. For unmapped
6114 chipselects (CS1 and CS2) care should be taken to use a base address
6115 that does not overlap with real memory regions.
6116 Additional information, like flash size, are detected automatically.
6117 An optional additional parameter sets the chipselect for the bank,
6118 with the default CS0.
6119 CS1 and CS2 require additional GPIO setup before they can be used
6120 since the alternate function must be enabled on the GPIO pin
6121 CS1/CS2 is routed to on the given SoC.
6122
6123 @example
6124 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ath79 0xbf000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6125
6126 # When using multiple chipselects the base should be different
6127 # for each, otherwise the write_image command is not able to
6128 # distinguish the banks.
6129 flash bank flash0 ath79 0xbf000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs0
6130 flash bank flash1 ath79 0x10000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs1
6131 flash bank flash2 ath79 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs2
6132 @end example
6133
6134 @end deffn
6135
6136 @deffn {Flash Driver} {fespi}
6137 @cindex Freedom E SPI
6138 @cindex fespi
6139
6140 SiFive's Freedom E SPI controller, used in HiFive and other boards.
6141
6142 @example
6143 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fespi 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6144 @end example
6145 @end deffn
6146
6147 @subsection Internal Flash (Microcontrollers)
6148
6149 @deffn {Flash Driver} {aduc702x}
6150 The ADUC702x analog microcontrollers from Analog Devices
6151 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
6152 The aduc702x flash driver works with models ADUC7019 through ADUC7028.
6153 The setup command only requires the @var{target} argument
6154 since all devices in this family have the same memory layout.
6155
6156 @example
6157 flash bank $_FLASHNAME aduc702x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6158 @end example
6159 @end deffn
6160
6161 @deffn {Flash Driver} {ambiqmicro}
6162 @cindex ambiqmicro
6163 @cindex apollo
6164 All members of the Apollo microcontroller family from
6165 Ambiq Micro include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
6166 The host connects over USB to an FTDI interface that communicates
6167 with the target using SWD.
6168
6169 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver reads the Chip Information Register detect
6170 the device class of the MCU.
6171 The Flash and SRAM sizes directly follow device class, and are used
6172 to set up the flash banks.
6173 If this fails, the driver will use default values set to the minimum
6174 sizes of an Apollo chip.
6175
6176 All Apollo chips have two flash banks of the same size.
6177 In all cases the first flash bank starts at location 0,
6178 and the second bank starts after the first.
6179
6180 @example
6181 # Flash bank 0
6182 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6183 # Flash bank 1 - same size as bank0, starts after bank 0.
6184 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0x00040000 0x00040000 0 0 \
6185 $_TARGETNAME
6186 @end example
6187
6188 Flash is programmed using custom entry points into the bootloader.
6189 This is the only way to program the flash as no flash control registers
6190 are available to the user.
6191
6192 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver adds some additional commands:
6193
6194 @deffn {Command} {ambiqmicro mass_erase} <bank>
6195 Erase entire bank.
6196 @end deffn
6197 @deffn {Command} {ambiqmicro page_erase} <bank> <first> <last>
6198 Erase device pages.
6199 @end deffn
6200 @deffn {Command} {ambiqmicro program_otp} <bank> <offset> <count>
6201 Program OTP is a one time operation to create write protected flash.
6202 The user writes sectors to SRAM starting at 0x10000010.
6203 Program OTP will write these sectors from SRAM to flash, and write protect
6204 the flash.
6205 @end deffn
6206 @end deffn
6207
6208 @anchor{at91samd}
6209 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91samd}
6210 @cindex at91samd
6211 All members of the ATSAM D2x, D1x, D0x, ATSAMR, ATSAML and ATSAMC microcontroller
6212 families from Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M0+ core.
6213
6214 Do not use for ATSAM D51 and E5x: use @xref{atsame5}.
6215
6216 The devices have one flash bank:
6217
6218 @example
6219 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91samd 0x00000000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
6220 @end example
6221
6222 @deffn {Command} {at91samd chip-erase}
6223 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
6224 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
6225 processor to be halted.
6226 @end deffn
6227
6228 @deffn {Command} {at91samd set-security}
6229 Secures the Flash via the Set Security Bit (SSB) command. This prevents access
6230 to the Flash and can only be undone by using the chip-erase command which
6231 erases the Flash contents and turns off the security bit. Warning: at this
6232 time, openocd will not be able to communicate with a secured chip and it is
6233 therefore not possible to chip-erase it without using another tool.
6234
6235 @example
6236 at91samd set-security enable
6237 @end example
6238 @end deffn
6239
6240 @deffn {Command} {at91samd eeprom}
6241 Shows or sets the EEPROM emulation size configuration, stored in the User Row
6242 of the Flash. When setting, the EEPROM size must be specified in bytes and it
6243 must be one of the permitted sizes according to the datasheet. Settings are
6244 written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset. EEPROM emulation
6245 requires additional firmware support and the minimum EEPROM size may not be
6246 the same as the minimum that the hardware supports. Set the EEPROM size to 0
6247 in order to disable this feature.
6248
6249 @example
6250 at91samd eeprom
6251 at91samd eeprom 1024
6252 @end example
6253 @end deffn
6254
6255 @deffn {Command} {at91samd bootloader}
6256 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Row of the
6257 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
6258 must be specified in bytes and it must be one of the permitted sizes according
6259 to the datasheet. Settings are written immediately but only take effect on
6260 MCU reset. Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
6261
6262 @example
6263 at91samd bootloader
6264 at91samd bootloader 16384
6265 @end example
6266 @end deffn
6267
6268 @deffn {Command} {at91samd dsu_reset_deassert}
6269 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
6270 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
6271 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
6272 @end deffn
6273
6274 @deffn {Command} {at91samd nvmuserrow}
6275 Writes or reads the entire 64 bit wide NVM user row register which is located at
6276 0x804000. This register includes various fuses lock-bits and factory calibration
6277 data. Reading the register is done by invoking this command without any
6278 arguments. Writing is possible by giving 1 or 2 hex values. The first argument
6279 is the register value to be written and the second one is an optional changemask.
6280 Every bit which value in changemask is 0 will stay unchanged. The lock- and
6281 reserved-bits are masked out and cannot be changed.
6282
6283 @example
6284 # Read user row
6285 >at91samd nvmuserrow
6286 NVMUSERROW: 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
6287 # Write 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788 to user row
6288 >at91samd nvmuserrow 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
6289 # Write 0x12300 to user row but leave other bits and low
6290 # byte unchanged
6291 >at91samd nvmuserrow 0x12345 0xFFF00
6292 @end example
6293 @end deffn
6294
6295 @end deffn
6296
6297 @anchor{at91sam3}
6298 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam3}
6299 @cindex at91sam3
6300 All members of the AT91SAM3 microcontroller family from
6301 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M3 core. The driver
6302 currently (6/22/09) recognizes the AT91SAM3U[1/2/4][C/E] chips. Note
6303 that the driver was orginaly developed and tested using the
6304 AT91SAM3U4E, using a SAM3U-EK eval board. Support for other chips in
6305 the family was cribbed from the data sheet. @emph{Note to future
6306 readers/updaters: Please remove this worrisome comment after other
6307 chips are confirmed.}
6308
6309 The AT91SAM3U4[E/C] (256K) chips have two flash banks; most other chips
6310 have one flash bank. In all cases the flash banks are at
6311 the following fixed locations:
6312
6313 @example
6314 # Flash bank 0 - all chips
6315 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00080000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
6316 # Flash bank 1 - only 256K chips
6317 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00100000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
6318 @end example
6319
6320 Internally, the AT91SAM3 flash memory is organized as follows.
6321 Unlike the AT91SAM7 chips, these are not used as parameters
6322 to the @command{flash bank} command:
6323
6324 @itemize
6325 @item @emph{N-Banks:} 256K chips have 2 banks, others have 1 bank.
6326 @item @emph{Bank Size:} 128K/64K Per flash bank
6327 @item @emph{Sectors:} 16 or 8 per bank
6328 @item @emph{SectorSize:} 8K Per Sector
6329 @item @emph{PageSize:} 256 bytes per page. Note that OpenOCD operates on 'sector' sizes, not page sizes.
6330 @end itemize
6331
6332 The AT91SAM3 driver adds some additional commands:
6333
6334 @deffn {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm}
6335 @deffnx {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm clear} number
6336 @deffnx {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm set} number
6337 @deffnx {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm show} [@option{all}|number]
6338 With no parameters, @command{show} or @command{show all},
6339 shows the status of all GPNVM bits.
6340 With @command{show} @var{number}, displays that bit.
6341
6342 With @command{set} @var{number} or @command{clear} @var{number},
6343 modifies that GPNVM bit.
6344 @end deffn
6345
6346 @deffn {Command} {at91sam3 info}
6347 This command attempts to display information about the AT91SAM3
6348 chip. @emph{First} it read the @code{CHIPID_CIDR} [address 0x400e0740, see
6349 Section 28.2.1, page 505 of the AT91SAM3U 29/may/2009 datasheet,
6350 document id: doc6430A] and decodes the values. @emph{Second} it reads the
6351 various clock configuration registers and attempts to display how it
6352 believes the chip is configured. By default, the SLOWCLK is assumed to
6353 be 32768 Hz, see the command @command{at91sam3 slowclk}.
6354 @end deffn
6355
6356 @deffn {Command} {at91sam3 slowclk} [value]
6357 This command shows/sets the slow clock frequency used in the
6358 @command{at91sam3 info} command calculations above.
6359 @end deffn
6360 @end deffn
6361
6362 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam4}
6363 @cindex at91sam4
6364 All members of the AT91SAM4 microcontroller family from
6365 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
6366 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
6367 @end deffn
6368
6369 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam4l}
6370 @cindex at91sam4l
6371 All members of the AT91SAM4L microcontroller family from
6372 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
6373 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
6374
6375 The AT91SAM4L driver adds some additional commands:
6376 @deffn {Command} {at91sam4l smap_reset_deassert}
6377 This command releases internal reset held by SMAP
6378 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
6379 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
6380 @end deffn
6381 @end deffn
6382
6383 @anchor{atsame5}
6384 @deffn {Flash Driver} {atsame5}
6385 @cindex atsame5
6386 All members of the SAM E54, E53, E51 and D51 microcontroller
6387 families from Microchip (former Atmel) include internal flash
6388 and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
6389
6390 The devices have two ECC flash banks with a swapping feature.
6391 This driver handles both banks together as it were one.
6392 Bank swapping is not supported yet.
6393
6394 @example
6395 flash bank $_FLASHNAME atsame5 0x00000000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
6396 @end example
6397
6398 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 bootloader}
6399 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Page of the
6400 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
6401 must be specified in bytes. The nearest bigger protection size is used.
6402 Settings are written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset.
6403 Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
6404
6405 @example
6406 atsame5 bootloader
6407 atsame5 bootloader 16384
6408 @end example
6409 @end deffn
6410
6411 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 chip-erase}
6412 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
6413 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
6414 processor to be halted.
6415 @end deffn
6416
6417 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 dsu_reset_deassert}
6418 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
6419 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
6420 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
6421 @end deffn
6422
6423 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 userpage}
6424 Writes or reads the first 64 bits of NVM User Page which is located at
6425 0x804000. This field includes various fuses.
6426 Reading is done by invoking this command without any arguments.
6427 Writing is possible by giving 1 or 2 hex values. The first argument
6428 is the value to be written and the second one is an optional bit mask
6429 (a zero bit in the mask means the bit stays unchanged).
6430 The reserved fields are always masked out and cannot be changed.
6431
6432 @example
6433 # Read
6434 >atsame5 userpage
6435 USER PAGE: 0xAEECFF80FE9A9239
6436 # Write
6437 >atsame5 userpage 0xAEECFF80FE9A9239
6438 # Write 2 to SEESBLK and 4 to SEEPSZ fields but leave other
6439 # bits unchanged (setup SmartEEPROM of virtual size 8192
6440 # bytes)
6441 >atsame5 userpage 0x4200000000 0x7f00000000
6442 @end example
6443 @end deffn
6444
6445 @end deffn
6446
6447 @deffn {Flash Driver} {atsamv}
6448 @cindex atsamv
6449 All members of the ATSAMV7x, ATSAMS70, and ATSAME70 families from
6450 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M7 core.
6451 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
6452
6453 @example
6454 flash bank $_FLASHNAME atsamv 0x00400000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6455 @end example
6456
6457 @deffn {Command} {atsamv gpnvm} [@option{show} [@option{all}|number]]
6458 @deffnx {Command} {atsamv gpnvm} (@option{clr}|@option{set}) number
6459 With no parameters, @option{show} or @option{show all},
6460 shows the status of all GPNVM bits.
6461 With @option{show} @var{number}, displays that bit.
6462
6463 With @option{set} @var{number} or @option{clear} @var{number},
6464 modifies that GPNVM bit.
6465 @end deffn
6466
6467 @end deffn
6468
6469 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam7}
6470 All members of the AT91SAM7 microcontroller family from Atmel include
6471 internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores. The driver automatically
6472 recognizes a number of these chips using the chip identification
6473 register, and autoconfigures itself.
6474
6475 @example
6476 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam7 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6477 @end example
6478
6479 For chips which are not recognized by the controller driver, you must
6480 provide additional parameters in the following order:
6481
6482 @itemize
6483 @item @var{chip_model} ... label used with @command{flash info}
6484 @item @var{banks}
6485 @item @var{sectors_per_bank}
6486 @item @var{pages_per_sector}
6487 @item @var{pages_size}
6488 @item @var{num_nvm_bits}
6489 @item @var{freq_khz} ... required if an external clock is provided,
6490 optional (but recommended) when the oscillator frequency is known
6491 @end itemize
6492
6493 It is recommended that you provide zeroes for all of those values
6494 except the clock frequency, so that everything except that frequency
6495 will be autoconfigured.
6496 Knowing the frequency helps ensure correct timings for flash access.
6497
6498 The flash controller handles erases automatically on a page (128/256 byte)
6499 basis, so explicit erase commands are not necessary for flash programming.
6500 However, there is an ``EraseAll`` command that can erase an entire flash
6501 plane (of up to 256KB), and it will be used automatically when you issue
6502 @command{flash erase_sector} or @command{flash erase_address} commands.
6503
6504 @deffn {Command} {at91sam7 gpnvm} bitnum (@option{set}|@option{clear})
6505 Set or clear a ``General Purpose Non-Volatile Memory'' (GPNVM)
6506 bit for the processor. Each processor has a number of such bits,
6507 used for controlling features such as brownout detection (so they
6508 are not truly general purpose).
6509 @quotation Note
6510 This assumes that the first flash bank (number 0) is associated with
6511 the appropriate at91sam7 target.
6512 @end quotation
6513 @end deffn
6514 @end deffn
6515
6516 @deffn {Flash Driver} {avr}
6517 The AVR 8-bit microcontrollers from Atmel integrate flash memory.
6518 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete.}
6519 @comment - defines mass_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
6520 @end deffn
6521
6522 @deffn {Flash Driver} {bluenrg-x}
6523 STMicroelectronics BlueNRG-1, BlueNRG-2 and BlueNRG-LP/LPS Bluetooth low energy wireless system-on-chip. They include ARM Cortex-M0/M0+ core and internal flash memory.
6524 The driver automatically recognizes these chips using
6525 the chip identification registers, and autoconfigures itself.
6526
6527 @example
6528 flash bank $_FLASHNAME bluenrg-x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6529 @end example
6530
6531 Note that when users ask to erase all the sectors of the flash, a mass erase command is used which is faster than erasing
6532 each single sector one by one.
6533
6534 @example
6535 flash erase_sector 0 0 last # It will perform a mass erase
6536 @end example
6537
6538 Triggering a mass erase is also useful when users want to disable readout protection.
6539 @end deffn
6540
6541 @deffn {Flash Driver} {cc26xx}
6542 All versions of the SimpleLink CC13xx and CC26xx microcontrollers from Texas
6543 Instruments include internal flash. The cc26xx flash driver supports both the
6544 CC13xx and CC26xx family of devices. The driver automatically recognizes the
6545 specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself. The flash bank
6546 starts at address 0.
6547
6548 @example
6549 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc26xx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6550 @end example
6551 @end deffn
6552
6553 @deffn {Flash Driver} {cc3220sf}
6554 The CC3220SF version of the SimpleLink CC32xx microcontrollers from Texas
6555 Instruments includes 1MB of internal flash. The cc3220sf flash driver only
6556 supports the internal flash. The serial flash on SimpleLink boards is
6557 programmed via the bootloader over a UART connection. Security features of
6558 the CC3220SF may erase the internal flash during power on reset. Refer to
6559 documentation at @url{www.ti.com/cc3220sf} for details on security features
6560 and programming the serial flash.
6561
6562 @example
6563 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc3220sf 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6564 @end example
6565 @end deffn
6566
6567 @deffn {Flash Driver} {efm32}
6568 All members of the EFM32/EFR32 microcontroller family from Energy Micro (now Silicon Labs)
6569 include internal flash and use Arm Cortex-M3 or Cortex-M4 cores. The driver automatically
6570 recognizes a number of these chips using the chip identification register, and
6571 autoconfigures itself.
6572 @example
6573 flash bank $_FLASHNAME efm32 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6574 @end example
6575 It supports writing to the user data page, as well as the portion of the lockbits page
6576 past 512 bytes on chips with larger page sizes. The latter is used by the SiLabs
6577 bootloader/AppLoader system for encryption keys. Setting protection on these pages is
6578 currently not supported.
6579 @example
6580 flash bank userdata.flash efm32 0x0FE00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6581 flash bank lockbits.flash efm32 0x0FE04000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6582 @end example
6583
6584 A special feature of efm32 controllers is that it is possible to completely disable the
6585 debug interface by writing the correct values to the 'Debug Lock Word'. OpenOCD supports
6586 this via the following command:
6587 @example
6588 efm32 debuglock num
6589 @end example
6590 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6591 Note that in order for this command to take effect, the target needs to be reset.
6592 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Unprotecting flash pages is not
6593 supported.}
6594 @end deffn
6595
6596 @deffn {Flash Driver} {esirisc}
6597 Members of the eSi-RISC family may optionally include internal flash programmed
6598 via the eSi-TSMC Flash interface. Additional parameters are required to
6599 configure the driver: @option{cfg_address} is the base address of the
6600 configuration register interface, @option{clock_hz} is the expected clock
6601 frequency, and @option{wait_states} is the number of configured read wait states.
6602
6603 @example
6604 flash bank $_FLASHNAME esirisc base_address size_bytes 0 0 \
6605 $_TARGETNAME cfg_address clock_hz wait_states
6606 @end example
6607
6608 @deffn {Command} {esirisc flash mass_erase} bank_id
6609 Erase all pages in data memory for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}.
6610 @end deffn
6611
6612 @deffn {Command} {esirisc flash ref_erase} bank_id
6613 Erase the reference cell for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}. @emph{This
6614 is an uncommon operation.}
6615 @end deffn
6616 @end deffn
6617
6618 @deffn {Flash Driver} {fm3}
6619 All members of the FM3 microcontroller family from Fujitsu
6620 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6621 The @var{fm3} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
6622 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
6623 @code{mb9bfxx1.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx2.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx3.cpu},
6624 @code{mb9bfxx4.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx5.cpu} or @code{mb9bfxx6.cpu}.
6625
6626 @example
6627 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fm3 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6628 @end example
6629 @end deffn
6630
6631 @deffn {Flash Driver} {fm4}
6632 All members of the FM4 microcontroller family from Spansion (formerly Fujitsu)
6633 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M4 cores.
6634 The @var{fm4} driver uses a @var{family} parameter to select the
6635 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
6636 @code{MB9BFx64}, @code{MB9BFx65}, @code{MB9BFx66}, @code{MB9BFx67}, @code{MB9BFx68},
6637 @code{S6E2Cx8}, @code{S6E2Cx9}, @code{S6E2CxA} or @code{S6E2Dx},
6638 with @code{x} treated as wildcard and otherwise case (and any trailing
6639 characters) ignored.
6640
6641 @example
6642 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}0 fm4 0x00000000 0 0 0 \
6643 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
6644 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}1 fm4 0x00100000 0 0 0 \
6645 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
6646 @end example
6647 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Protection is not supported,
6648 nor is Chip Erase (only Sector Erase is implemented).}
6649 @end deffn
6650
6651 @deffn {Flash Driver} {kinetis}
6652 @cindex kinetis
6653 Kx, KLx, KVx and KE1x members of the Kinetis microcontroller family
6654 from NXP (former Freescale) include
6655 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+ or M4 cores. The driver automatically
6656 recognizes flash size and a number of flash banks (1-4) using the chip
6657 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6658 Use kinetis_ke driver for KE0x and KEAx devices.
6659
6660 The @var{kinetis} driver defines option:
6661 @itemize
6662 @item -sim-base @var{addr} ... base of System Integration Module where chip identification resides. Driver tries two known locations if option is omitted.
6663 @end itemize
6664
6665 @example
6666 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6667 @end example
6668
6669 @deffn {Config Command} {kinetis create_banks}
6670 Configuration command enables automatic creation of additional flash banks
6671 based on real flash layout of device. Banks are created during device probe.
6672 Use 'flash probe 0' to force probe.
6673 @end deffn
6674
6675 @deffn {Command} {kinetis fcf_source} [protection|write]
6676 Select what source is used when writing to a Flash Configuration Field.
6677 @option{protection} mode builds FCF content from protection bits previously
6678 set by 'flash protect' command.
6679 This mode is default. MCU is protected from unwanted locking by immediate
6680 writing FCF after erase of relevant sector.
6681 @option{write} mode enables direct write to FCF.
6682 Protection cannot be set by 'flash protect' command. FCF is written along
6683 with the rest of a flash image.
6684 @emph{BEWARE: Incorrect flash configuration may permanently lock the device!}
6685 @end deffn
6686
6687 @deffn {Command} {kinetis fopt} [num]
6688 Set value to write to FOPT byte of Flash Configuration Field.
6689 Used in kinetis 'fcf_source protection' mode only.
6690 @end deffn
6691
6692 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm check_security}
6693 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end
6694 and examine-fail event.
6695 @end deffn
6696
6697 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm halt}
6698 Issues a halt via the MDM-AP. This command can be used to break a watchdog reset
6699 loop when connecting to an unsecured target.
6700 @end deffn
6701
6702 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm mass_erase}
6703 Issues a complete flash erase via the MDM-AP. This can be used to erase a chip
6704 back to its factory state, removing security. It does not require the processor
6705 to be halted, however the target will remain in a halted state after this
6706 command completes.
6707 @end deffn
6708
6709 @deffn {Command} {kinetis nvm_partition}
6710 For FlexNVM devices only (KxxDX and KxxFX).
6711 Command shows or sets data flash or EEPROM backup size in kilobytes,
6712 sets two EEPROM blocks sizes in bytes and enables/disables loading
6713 of EEPROM contents to FlexRAM during reset.
6714
6715 For details see device reference manual, Flash Memory Module,
6716 Program Partition command.
6717
6718 Setting is possible only once after mass_erase.
6719 Reset the device after partition setting.
6720
6721 Show partition size:
6722 @example
6723 kinetis nvm_partition info
6724 @end example
6725
6726 Set 32 KB data flash, rest of FlexNVM is EEPROM backup. EEPROM has two blocks
6727 of 512 and 1536 bytes and its contents is loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
6728 @example
6729 kinetis nvm_partition dataflash 32 512 1536 on
6730 @end example
6731
6732 Set 16 KB EEPROM backup, rest of FlexNVM is a data flash. EEPROM has two blocks
6733 of 1024 bytes and its contents is not loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
6734 @example
6735 kinetis nvm_partition eebkp 16 1024 1024 off
6736 @end example
6737 @end deffn
6738
6739 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm reset}
6740 Issues a reset via the MDM-AP. This causes the MCU to output a low pulse on the
6741 RESET pin, which can be used to reset other hardware on board.
6742 @end deffn
6743
6744 @deffn {Command} {kinetis disable_wdog}
6745 For Kx devices only (KLx has different COP watchdog, it is not supported).
6746 Command disables watchdog timer.
6747 @end deffn
6748 @end deffn
6749
6750 @deffn {Flash Driver} {kinetis_ke}
6751 @cindex kinetis_ke
6752 KE0x and KEAx members of the Kinetis microcontroller family from NXP include
6753 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+. The driver automatically recognizes
6754 the KE0x sub-family using the chip identification register, and
6755 autoconfigures itself.
6756 Use kinetis (not kinetis_ke) driver for KE1x devices.
6757
6758 @example
6759 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis_ke 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6760 @end example
6761
6762 @deffn {Command} {kinetis_ke mdm check_security}
6763 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end event.
6764 @end deffn
6765
6766 @deffn {Command} {kinetis_ke mdm mass_erase}
6767 Issues a complete Flash erase via the MDM-AP.
6768 This can be used to erase a chip back to its factory state.
6769 Command removes security lock from a device (use of SRST highly recommended).
6770 It does not require the processor to be halted.
6771 @end deffn
6772
6773 @deffn {Command} {kinetis_ke disable_wdog}
6774 Command disables watchdog timer.
6775 @end deffn
6776 @end deffn
6777
6778 @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpc2000}
6779 This is the driver to support internal flash of all members of the
6780 LPC11(x)00 and LPC1300 microcontroller families and most members of
6781 the LPC800, LPC1500, LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4000, LPC54100,
6782 LPC8Nxx and NHS31xx microcontroller families from NXP.
6783
6784 @quotation Note
6785 There are LPC2000 devices which are not supported by the @var{lpc2000}
6786 driver:
6787 The LPC2888 is supported by the @var{lpc288x} driver.
6788 The LPC29xx family is supported by the @var{lpc2900} driver.
6789 @end quotation
6790
6791 The @var{lpc2000} driver defines two mandatory and two optional parameters,
6792 which must appear in the following order:
6793
6794 @itemize
6795 @item @var{variant} ... required, may be
6796 @option{lpc2000_v1} (older LPC21xx and LPC22xx)
6797 @option{lpc2000_v2} (LPC213x, LPC214x, LPC210[123], LPC23xx and LPC24xx)
6798 @option{lpc1700} (LPC175x and LPC176x and LPC177x/8x)
6799 @option{lpc4300} - available also as @option{lpc1800} alias (LPC18x[2357] and
6800 LPC43x[2357])
6801 @option{lpc800} (LPC8xx)
6802 @option{lpc1100} (LPC11(x)xx and LPC13xx)
6803 @option{lpc1500} (LPC15xx)
6804 @option{lpc54100} (LPC541xx)
6805 @option{lpc4000} (LPC40xx)
6806 or @option{auto} - automatically detects flash variant and size for LPC11(x)00,
6807 LPC8xx, LPC13xx, LPC17xx, LPC40xx, LPC8Nxx and NHS31xx
6808 @item @var{clock_kHz} ... the frequency, in kiloHertz,
6809 at which the core is running
6810 @item @option{calc_checksum} ... optional (but you probably want to provide this!),
6811 telling the driver to calculate a valid checksum for the exception vector table.
6812 @quotation Note
6813 If you don't provide @option{calc_checksum} when you're writing the vector
6814 table, the boot ROM will almost certainly ignore your flash image.
6815 However, if you do provide it,
6816 with most tool chains @command{verify_image} will fail.
6817 @end quotation
6818 @item @option{iap_entry} ... optional telling the driver to use a different
6819 ROM IAP entry point.
6820 @end itemize
6821
6822 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6823
6824 @example
6825 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000 0x0 0x7d000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME \
6826 lpc2000_v2 14765 calc_checksum
6827 @end example
6828
6829 @deffn {Command} {lpc2000 part_id} bank
6830 Displays the four byte part identifier associated with
6831 the specified flash @var{bank}.
6832 @end deffn
6833 @end deffn
6834
6835 @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpc288x}
6836 The LPC2888 microcontroller from NXP needs slightly different flash
6837 support from its lpc2000 siblings.
6838 The @var{lpc288x} driver defines one mandatory parameter,
6839 the programming clock rate in Hz.
6840 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6841
6842 @example
6843 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc288x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 12000000
6844 @end example
6845 @end deffn
6846
6847 @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpc2900}
6848 This driver supports the LPC29xx ARM968E based microcontroller family
6849 from NXP.
6850
6851 The predefined parameters @var{base}, @var{size}, @var{chip_width} and
6852 @var{bus_width} of the @code{flash bank} command are ignored. Flash size and
6853 sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
6854 The driver has one additional mandatory parameter: The CPU clock rate
6855 (in kHz) at the time the flash operations will take place. Most of the time this
6856 will not be the crystal frequency, but a higher PLL frequency. The
6857 @code{reset-init} event handler in the board script is usually the place where
6858 you start the PLL.
6859
6860 The driver rejects flashless devices (currently the LPC2930).
6861
6862 The EEPROM in LPC2900 devices is not mapped directly into the address space.
6863 It must be handled much more like NAND flash memory, and will therefore be
6864 handled by a separate @code{lpc2900_eeprom} driver (not yet available).
6865
6866 Sector protection in terms of the LPC2900 is handled transparently. Every time a
6867 sector needs to be erased or programmed, it is automatically unprotected.
6868 What is shown as protection status in the @code{flash info} command, is
6869 actually the LPC2900 @emph{sector security}. This is a mechanism to prevent a
6870 sector from ever being erased or programmed again. As this is an irreversible
6871 mechanism, it is handled by a special command (@code{lpc2900 secure_sector}),
6872 and not by the standard @code{flash protect} command.
6873
6874 Example for a 125 MHz clock frequency:
6875 @example
6876 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2900 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 125000
6877 @end example
6878
6879 Some @code{lpc2900}-specific commands are defined. In the following command list,
6880 the @var{bank} parameter is the bank number as obtained by the
6881 @code{flash banks} command.
6882
6883 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 signature} bank
6884 Calculates a 128-bit hash value, the @emph{signature}, from the whole flash
6885 content. This is a hardware feature of the flash block, hence the calculation is
6886 very fast. You may use this to verify the content of a programmed device against
6887 a known signature.
6888 Example:
6889 @example
6890 lpc2900 signature 0
6891 signature: 0x5f40cdc8:0xc64e592e:0x10490f89:0x32a0f317
6892 @end example
6893 @end deffn
6894
6895 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 read_custom} bank filename
6896 Reads the 912 bytes of customer information from the flash index sector, and
6897 saves it to a file in binary format.
6898 Example:
6899 @example
6900 lpc2900 read_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin
6901 @end example
6902 @end deffn
6903
6904 The index sector of the flash is a @emph{write-only} sector. It cannot be
6905 erased! In order to guard against unintentional write access, all following
6906 commands need to be preceded by a successful call to the @code{password}
6907 command:
6908
6909 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 password} bank password
6910 You need to use this command right before each of the following commands:
6911 @code{lpc2900 write_custom}, @code{lpc2900 secure_sector},
6912 @code{lpc2900 secure_jtag}.
6913
6914 The password string is fixed to "I_know_what_I_am_doing".
6915 Example:
6916 @example
6917 lpc2900 password 0 I_know_what_I_am_doing
6918 Potentially dangerous operation allowed in next command!
6919 @end example
6920 @end deffn
6921
6922 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 write_custom} bank filename type
6923 Writes the content of the file into the customer info space of the flash index
6924 sector. The filetype can be specified with the @var{type} field. Possible values
6925 for @var{type} are: @var{bin} (binary), @var{ihex} (Intel hex format),
6926 @var{elf} (ELF binary) or @var{s19} (Motorola S-records). The file must
6927 contain a single section, and the contained data length must be exactly
6928 912 bytes.
6929 @quotation Attention
6930 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6931 @end quotation
6932 Example:
6933 @example
6934 lpc2900 write_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin bin
6935 @end example
6936 @end deffn
6937
6938 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 secure_sector} bank first last
6939 Secures the sector range from @var{first} to @var{last} (including) against
6940 further program and erase operations. The sector security will be effective
6941 after the next power cycle.
6942 @quotation Attention
6943 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6944 @end quotation
6945 Secured sectors appear as @emph{protected} in the @code{flash info} command.
6946 Example:
6947 @example
6948 lpc2900 secure_sector 0 1 1
6949 flash info 0
6950 #0 : lpc2900 at 0x20000000, size 0x000c0000, (...)
6951 # 0: 0x00000000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
6952 # 1: 0x00002000 (0x2000 8kB) protected
6953 # 2: 0x00004000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
6954 @end example
6955 @end deffn
6956
6957 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 secure_jtag} bank
6958 Irreversibly disable the JTAG port. The new JTAG security setting will be
6959 effective after the next power cycle.
6960 @quotation Attention
6961 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6962 @end quotation
6963 Examples:
6964 @example
6965 lpc2900 secure_jtag 0
6966 @end example
6967 @end deffn
6968 @end deffn
6969
6970 @deffn {Flash Driver} {mdr}
6971 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on Milandr Cortex-M
6972 based controllers. A known limitation is that the Info memory can't be
6973 read or verified as it's not memory mapped.
6974
6975 @example
6976 flash bank <name> mdr <base> <size> \
6977 0 0 <target#> @var{type} @var{page_count} @var{sec_count}
6978 @end example
6979
6980 @itemize @bullet
6981 @item @var{type} - 0 for main memory, 1 for info memory
6982 @item @var{page_count} - total number of pages
6983 @item @var{sec_count} - number of sector per page count
6984 @end itemize
6985
6986 Example usage:
6987 @example
6988 if @{ [info exists IMEMORY] && [string equal $IMEMORY true] @} @{
6989 flash bank $@{_CHIPNAME@}_info.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x01000 \
6990 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 1 1 4
6991 @} else @{
6992 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x20000 \
6993 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0 32 4
6994 @}
6995 @end example
6996 @end deffn
6997
6998 @deffn {Flash Driver} {msp432}
6999 All versions of the SimpleLink MSP432 microcontrollers from Texas
7000 Instruments include internal flash. The msp432 flash driver automatically
7001 recognizes the specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself.
7002 Main program flash starts at address 0. The information flash region on
7003 MSP432P4 versions starts at address 0x200000.
7004
7005 @example
7006 flash bank $_FLASHNAME msp432 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7007 @end example
7008
7009 @deffn {Command} {msp432 mass_erase} bank_id [main|all]
7010 Performs a complete erase of flash. By default, @command{mass_erase} will erase
7011 only the main program flash.
7012
7013 On MSP432P4 versions, using @command{mass_erase all} will erase both the
7014 main program and information flash regions. To also erase the BSL in information
7015 flash, the user must first use the @command{bsl} command.
7016 @end deffn
7017
7018 @deffn {Command} {msp432 bsl} bank_id [unlock|lock]
7019 On MSP432P4 versions, @command{bsl} unlocks and locks the bootstrap loader (BSL)
7020 region in information flash so that flash commands can erase or write the BSL.
7021 Leave the BSL locked to prevent accidentally corrupting the bootstrap loader.
7022
7023 To erase and program the BSL:
7024 @example
7025 msp432 bsl unlock
7026 flash erase_address 0x202000 0x2000
7027 flash write_image bsl.bin 0x202000
7028 msp432 bsl lock
7029 @end example
7030 @end deffn
7031 @end deffn
7032
7033 @deffn {Flash Driver} {niietcm4}
7034 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on NIIET Cortex-M4
7035 based controllers. Flash size and sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
7036 Main flash memory is called "Bootflash" and has main region and info region.
7037 Info region is NOT memory mapped by default,
7038 but it can replace first part of main region if needed.
7039 Full erase, single and block writes are supported for both main and info regions.
7040 There is additional not memory mapped flash called "Userflash", which
7041 also have division into regions: main and info.
7042 Purpose of userflash - to store system and user settings.
7043 Driver has special commands to perform operations with this memory.
7044
7045 @example
7046 flash bank $_FLASHNAME niietcm4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7047 @end example
7048
7049 Some niietcm4-specific commands are defined:
7050
7051 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_read_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address
7052 Read byte from main or info userflash region.
7053 @end deffn
7054
7055 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_write_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address value
7056 Write byte to main or info userflash region.
7057 @end deffn
7058
7059 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_full_erase} bank
7060 Erase all userflash including info region.
7061 @end deffn
7062
7063 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_erase} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector
7064 Erase sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
7065 @end deffn
7066
7067 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_protect_check} bank ('main'|'info')
7068 Check sectors protect.
7069 @end deffn
7070
7071 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_protect} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector ('on'|'off')
7072 Protect sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
7073 @end deffn
7074
7075 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 bflash_info_remap} bank ('on'|'off')
7076 Enable remapping bootflash info region to 0x00000000 (or 0x40000000 if external memory boot used).
7077 @end deffn
7078
7079 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 extmem_cfg} bank ('gpioa'|'gpiob'|'gpioc'|'gpiod'|'gpioe'|'gpiof'|'gpiog'|'gpioh') pin_num ('func1'|'func3')
7080 Configure external memory interface for boot.
7081 @end deffn
7082
7083 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 service_mode_erase} bank
7084 Perform emergency erase of all flash (bootflash and userflash).
7085 @end deffn
7086
7087 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 driver_info} bank
7088 Show information about flash driver.
7089 @end deffn
7090
7091 @end deffn
7092
7093 @deffn {Flash Driver} {npcx}
7094 All versions of the NPCX microcontroller families from Nuvoton include internal
7095 flash. The NPCX flash driver supports the NPCX family of devices. The driver
7096 automatically recognizes the specific version's flash parameters and
7097 autoconfigures itself. The flash bank starts at address 0x64000000.
7098
7099 @example
7100 flash bank $_FLASHNAME npcx 0x64000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7101 @end example
7102 @end deffn
7103
7104 @deffn {Flash Driver} {nrf5}
7105 All members of the nRF51 microcontroller families from Nordic Semiconductor
7106 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 core. nRF52 family powered
7107 by ARM Cortex-M4 or M4F core is supported too. nRF52832 is fully supported
7108 including BPROT flash protection scheme. nRF52833 and nRF52840 devices are
7109 supported with the exception of security extensions (flash access control list
7110 - ACL).
7111
7112 @example
7113 flash bank $_FLASHNAME nrf5 0 0x00000000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7114 @end example
7115
7116 Some nrf5-specific commands are defined:
7117
7118 @deffn {Command} {nrf5 mass_erase}
7119 Erases the contents of the code memory and user information
7120 configuration registers as well. It must be noted that this command
7121 works only for chips that do not have factory pre-programmed region 0
7122 code.
7123 @end deffn
7124
7125 @deffn {Command} {nrf5 info}
7126 Decodes and shows information from FICR and UICR registers.
7127 @end deffn
7128
7129 @end deffn
7130
7131 @deffn {Flash Driver} {ocl}
7132 This driver is an implementation of the ``on chip flash loader''
7133 protocol proposed by Pavel Chromy.
7134
7135 It is a minimalistic command-response protocol intended to be used
7136 over a DCC when communicating with an internal or external flash
7137 loader running from RAM. An example implementation for AT91SAM7x is
7138 available in @file{contrib/loaders/flash/at91sam7x/}.
7139
7140 @example
7141 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ocl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7142 @end example
7143 @end deffn
7144
7145 @deffn {Flash Driver} {pic32mx}
7146 The PIC32MX microcontrollers are based on the MIPS 4K cores,
7147 and integrate flash memory.
7148
7149 @example
7150 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7151 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1d000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7152 @end example
7153
7154 @comment numerous *disabled* commands are defined:
7155 @comment - chip_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
7156 @comment - lock, unlock ... pointless given protect on/off (yes?)
7157 @comment - pgm_word ... shouldn't bank be deduced from address??
7158 Some pic32mx-specific commands are defined:
7159 @deffn {Command} {pic32mx pgm_word} address value bank
7160 Programs the specified 32-bit @var{value} at the given @var{address}
7161 in the specified chip @var{bank}.
7162 @end deffn
7163 @deffn {Command} {pic32mx unlock} bank
7164 Unlock and erase specified chip @var{bank}.
7165 This will remove any Code Protection.
7166 @end deffn
7167 @end deffn
7168
7169 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc4}
7170 All members of the PSoC 41xx/42xx microcontroller family from Cypress
7171 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 cores.
7172 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7173 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7174
7175 Note: Erased internal flash reads as 00.
7176 System ROM of PSoC 4 does not implement erase of a flash sector.
7177
7178 @example
7179 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7180 @end example
7181
7182 psoc4-specific commands
7183 @deffn {Command} {psoc4 flash_autoerase} num (on|off)
7184 Enables or disables autoerase mode for a flash bank.
7185
7186 If flash_autoerase is off, use mass_erase before flash programming.
7187 Flash erase command fails if region to erase is not whole flash memory.
7188
7189 If flash_autoerase is on, a sector is both erased and programmed in one
7190 system ROM call. Flash erase command is ignored.
7191 This mode is suitable for gdb load.
7192
7193 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7194 @end deffn
7195
7196 @deffn {Command} {psoc4 mass_erase} num
7197 Erases the contents of the flash memory, protection and security lock.
7198
7199 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7200 @end deffn
7201 @end deffn
7202
7203 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc5lp}
7204 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
7205 include internal program flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
7206 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
7207 apart from the base address.
7208
7209 @example
7210 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc5lp 0x00000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7211 @end example
7212
7213 @b{Note:} PSoC 5LP chips can be configured to have ECC enabled or disabled.
7214 @quotation Attention
7215 If flash operations are performed in ECC-disabled mode, they will also affect
7216 the ECC flash region. Erasing a 16k flash sector in the 0x00000000 area will
7217 then also erase the corresponding 2k data bytes in the 0x48000000 area.
7218 Writing to the ECC data bytes in ECC-disabled mode is not implemented.
7219 @end quotation
7220
7221 Commands defined in the @var{psoc5lp} driver:
7222
7223 @deffn {Command} {psoc5lp mass_erase}
7224 Erases all flash data and ECC/configuration bytes, all flash protection rows,
7225 and all row latches in all flash arrays on the device.
7226 @end deffn
7227 @end deffn
7228
7229 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc5lp_eeprom}
7230 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
7231 include internal EEPROM and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
7232 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
7233 apart from the base address.
7234
7235 @example
7236 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.eeprom psoc5lp_eeprom 0x40008000 0 0 0 \
7237 $_TARGETNAME
7238 @end example
7239 @end deffn
7240
7241 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc5lp_nvl}
7242 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
7243 include internal Nonvolatile Latches and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
7244 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself.
7245
7246 @example
7247 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.nvl psoc5lp_nvl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7248 @end example
7249
7250 PSoC 5LP chips have multiple NV Latches:
7251
7252 @itemize
7253 @item Device Configuration NV Latch - 4 bytes
7254 @item Write Once (WO) NV Latch - 4 bytes
7255 @end itemize
7256
7257 @b{Note:} This driver only implements the Device Configuration NVL.
7258
7259 The @var{psoc5lp} driver reads the ECC mode from Device Configuration NVL.
7260 @quotation Attention
7261 Switching ECC mode via write to Device Configuration NVL will require a reset
7262 after successful write.
7263 @end quotation
7264 @end deffn
7265
7266 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc6}
7267 Supports PSoC6 (CY8C6xxx) family of Cypress microcontrollers.
7268 PSoC6 is a dual-core device with CM0+ and CM4 cores. Both cores share
7269 the same Flash/RAM/MMIO address space.
7270
7271 Flash in PSoC6 is split into three regions:
7272 @itemize @bullet
7273 @item Main Flash - this is the main storage for user application.
7274 Total size varies among devices, sector size: 256 kBytes, row size:
7275 512 bytes. Supports erase operation on individual rows.
7276 @item Work Flash - intended to be used as storage for user data
7277 (e.g. EEPROM emulation). Total size: 32 KBytes, sector size: 32 KBytes,
7278 row size: 512 bytes.
7279 @item Supervisory Flash - special region which contains device-specific
7280 service data. This region does not support erase operation. Only few rows can
7281 be programmed by the user, most of the rows are read only. Programming
7282 operation will erase row automatically.
7283 @end itemize
7284
7285 All three flash regions are supported by the driver. Flash geometry is detected
7286 automatically by parsing data in SPCIF_GEOMETRY register.
7287
7288 PSoC6 is equipped with NOR Flash so erased Flash reads as 0x00.
7289
7290 @example
7291 flash bank main_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 \
7292 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7293 flash bank work_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 \
7294 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7295 flash bank super_flash_user_cm0 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 \
7296 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7297 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm0 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 \
7298 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7299 flash bank super_flash_key_cm0 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 \
7300 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7301 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm0 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 \
7302 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7303
7304 flash bank main_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 \
7305 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7306 flash bank work_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 \
7307 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7308 flash bank super_flash_user_cm4 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 \
7309 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7310 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm4 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 \
7311 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7312 flash bank super_flash_key_cm4 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 \
7313 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7314 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm4 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 \
7315 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7316 @end example
7317
7318 psoc6-specific commands
7319 @deffn {Command} {psoc6 reset_halt}
7320 Command can be used to simulate broken Vector Catch from gdbinit or tcl scripts.
7321 When invoked for CM0+ target, it will set break point at application entry point
7322 and issue SYSRESETREQ. This will reset both cores and all peripherals. CM0+ will
7323 reset CM4 during boot anyway so this is safe. On CM4 target, VECTRESET is used
7324 instead of SYSRESETREQ to avoid unwanted reset of CM0+;
7325 @end deffn
7326
7327 @deffn {Command} {psoc6 mass_erase} num
7328 Erases the contents given flash bank. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown
7329 by @command{flash banks}.
7330 Note: only Main and Work flash regions support Erase operation.
7331 @end deffn
7332 @end deffn
7333
7334 @deffn {Flash Driver} {rp2040}
7335 Supports RP2040 "Raspberry Pi Pico" microcontroller.
7336 RP2040 is a dual-core device with two CM0+ cores. Both cores share the same
7337 Flash/RAM/MMIO address space. Non-volatile storage is achieved with an
7338 external QSPI flash; a Boot ROM provides helper functions.
7339
7340 @example
7341 flash bank $_FLASHNAME rp2040_flash $_FLASHBASE $_FLASHSIZE 1 32 $_TARGETNAME
7342 @end example
7343 @end deffn
7344
7345 @deffn {Flash Driver} {rsl10}
7346 Supports Onsemi RSL10 microcontroller flash memory. Uses functions
7347 stored in ROM to control flash memory interface.
7348
7349 @example
7350 flash bank $_FLASHNAME rsl10 $_FLASHBASE $_FLASHSIZE 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7351 @end example
7352
7353 @deffn {Command} {rsl10 lock} key1 key2 key3 key4
7354 Writes @var{key1 key2 key3 key4} words to @var{0x81044 0x81048 0x8104c
7355 0x8050}. Locks debug port by writing @var{0x4C6F634B} to @var{0x81040}.
7356
7357 To unlock use the @command{rsl10 unlock key1 key2 key3 key4} command.
7358 @end deffn
7359
7360 @deffn {Command} {rsl10 unlock} key1 key2 key3 key4
7361 Unlocks debug port, by writing @var{key1 key2 key3 key4} words to
7362 registers through DAP, and clears @var{0x81040} address in flash to 0x1.
7363 @end deffn
7364
7365 @deffn {Command} {rsl10 mass_erase}
7366 Erases all unprotected flash sectors.
7367 @end deffn
7368 @end deffn
7369
7370 @deffn {Flash Driver} {sim3x}
7371 All members of the SiM3 microcontroller family from Silicon Laboratories
7372 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. It supports both JTAG
7373 and SWD interface.
7374 The @var{sim3x} driver tries to probe the device to auto detect the MCU.
7375 If this fails, it will use the @var{size} parameter as the size of flash bank.
7376
7377 @example
7378 flash bank $_FLASHNAME sim3x 0 $_CPUROMSIZE 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7379 @end example
7380
7381 There are 2 commands defined in the @var{sim3x} driver:
7382
7383 @deffn {Command} {sim3x mass_erase}
7384 Erases the complete flash. This is used to unlock the flash.
7385 And this command is only possible when using the SWD interface.
7386 @end deffn
7387
7388 @deffn {Command} {sim3x lock}
7389 Lock the flash. To unlock use the @command{sim3x mass_erase} command.
7390 @end deffn
7391 @end deffn
7392
7393 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stellaris}
7394 All members of the Stellaris LM3Sxxx, LM4x and Tiva C microcontroller
7395 families from Texas Instruments include internal flash. The driver
7396 automatically recognizes a number of these chips using the chip
7397 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7398
7399 @example
7400 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stellaris 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7401 @end example
7402
7403 @deffn {Command} {stellaris recover}
7404 Performs the @emph{Recovering a "Locked" Device} procedure to restore
7405 the flash and its associated nonvolatile registers to their factory
7406 default values (erased). This is the only way to remove flash
7407 protection or re-enable debugging if that capability has been
7408 disabled.
7409
7410 Note that the final "power cycle the chip" step in this procedure
7411 must be performed by hand, since OpenOCD can't do it.
7412 @quotation Warning
7413 if more than one Stellaris chip is connected, the procedure is
7414 applied to all of them.
7415 @end quotation
7416 @end deffn
7417 @end deffn
7418
7419 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32f1x}
7420 All members of the STM32F0, STM32F1 and STM32F3 microcontroller families
7421 from STMicroelectronics and all members of the GD32F1x0, GD32F3x0 and GD32E23x microcontroller
7422 families from GigaDevice include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0/M3/M4/M23 cores.
7423 The driver also works with GD32VF103 powered by RISC-V core.
7424 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7425 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7426
7427 @example
7428 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7429 @end example
7430
7431 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7432 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7433 the flash driver.
7434
7435 @example
7436 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7437 @end example
7438
7439 If you have a target with dual flash banks then define the second bank
7440 as per the following example.
7441 @example
7442 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0x08080000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7443 @end example
7444
7445 Some stm32f1x-specific commands are defined:
7446
7447 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x lock} num
7448 Locks the entire stm32 device against reading.
7449 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7450 @end deffn
7451
7452 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x unlock} num
7453 Unlocks the entire stm32 device for reading. This command will cause
7454 a mass erase of the entire stm32 device if previously locked.
7455 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7456 @end deffn
7457
7458 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x mass_erase} num
7459 Mass erases the entire stm32 device.
7460 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7461 @end deffn
7462
7463 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x options_read} num
7464 Reads and displays active stm32 option bytes loaded during POR
7465 or upon executing the @command{stm32f1x options_load} command.
7466 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7467 @end deffn
7468
7469 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x options_write} num (@option{SWWDG}|@option{HWWDG}) (@option{RSTSTNDBY}|@option{NORSTSTNDBY}) (@option{RSTSTOP}|@option{NORSTSTOP}) (@option{USEROPT} user_data)
7470 Writes the stm32 option byte with the specified values.
7471 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7472 The @var{user_data} parameter is content of higher 16 bits of the option byte register (Data0 and Data1 as one 16bit number).
7473 @end deffn
7474
7475 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x options_load} num
7476 Generates a special kind of reset to re-load the stm32 option bytes written
7477 by the @command{stm32f1x options_write} or @command{flash protect} commands
7478 without having to power cycle the target. Not applicable to stm32f1x devices.
7479 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7480 @end deffn
7481 @end deffn
7482
7483 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32f2x}
7484 All members of the STM32F2, STM32F4 and STM32F7 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
7485 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3/M4/M7 cores.
7486 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7487 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7488
7489 @example
7490 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7491 @end example
7492
7493 If you use OTP (One-Time Programmable) memory define it as a second bank
7494 as per the following example.
7495 @example
7496 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0x1FFF7800 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7497 @end example
7498
7499 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x otp} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{show})
7500 Enables or disables OTP write commands for bank @var{num}.
7501 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7502 @end deffn
7503
7504 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7505 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7506 the flash driver.
7507
7508 @example
7509 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7510 @end example
7511
7512 Some stm32f2x-specific commands are defined:
7513
7514 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x lock} num
7515 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7516 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7517 @end deffn
7518
7519 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x unlock} num
7520 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7521 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7522 @end deffn
7523
7524 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x mass_erase} num
7525 Mass erases the entire stm32f2x device.
7526 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7527 @end deffn
7528
7529 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x options_read} num
7530 Reads and displays user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0, boot_addr1, optcr2.
7531 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7532 @end deffn
7533
7534 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x options_write} num user_options boot_addr0 boot_addr1
7535 Writes user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0 and boot_addr1 in raw format.
7536 Warning: The meaning of the various bits depends on the device, always check datasheet!
7537 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{user_options} a
7538 12 bit value, consisting of bits 31-28 and 7-0 of FLASH_OPTCR, @var{boot_addr0} and
7539 @var{boot_addr1} two halfwords (of FLASH_OPTCR1).
7540 @end deffn
7541
7542 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x optcr2_write} num optcr2
7543 Writes FLASH_OPTCR2 options. Warning: Clearing PCROPi bits requires a full mass erase!
7544 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{optcr2} a 32-bit word.
7545 @end deffn
7546 @end deffn
7547
7548 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32h7x}
7549 All members of the STM32H7 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
7550 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M7 core.
7551 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7552 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7553
7554 @example
7555 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7556 @end example
7557
7558 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7559 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7560 the flash driver.
7561
7562 @example
7563 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7564 @end example
7565
7566 Some stm32h7x-specific commands are defined:
7567
7568 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x lock} num
7569 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7570 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7571 @end deffn
7572
7573 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x unlock} num
7574 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7575 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7576 @end deffn
7577
7578 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x mass_erase} num
7579 Mass erases the entire stm32h7x device.
7580 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7581 @end deffn
7582
7583 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x option_read} num reg_offset
7584 Reads an option byte register from the stm32h7x device.
7585 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7586 is the register offset of the option byte to read from the used bank registers' base.
7587 For example: in STM32H74x/H75x the bank 1 registers' base is 0x52002000 and 0x52002100 for bank 2.
7588
7589 Example usage:
7590 @example
7591 # read OPTSR_CUR
7592 stm32h7x option_read 0 0x1c
7593 # read WPSN_CUR1R
7594 stm32h7x option_read 0 0x38
7595 # read WPSN_CUR2R
7596 stm32h7x option_read 1 0x38
7597 @end example
7598 @end deffn
7599
7600 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x option_write} num reg_offset value [reg_mask]
7601 Writes an option byte register of the stm32h7x device.
7602 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7603 is the register offset of the option byte to write from the used bank register base,
7604 and @var{reg_mask} is the mask to apply when writing the register (only bits with a '1'
7605 will be touched).
7606
7607 Example usage:
7608 @example
7609 # swap bank 1 and bank 2 in dual bank devices
7610 # by setting SWAP_BANK_OPT bit in OPTSR_PRG
7611 stm32h7x option_write 0 0x20 0x8000000 0x8000000
7612 @end example
7613 @end deffn
7614 @end deffn
7615
7616 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32lx}
7617 All members of the STM32L0 and STM32L1 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
7618 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 and Cortex-M0+ cores.
7619 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7620 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7621
7622 @example
7623 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7624 @end example
7625
7626 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7627 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7628 the flash driver. If you use 0 as the bank base address, it tells the
7629 driver to autodetect the bank location assuming you're configuring the
7630 second bank.
7631
7632 @example
7633 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0x08000000 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7634 @end example
7635
7636 Some stm32lx-specific commands are defined:
7637
7638 @deffn {Command} {stm32lx lock} num
7639 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7640 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7641 @end deffn
7642
7643 @deffn {Command} {stm32lx unlock} num
7644 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7645 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7646 @end deffn
7647
7648 @deffn {Command} {stm32lx mass_erase} num
7649 Mass erases the entire stm32lx device (all flash banks and EEPROM
7650 data). This is the only way to unlock a protected flash (unless RDP
7651 Level is 2 which can't be unlocked at all).
7652 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7653 @end deffn
7654 @end deffn
7655
7656 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32l4x}
7657 All members of the STM32 G0, G4, L4, L4+, L5, U5, WB and WL
7658 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics include internal flash
7659 and use ARM Cortex-M0+, M4 and M33 cores.
7660 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7661 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7662
7663 @example
7664 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7665 @end example
7666
7667 If you use OTP (One-Time Programmable) memory define it as a second bank
7668 as per the following example.
7669 @example
7670 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0x1FFF7000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7671 @end example
7672
7673 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x otp} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{show})
7674 Enables or disables OTP write commands for bank @var{num}.
7675 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7676 @end deffn
7677
7678 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7679 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7680 the flash driver. However, specifying a wrong value might lead to a completely
7681 wrong flash layout, so this feature must be used carefully.
7682
7683 @example
7684 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0x08000000 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7685 @end example
7686
7687 Some stm32l4x-specific commands are defined:
7688
7689 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x lock} num
7690 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7691 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7692
7693 @emph{Note:} To apply the protection change immediately, use @command{stm32l4x option_load}.
7694 @end deffn
7695
7696 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x unlock} num
7697 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7698 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7699
7700 @emph{Note:} To apply the protection change immediately, use @command{stm32l4x option_load}.
7701 @end deffn
7702
7703 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x mass_erase} num
7704 Mass erases the entire stm32l4x device.
7705 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7706 @end deffn
7707
7708 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x option_read} num reg_offset
7709 Reads an option byte register from the stm32l4x device.
7710 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7711 is the register offset of the Option byte to read.
7712
7713 For example to read the FLASH_OPTR register:
7714 @example
7715 stm32l4x option_read 0 0x20
7716 # Option Register (for STM32L4x): <0x40022020> = 0xffeff8aa
7717 # Option Register (for STM32WBx): <0x58004020> = ...
7718 # The correct flash base address will be used automatically
7719 @end example
7720
7721 The above example will read out the FLASH_OPTR register which contains the RDP
7722 option byte, Watchdog configuration, BOR level etc.
7723 @end deffn
7724
7725 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x option_write} num reg_offset reg_mask
7726 Write an option byte register of the stm32l4x device.
7727 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7728 is the register offset of the Option byte to write, and @var{reg_mask} is the mask
7729 to apply when writing the register (only bits with a '1' will be touched).
7730
7731 @emph{Note:} To apply the option bytes change immediately, use @command{stm32l4x option_load}.
7732
7733 For example to write the WRP1AR option bytes:
7734 @example
7735 stm32l4x option_write 0 0x28 0x00FF0000 0x00FF00FF
7736 @end example
7737
7738 The above example will write the WRP1AR option register configuring the Write protection
7739 Area A for bank 1. The above example set WRP1AR_END=255, WRP1AR_START=0.
7740 This will effectively write protect all sectors in flash bank 1.
7741 @end deffn
7742
7743 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x wrp_info} num [device_bank]
7744 List the protected areas using WRP.
7745 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7746 @var{device_bank} parameter is optional, possible values 'bank1' or 'bank2',
7747 if not specified, the command will display the whole flash protected areas.
7748
7749 @b{Note:} @var{device_bank} is different from banks created using @code{flash bank}.
7750 Devices supported in this flash driver, can have main flash memory organized
7751 in single or dual-banks mode.
7752 Thus the usage of @var{device_bank} is meaningful only in dual-bank mode, to get
7753 write protected areas in a specific @var{device_bank}
7754
7755 @end deffn
7756
7757 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x option_load} num
7758 Forces a re-load of the option byte registers. Will cause a system reset of the device.
7759 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7760 @end deffn
7761
7762 @deffn Command {stm32l4x trustzone} num [@option{enable} | @option{disable}]
7763 Enables or disables Global TrustZone Security, using the TZEN option bit.
7764 If neither @option{enabled} nor @option{disable} are specified, the command will display
7765 the TrustZone status.
7766 @emph{Note:} This command works only with devices with TrustZone, eg. STM32L5.
7767 @emph{Note:} This command will perform an OBL_Launch after modifying the TZEN.
7768 @end deffn
7769 @end deffn
7770
7771 @deffn {Flash Driver} {str7x}
7772 All members of the STR7 microcontroller family from STMicroelectronics
7773 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
7774 The @var{str7x} driver defines one mandatory parameter, @var{variant},
7775 which is either @code{STR71x}, @code{STR73x} or @code{STR75x}.
7776
7777 @example
7778 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str7x \
7779 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME STR71x
7780 @end example
7781
7782 @deffn {Command} {str7x disable_jtag} bank
7783 Activate the Debug/Readout protection mechanism
7784 for the specified flash bank.
7785 @end deffn
7786 @end deffn
7787
7788 @deffn {Flash Driver} {str9x}
7789 Most members of the STR9 microcontroller family from STMicroelectronics
7790 include internal flash and use ARM966E cores.
7791 The str9 needs the flash controller to be configured using
7792 the @command{str9x flash_config} command prior to Flash programming.
7793
7794 @example
7795 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str9x 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7796 str9x flash_config 0 4 2 0 0x80000
7797 @end example
7798
7799 @deffn {Command} {str9x flash_config} num bbsr nbbsr bbadr nbbadr
7800 Configures the str9 flash controller.
7801 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7802
7803 @itemize @bullet
7804 @item @var{bbsr} - Boot Bank Size register
7805 @item @var{nbbsr} - Non Boot Bank Size register
7806 @item @var{bbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
7807 @item @var{nbbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
7808 @end itemize
7809 @end deffn
7810
7811 @end deffn
7812
7813 @deffn {Flash Driver} {str9xpec}
7814 @cindex str9xpec
7815
7816 Only use this driver for locking/unlocking the device or configuring the option bytes.
7817 Use the standard str9 driver for programming.
7818 Before using the flash commands the turbo mode must be enabled using the
7819 @command{str9xpec enable_turbo} command.
7820
7821 Here is some background info to help
7822 you better understand how this driver works. OpenOCD has two flash drivers for
7823 the str9:
7824 @enumerate
7825 @item
7826 Standard driver @option{str9x} programmed via the str9 core. Normally used for
7827 flash programming as it is faster than the @option{str9xpec} driver.
7828 @item
7829 Direct programming @option{str9xpec} using the flash controller. This is an
7830 ISC compliant (IEEE 1532) tap connected in series with the str9 core. The str9
7831 core does not need to be running to program using this flash driver. Typical use
7832 for this driver is locking/unlocking the target and programming the option bytes.
7833 @end enumerate
7834
7835 Before we run any commands using the @option{str9xpec} driver we must first disable
7836 the str9 core. This example assumes the @option{str9xpec} driver has been
7837 configured for flash bank 0.
7838 @example
7839 # assert srst, we do not want core running
7840 # while accessing str9xpec flash driver
7841 adapter assert srst
7842 # turn off target polling
7843 poll off
7844 # disable str9 core
7845 str9xpec enable_turbo 0
7846 # read option bytes
7847 str9xpec options_read 0
7848 # re-enable str9 core
7849 str9xpec disable_turbo 0
7850 poll on
7851 reset halt
7852 @end example
7853 The above example will read the str9 option bytes.
7854 When performing a unlock remember that you will not be able to halt the str9 - it
7855 has been locked. Halting the core is not required for the @option{str9xpec} driver
7856 as mentioned above, just issue the commands above manually or from a telnet prompt.
7857
7858 Several str9xpec-specific commands are defined:
7859
7860 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec disable_turbo} num
7861 Restore the str9 into JTAG chain.
7862 @end deffn
7863
7864 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec enable_turbo} num
7865 Enable turbo mode, will simply remove the str9 from the chain and talk
7866 directly to the embedded flash controller.
7867 @end deffn
7868
7869 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec lock} num
7870 Lock str9 device. The str9 will only respond to an unlock command that will
7871 erase the device.
7872 @end deffn
7873
7874 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec part_id} num
7875 Prints the part identifier for bank @var{num}.
7876 @end deffn
7877
7878 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_cmap} num (@option{bank0}|@option{bank1})
7879 Configure str9 boot bank.
7880 @end deffn
7881
7882 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_lvdsel} num (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
7883 Configure str9 lvd source.
7884 @end deffn
7885
7886 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_lvdthd} num (@option{2.4v}|@option{2.7v})
7887 Configure str9 lvd threshold.
7888 @end deffn
7889
7890 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_lvdwarn} bank (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
7891 Configure str9 lvd reset warning source.
7892 @end deffn
7893
7894 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_read} num
7895 Read str9 option bytes.
7896 @end deffn
7897
7898 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_write} num
7899 Write str9 option bytes.
7900 @end deffn
7901
7902 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec unlock} num
7903 unlock str9 device.
7904 @end deffn
7905
7906 @end deffn
7907
7908 @deffn {Flash Driver} {swm050}
7909 @cindex swm050
7910 All members of the swm050 microcontroller family from Foshan Synwit Tech.
7911
7912 @example
7913 flash bank $_FLASHNAME swm050 0x0 0x2000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7914 @end example
7915
7916 One swm050-specific command is defined:
7917
7918 @deffn {Command} {swm050 mass_erase} bank_id
7919 Erases the entire flash bank.
7920 @end deffn
7921
7922 @end deffn
7923
7924
7925 @deffn {Flash Driver} {tms470}
7926 Most members of the TMS470 microcontroller family from Texas Instruments
7927 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
7928 This driver doesn't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7929
7930 Some tms470-specific commands are defined:
7931
7932 @deffn {Command} {tms470 flash_keyset} key0 key1 key2 key3
7933 Saves programming keys in a register, to enable flash erase and write commands.
7934 @end deffn
7935
7936 @deffn {Command} {tms470 osc_megahertz} clock_mhz
7937 Reports the clock speed, which is used to calculate timings.
7938 @end deffn
7939
7940 @deffn {Command} {tms470 plldis} (0|1)
7941 Disables (@var{1}) or enables (@var{0}) use of the PLL to speed up
7942 the flash clock.
7943 @end deffn
7944 @end deffn
7945
7946 @deffn {Flash Driver} {w600}
7947 W60x series Wi-Fi SoC from WinnerMicro
7948 are designed with ARM Cortex-M3 and have 1M Byte QFLASH inside.
7949 The @var{w600} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
7950 correct bank config.
7951
7952 @example
7953 flash bank $_FLASHNAME w600 0x08000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAMEs
7954 @end example
7955 @end deffn
7956
7957 @deffn {Flash Driver} {xmc1xxx}
7958 All members of the XMC1xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
7959 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7960 @end deffn
7961
7962 @deffn {Flash Driver} {xmc4xxx}
7963 All members of the XMC4xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
7964 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7965
7966 Some xmc4xxx-specific commands are defined:
7967
7968 @deffn {Command} {xmc4xxx flash_password} bank_id passwd1 passwd2
7969 Saves flash protection passwords which are used to lock the user flash
7970 @end deffn
7971
7972 @deffn {Command} {xmc4xxx flash_unprotect} bank_id user_level[0-1]
7973 Removes Flash write protection from the selected user bank
7974 @end deffn
7975
7976 @end deffn
7977
7978 @section NAND Flash Commands
7979 @cindex NAND
7980
7981 Compared to NOR or SPI flash, NAND devices are inexpensive
7982 and high density. Today's NAND chips, and multi-chip modules,
7983 commonly hold multiple GigaBytes of data.
7984
7985 NAND chips consist of a number of ``erase blocks'' of a given
7986 size (such as 128 KBytes), each of which is divided into a
7987 number of pages (of perhaps 512 or 2048 bytes each). Each
7988 page of a NAND flash has an ``out of band'' (OOB) area to hold
7989 Error Correcting Code (ECC) and other metadata, usually 16 bytes
7990 of OOB for every 512 bytes of page data.
7991
7992 One key characteristic of NAND flash is that its error rate
7993 is higher than that of NOR flash. In normal operation, that
7994 ECC is used to correct and detect errors. However, NAND
7995 blocks can also wear out and become unusable; those blocks
7996 are then marked "bad". NAND chips are even shipped from the
7997 manufacturer with a few bad blocks. The highest density chips
7998 use a technology (MLC) that wears out more quickly, so ECC
7999 support is increasingly important as a way to detect blocks
8000 that have begun to fail, and help to preserve data integrity
8001 with techniques such as wear leveling.
8002
8003 Software is used to manage the ECC. Some controllers don't
8004 support ECC directly; in those cases, software ECC is used.
8005 Other controllers speed up the ECC calculations with hardware.
8006 Single-bit error correction hardware is routine. Controllers
8007 geared for newer MLC chips may correct 4 or more errors for
8008 every 512 bytes of data.
8009
8010 You will need to make sure that any data you write using
8011 OpenOCD includes the appropriate kind of ECC. For example,
8012 that may mean passing the @code{oob_softecc} flag when
8013 writing NAND data, or ensuring that the correct hardware
8014 ECC mode is used.
8015
8016 The basic steps for using NAND devices include:
8017 @enumerate
8018 @item Declare via the command @command{nand device}
8019 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
8020 passing parameters as needed by the controller.
8021 @item Configure each device using @command{nand probe}.
8022 @* Do this only after the associated target is set up,
8023 such as in its reset-init script or in procures defined
8024 to access that device.
8025 @item Operate on the flash via @command{nand subcommand}
8026 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
8027 via a script in some automated way. Common task include writing a
8028 boot loader, operating system, or other data needed to initialize or
8029 de-brick a board.
8030 @end enumerate
8031
8032 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, the largest NAND
8033 flash fully supported by OpenOCD is 2 GiBytes (16 GiBits).
8034 This is because the variables used to hold offsets and lengths
8035 are only 32 bits wide.
8036 (Larger chips may work in some cases, unless an offset or length
8037 is larger than 0xffffffff, the largest 32-bit unsigned integer.)
8038 Some larger devices will work, since they are actually multi-chip
8039 modules with two smaller chips and individual chipselect lines.
8040
8041 @anchor{nandconfiguration}
8042 @subsection NAND Configuration Commands
8043 @cindex NAND configuration
8044
8045 NAND chips must be declared in configuration scripts,
8046 plus some additional configuration that's done after
8047 OpenOCD has initialized.
8048
8049 @deffn {Config Command} {nand device} name driver target [configparams...]
8050 Declares a NAND device, which can be read and written to
8051 after it has been configured through @command{nand probe}.
8052 In OpenOCD, devices are single chips; this is unlike some
8053 operating systems, which may manage multiple chips as if
8054 they were a single (larger) device.
8055 In some cases, configuring a device will activate extra
8056 commands; see the controller-specific documentation.
8057
8058 @b{NOTE:} This command is not available after OpenOCD
8059 initialization has completed. Use it in board specific
8060 configuration files, not interactively.
8061
8062 @itemize @bullet
8063 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the NAND bank
8064 in most other NAND commands. A number is also available.
8065 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the NAND controller driver
8066 associated with the NAND device being declared.
8067 @xref{nanddriverlist,,NAND Driver List}.
8068 @item @var{target} ... names the target used when issuing
8069 commands to the NAND controller.
8070 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
8071 @item @var{configparams} ... controllers may support, or require,
8072 additional parameters. See the controller-specific documentation
8073 for more information.
8074 @end itemize
8075 @end deffn
8076
8077 @deffn {Command} {nand list}
8078 Prints a summary of each device declared
8079 using @command{nand device}, numbered from zero.
8080 Note that un-probed devices show no details.
8081 @example
8082 > nand list
8083 #0: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
8084 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
8085 #1: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
8086 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
8087 >
8088 @end example
8089 @end deffn
8090
8091 @deffn {Command} {nand probe} num
8092 Probes the specified device to determine key characteristics
8093 like its page and block sizes, and how many blocks it has.
8094 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8095 You must (successfully) probe a device before you can use
8096 it with most other NAND commands.
8097 @end deffn
8098
8099 @subsection Erasing, Reading, Writing to NAND Flash
8100
8101 @deffn {Command} {nand dump} num filename offset length [oob_option]
8102 @cindex NAND reading
8103 Reads binary data from the NAND device and writes it to the file,
8104 starting at the specified offset.
8105 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8106
8107 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
8108 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
8109
8110 The @var{offset} and @var{length} must be exact multiples of the
8111 device's page size. They describe a data region; the OOB data
8112 associated with each such page may also be accessed.
8113
8114 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, no error correction
8115 was done on the data that's read, unless raw access was disabled
8116 and the underlying NAND controller driver had a @code{read_page}
8117 method which handled that error correction.
8118
8119 By default, only page data is saved to the specified file.
8120 Use an @var{oob_option} parameter to save OOB data:
8121 @itemize @bullet
8122 @item no oob_* parameter
8123 @*Output file holds only page data; OOB is discarded.
8124 @item @code{oob_raw}
8125 @*Output file interleaves page data and OOB data;
8126 the file will be longer than "length" by the size of the
8127 spare areas associated with each data page.
8128 Note that this kind of "raw" access is different from
8129 what's implied by @command{nand raw_access}, which just
8130 controls whether a hardware-aware access method is used.
8131 @item @code{oob_only}
8132 @*Output file has only raw OOB data, and will
8133 be smaller than "length" since it will contain only the
8134 spare areas associated with each data page.
8135 @end itemize
8136 @end deffn
8137
8138 @deffn {Command} {nand erase} num [offset length]
8139 @cindex NAND erasing
8140 @cindex NAND programming
8141 Erases blocks on the specified NAND device, starting at the
8142 specified @var{offset} and continuing for @var{length} bytes.
8143 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
8144 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
8145 If those parameters are not specified,
8146 the whole NAND chip will be erased.
8147 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8148
8149 @b{NOTE:} This command will try to erase bad blocks, when told
8150 to do so, which will probably invalidate the manufacturer's bad
8151 block marker.
8152 For the remainder of the current server session, @command{nand info}
8153 will still report that the block ``is'' bad.
8154 @end deffn
8155
8156 @deffn {Command} {nand write} num filename offset [option...]
8157 @cindex NAND writing
8158 @cindex NAND programming
8159 Writes binary data from the file into the specified NAND device,
8160 starting at the specified offset. Those pages should already
8161 have been erased; you can't change zero bits to one bits.
8162 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8163
8164 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
8165 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
8166
8167 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
8168 All data in the file will be written, assuming it doesn't run
8169 past the end of the device.
8170 Only full pages are written, and any extra space in the last
8171 page will be filled with 0xff bytes. (That includes OOB data,
8172 if that's being written.)
8173
8174 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, bad blocks are
8175 ignored. That is, this routine will not skip bad blocks,
8176 but will instead try to write them. This can cause problems.
8177
8178 Provide at most one @var{option} parameter. With some
8179 NAND drivers, the meanings of these parameters may change
8180 if @command{nand raw_access} was used to disable hardware ECC.
8181 @itemize @bullet
8182 @item no oob_* parameter
8183 @*File has only page data, which is written.
8184 If raw access is in use, the OOB area will not be written.
8185 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
8186 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may write the OOB
8187 with hardware-computed ECC data.
8188 @item @code{oob_only}
8189 @*File has only raw OOB data, which is written to the OOB area.
8190 Each page's data area stays untouched. @i{This can be a dangerous
8191 option}, since it can invalidate the ECC data.
8192 You may need to force raw access to use this mode.
8193 @item @code{oob_raw}
8194 @*File interleaves data and OOB data, both of which are written
8195 If raw access is enabled, the data is written first, then the
8196 un-altered OOB.
8197 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
8198 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may modify the OOB
8199 before it's written, to include hardware-computed ECC data.
8200 @item @code{oob_softecc}
8201 @*File has only page data, which is written.
8202 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a standard 1-bit
8203 software ECC code stored in conventional locations.
8204 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
8205 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
8206 @item @code{oob_softecc_kw}
8207 @*File has only page data, which is written.
8208 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a 4-bit software ECC
8209 specific to the boot ROM in Marvell Kirkwood SoCs.
8210 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
8211 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
8212 @end itemize
8213 @end deffn
8214
8215 @deffn {Command} {nand verify} num filename offset [option...]
8216 @cindex NAND verification
8217 @cindex NAND programming
8218 Verify the binary data in the file has been programmed to the
8219 specified NAND device, starting at the specified offset.
8220 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8221
8222 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
8223 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
8224
8225 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
8226 All data in the file will be read and compared to the contents of the
8227 flash, assuming it doesn't run past the end of the device.
8228 As with @command{nand write}, only full pages are verified, so any extra
8229 space in the last page will be filled with 0xff bytes.
8230
8231 The same @var{options} accepted by @command{nand write},
8232 and the file will be processed similarly to produce the buffers that
8233 can be compared against the contents produced from @command{nand dump}.
8234
8235 @b{NOTE:} This will not work when the underlying NAND controller
8236 driver's @code{write_page} routine must update the OOB with a
8237 hardware-computed ECC before the data is written. This limitation may
8238 be removed in a future release.
8239 @end deffn
8240
8241 @subsection Other NAND commands
8242 @cindex NAND other commands
8243
8244 @deffn {Command} {nand check_bad_blocks} num [offset length]
8245 Checks for manufacturer bad block markers on the specified NAND
8246 device. If no parameters are provided, checks the whole
8247 device; otherwise, starts at the specified @var{offset} and
8248 continues for @var{length} bytes.
8249 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
8250 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
8251 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8252
8253 @b{NOTE:} Before using this command you should force raw access
8254 with @command{nand raw_access enable} to ensure that the underlying
8255 driver will not try to apply hardware ECC.
8256 @end deffn
8257
8258 @deffn {Command} {nand info} num
8259 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8260 This prints the one-line summary from "nand list", plus for
8261 devices which have been probed this also prints any known
8262 status for each block.
8263 @end deffn
8264
8265 @deffn {Command} {nand raw_access} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
8266 Sets or clears an flag affecting how page I/O is done.
8267 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8268
8269 This flag is cleared (disabled) by default, but changing that
8270 value won't affect all NAND devices. The key factor is whether
8271 the underlying driver provides @code{read_page} or @code{write_page}
8272 methods. If it doesn't provide those methods, the setting of
8273 this flag is irrelevant; all access is effectively ``raw''.
8274
8275 When those methods exist, they are normally used when reading
8276 data (@command{nand dump} or reading bad block markers) or
8277 writing it (@command{nand write}). However, enabling
8278 raw access (setting the flag) prevents use of those methods,
8279 bypassing hardware ECC logic.
8280 @i{This can be a dangerous option}, since writing blocks
8281 with the wrong ECC data can cause them to be marked as bad.
8282 @end deffn
8283
8284 @anchor{nanddriverlist}
8285 @subsection NAND Driver List
8286 As noted above, the @command{nand device} command allows
8287 driver-specific options and behaviors.
8288 Some controllers also activate controller-specific commands.
8289
8290 @deffn {NAND Driver} {at91sam9}
8291 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on AT91SAM9 family chips from
8292 Atmel. It takes two extra parameters: address of the NAND chip;
8293 address of the ECC controller.
8294 @example
8295 nand device $NANDFLASH at91sam9 $CHIPNAME 0x40000000 0xfffffe800
8296 @end example
8297 AT91SAM9 chips support single-bit ECC hardware. The @code{write_page} and
8298 @code{read_page} methods are used to utilize the ECC hardware unless they are
8299 disabled by using the @command{nand raw_access} command. There are four
8300 additional commands that are needed to fully configure the AT91SAM9 NAND
8301 controller. Two are optional; most boards use the same wiring for ALE/CLE:
8302 @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 cle} num addr_line
8303 Configure the address line used for latching commands. The @var{num}
8304 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8305 @end deffn
8306 @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 ale} num addr_line
8307 Configure the address line used for latching addresses. The @var{num}
8308 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8309 @end deffn
8310
8311 For the next two commands, it is assumed that the pins have already been
8312 properly configured for input or output.
8313 @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 rdy_busy} num pio_base_addr pin
8314 Configure the RDY/nBUSY input from the NAND device. The @var{num}
8315 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
8316 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
8317 @end deffn
8318 @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 ce} num pio_base_addr pin
8319 Configure the chip enable input to the NAND device. The @var{num}
8320 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
8321 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
8322 @end deffn
8323 @end deffn
8324
8325 @deffn {NAND Driver} {davinci}
8326 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on DaVinci family
8327 chips from Texas Instruments.
8328 It takes three extra parameters:
8329 address of the NAND chip;
8330 hardware ECC mode to use (@option{hwecc1},
8331 @option{hwecc4}, @option{hwecc4_infix});
8332 address of the AEMIF controller on this processor.
8333 @example
8334 nand device davinci dm355.arm 0x02000000 hwecc4 0x01e10000
8335 @end example
8336 All DaVinci processors support the single-bit ECC hardware,
8337 and newer ones also support the four-bit ECC hardware.
8338 The @code{write_page} and @code{read_page} methods are used
8339 to implement those ECC modes, unless they are disabled using
8340 the @command{nand raw_access} command.
8341 @end deffn
8342
8343 @deffn {NAND Driver} {lpc3180}
8344 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
8345 parameter: the clock rate used by the controller.
8346 @deffn {Command} {lpc3180 select} num [mlc|slc]
8347 Configures use of the MLC or SLC controller mode.
8348 MLC implies use of hardware ECC.
8349 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8350 @end deffn
8351
8352 At this writing, this driver includes @code{write_page}
8353 and @code{read_page} methods. Using @command{nand raw_access}
8354 to disable those methods will prevent use of hardware ECC
8355 in the MLC controller mode, but won't change SLC behavior.
8356 @end deffn
8357 @comment current lpc3180 code won't issue 5-byte address cycles
8358
8359 @deffn {NAND Driver} {mx3}
8360 This driver handles the NAND controller in i.MX31. The mxc driver
8361 should work for this chip as well.
8362 @end deffn
8363
8364 @deffn {NAND Driver} {mxc}
8365 This driver handles the NAND controller found in Freescale i.MX
8366 chips. It has support for v1 (i.MX27 and i.MX31) and v2 (i.MX35).
8367 The driver takes 3 extra arguments, chip (@option{mx27},
8368 @option{mx31}, @option{mx35}), ecc (@option{noecc}, @option{hwecc})
8369 and optionally if bad block information should be swapped between
8370 main area and spare area (@option{biswap}), defaults to off.
8371 @example
8372 nand device mx35.nand mxc imx35.cpu mx35 hwecc biswap
8373 @end example
8374 @deffn {Command} {mxc biswap} bank_num [enable|disable]
8375 Turns on/off bad block information swapping from main area,
8376 without parameter query status.
8377 @end deffn
8378 @end deffn
8379
8380 @deffn {NAND Driver} {orion}
8381 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
8382 parameter: the address of the controller.
8383 @example
8384 nand device orion 0xd8000000
8385 @end example
8386 These controllers don't define any specialized commands.
8387 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
8388 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
8389 change any behavior.
8390 @end deffn
8391
8392 @deffn {NAND Driver} {s3c2410}
8393 @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c2412}
8394 @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c2440}
8395 @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c2443}
8396 @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c6400}
8397 These S3C family controllers don't have any special
8398 @command{nand device} options, and don't define any
8399 specialized commands.
8400 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
8401 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
8402 change any behavior.
8403 @end deffn
8404
8405 @node Flash Programming
8406 @chapter Flash Programming
8407
8408 OpenOCD implements numerous ways to program the target flash, whether internal or external.
8409 Programming can be achieved by either using @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
8410 or using the commands given in @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
8411
8412 @*To simplify using the flash commands directly a jimtcl script is available that handles the programming and verify stage.
8413 OpenOCD will program/verify/reset the target and optionally shutdown.
8414
8415 The script is executed as follows and by default the following actions will be performed.
8416 @enumerate
8417 @item 'init' is executed.
8418 @item 'reset init' is called to reset and halt the target, any 'reset init' scripts are executed.
8419 @item @code{flash write_image} is called to erase and write any flash using the filename given.
8420 @item If the @option{preverify} parameter is given, the target is "verified" first and only flashed if this fails.
8421 @item @code{verify_image} is called if @option{verify} parameter is given.
8422 @item @code{reset run} is called if @option{reset} parameter is given.
8423 @item OpenOCD is shutdown if @option{exit} parameter is given.
8424 @end enumerate
8425
8426 An example of usage is given below. @xref{program}.
8427
8428 @example
8429 # program and verify using elf/hex/s19. verify and reset
8430 # are optional parameters
8431 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
8432 -c "program filename.elf verify reset exit"
8433
8434 # binary files need the flash address passing
8435 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
8436 -c "program filename.bin exit 0x08000000"
8437 @end example
8438
8439 @node PLD/FPGA Commands
8440 @chapter PLD/FPGA Commands
8441 @cindex PLD
8442 @cindex FPGA
8443
8444 Programmable Logic Devices (PLDs) and the more flexible
8445 Field Programmable Gate Arrays (FPGAs) are both types of programmable hardware.
8446 OpenOCD can support programming them.
8447 Although PLDs are generally restrictive (cells are less functional, and
8448 there are no special purpose cells for memory or computational tasks),
8449 they share the same OpenOCD infrastructure.
8450 Accordingly, both are called PLDs here.
8451
8452 @section PLD/FPGA Configuration and Commands
8453
8454 As it does for JTAG TAPs, debug targets, and flash chips (both NOR and NAND),
8455 OpenOCD maintains a list of PLDs available for use in various commands.
8456 Also, each such PLD requires a driver.
8457
8458 They are referenced by the number shown by the @command{pld devices} command,
8459 and new PLDs are defined by @command{pld device driver_name}.
8460
8461 @deffn {Config Command} {pld device} driver_name tap_name [driver_options]
8462 Defines a new PLD device, supported by driver @var{driver_name},
8463 using the TAP named @var{tap_name}.
8464 The driver may make use of any @var{driver_options} to configure its
8465 behavior.
8466 @end deffn
8467
8468 @deffn {Command} {pld devices}
8469 Lists the PLDs and their numbers.
8470 @end deffn
8471
8472 @deffn {Command} {pld load} num filename
8473 Loads the file @file{filename} into the PLD identified by @var{num}.
8474 The file format must be inferred by the driver.
8475 @end deffn
8476
8477 @section PLD/FPGA Drivers, Options, and Commands
8478
8479 Drivers may support PLD-specific options to the @command{pld device}
8480 definition command, and may also define commands usable only with
8481 that particular type of PLD.
8482
8483 @deffn {FPGA Driver} {virtex2} [no_jstart]
8484 Virtex-II is a family of FPGAs sold by Xilinx.
8485 It supports the IEEE 1532 standard for In-System Configuration (ISC).
8486
8487 If @var{no_jstart} is non-zero, the JSTART instruction is not used after
8488 loading the bitstream. While required for Series2, Series3, and Series6, it
8489 breaks bitstream loading on Series7.
8490
8491 @deffn {Command} {virtex2 read_stat} num
8492 Reads and displays the Virtex-II status register (STAT)
8493 for FPGA @var{num}.
8494 @end deffn
8495 @end deffn
8496
8497 @node General Commands
8498 @chapter General Commands
8499 @cindex commands
8500
8501 The commands documented in this chapter here are common commands that
8502 you, as a human, may want to type and see the output of. Configuration type
8503 commands are documented elsewhere.
8504
8505 Intent:
8506 @itemize @bullet
8507 @item @b{Source Of Commands}
8508 @* OpenOCD commands can occur in a configuration script (discussed
8509 elsewhere) or typed manually by a human or supplied programmatically,
8510 or via one of several TCP/IP Ports.
8511
8512 @item @b{From the human}
8513 @* A human should interact with the telnet interface (default port: 4444)
8514 or via GDB (default port 3333).
8515
8516 To issue commands from within a GDB session, use the @option{monitor}
8517 command, e.g. use @option{monitor poll} to issue the @option{poll}
8518 command. All output is relayed through the GDB session.
8519
8520 @item @b{Machine Interface}
8521 The Tcl interface's intent is to be a machine interface. The default Tcl
8522 port is 5555.
8523 @end itemize
8524
8525
8526 @section Server Commands
8527
8528 @deffn {Command} {exit}
8529 Exits the current telnet session.
8530 @end deffn
8531
8532 @deffn {Command} {help} [string]
8533 With no parameters, prints help text for all commands.
8534 Otherwise, prints each helptext containing @var{string}.
8535 Not every command provides helptext.
8536
8537 Configuration commands, and commands valid at any time, are
8538 explicitly noted in parenthesis.
8539 In most cases, no such restriction is listed; this indicates commands
8540 which are only available after the configuration stage has completed.
8541 @end deffn
8542
8543 @deffn {Command} {usage} [string]
8544 With no parameters, prints usage text for all commands. Otherwise,
8545 prints all usage text of which command, help text, and usage text
8546 containing @var{string}.
8547 Not every command provides helptext.
8548 @end deffn
8549
8550 @deffn {Command} {sleep} msec [@option{busy}]
8551 Wait for at least @var{msec} milliseconds before resuming.
8552 If @option{busy} is passed, busy-wait instead of sleeping.
8553 (This option is strongly discouraged.)
8554 Useful in connection with script files
8555 (@command{script} command and @command{target_name} configuration).
8556 @end deffn
8557
8558 @deffn {Command} {shutdown} [@option{error}]
8559 Close the OpenOCD server, disconnecting all clients (GDB, telnet,
8560 other). If option @option{error} is used, OpenOCD will return a
8561 non-zero exit code to the parent process.
8562
8563 If user types CTRL-C or kills OpenOCD, the command @command{shutdown}
8564 will be automatically executed to cause OpenOCD to exit.
8565
8566 It is possible to specify, in the TCL list @var{pre_shutdown_commands} , a
8567 set of commands to be automatically executed before @command{shutdown} , e.g.:
8568 @example
8569 lappend pre_shutdown_commands @{echo "Goodbye, my friend ..."@}
8570 lappend pre_shutdown_commands @{echo "see you soon !"@}
8571 @end example
8572 The commands in the list will be executed (in the same order they occupy
8573 in the list) before OpenOCD exits. If one of the commands in the list
8574 fails, then the remaining commands are not executed anymore while OpenOCD
8575 will proceed to quit.
8576 @end deffn
8577
8578 @anchor{debuglevel}
8579 @deffn {Command} {debug_level} [n]
8580 @cindex message level
8581 Display debug level.
8582 If @var{n} (from 0..4) is provided, then set it to that level.
8583 This affects the kind of messages sent to the server log.
8584 Level 0 is error messages only;
8585 level 1 adds warnings;
8586 level 2 adds informational messages;
8587 level 3 adds debugging messages;
8588 and level 4 adds verbose low-level debug messages.
8589 The default is level 2, but that can be overridden on
8590 the command line along with the location of that log
8591 file (which is normally the server's standard output).
8592 @xref{Running}.
8593 @end deffn
8594
8595 @deffn {Command} {echo} [-n] message
8596 Logs a message at "user" priority.
8597 Option "-n" suppresses trailing newline.
8598 @example
8599 echo "Downloading kernel -- please wait"
8600 @end example
8601 @end deffn
8602
8603 @deffn {Command} {log_output} [filename | "default"]
8604 Redirect logging to @var{filename} or set it back to default output;
8605 the default log output channel is stderr.
8606 @end deffn
8607
8608 @deffn {Command} {add_script_search_dir} [directory]
8609 Add @var{directory} to the file/script search path.
8610 @end deffn
8611
8612 @deffn {Config Command} {bindto} [@var{name}]
8613 Specify hostname or IPv4 address on which to listen for incoming
8614 TCP/IP connections. By default, OpenOCD will listen on the loopback
8615 interface only. If your network environment is safe, @code{bindto
8616 0.0.0.0} can be used to cover all available interfaces.
8617 @end deffn
8618
8619 @anchor{targetstatehandling}
8620 @section Target State handling
8621 @cindex reset
8622 @cindex halt
8623 @cindex target initialization
8624
8625 In this section ``target'' refers to a CPU configured as
8626 shown earlier (@pxref{CPU Configuration}).
8627 These commands, like many, implicitly refer to
8628 a current target which is used to perform the
8629 various operations. The current target may be changed
8630 by using @command{targets} command with the name of the
8631 target which should become current.
8632
8633 @deffn {Command} {reg} [(number|name) [(value|'force')]]
8634 Access a single register by @var{number} or by its @var{name}.
8635 The target must generally be halted before access to CPU core
8636 registers is allowed. Depending on the hardware, some other
8637 registers may be accessible while the target is running.
8638
8639 @emph{With no arguments}:
8640 list all available registers for the current target,
8641 showing number, name, size, value, and cache status.
8642 For valid entries, a value is shown; valid entries
8643 which are also dirty (and will be written back later)
8644 are flagged as such.
8645
8646 @emph{With number/name}: display that register's value.
8647 Use @var{force} argument to read directly from the target,
8648 bypassing any internal cache.
8649
8650 @emph{With both number/name and value}: set register's value.
8651 Writes may be held in a writeback cache internal to OpenOCD,
8652 so that setting the value marks the register as dirty instead
8653 of immediately flushing that value. Resuming CPU execution
8654 (including by single stepping) or otherwise activating the
8655 relevant module will flush such values.
8656
8657 Cores may have surprisingly many registers in their
8658 Debug and trace infrastructure:
8659
8660 @example
8661 > reg
8662 ===== ARM registers
8663 (0) r0 (/32): 0x0000D3C2 (dirty)
8664 (1) r1 (/32): 0xFD61F31C
8665 (2) r2 (/32)
8666 ...
8667 (164) ETM_contextid_comparator_mask (/32)
8668 >
8669 @end example
8670 @end deffn
8671
8672 @deffn {Command} {set_reg} dict
8673 Set register values of the target.
8674
8675 @itemize
8676 @item @var{dict} ... Tcl dictionary with pairs of register names and values.
8677 @end itemize
8678
8679 For example, the following command sets the value 0 to the program counter (pc)
8680 register and 0x1000 to the stack pointer (sp) register:
8681
8682 @example
8683 set_reg @{pc 0 sp 0x1000@}
8684 @end example
8685 @end deffn
8686
8687 @deffn {Command} {get_reg} [-force] list
8688 Get register values from the target and return them as Tcl dictionary with pairs
8689 of register names and values.
8690 If option "-force" is set, the register values are read directly from the
8691 target, bypassing any caching.
8692
8693 @itemize
8694 @item @var{list} ... List of register names
8695 @end itemize
8696
8697 For example, the following command retrieves the values from the program
8698 counter (pc) and stack pointer (sp) register:
8699
8700 @example
8701 get_reg @{pc sp@}
8702 @end example
8703 @end deffn
8704
8705 @deffn {Command} {write_memory} address width data ['phys']
8706 This function provides an efficient way to write to the target memory from a Tcl
8707 script.
8708
8709 @itemize
8710 @item @var{address} ... target memory address
8711 @item @var{width} ... memory access bit size, can be 8, 16, 32 or 64
8712 @item @var{data} ... Tcl list with the elements to write
8713 @item ['phys'] ... treat the memory address as physical instead of virtual address
8714 @end itemize
8715
8716 For example, the following command writes two 32 bit words into the target
8717 memory at address 0x20000000:
8718
8719 @example
8720 write_memory 0x20000000 32 @{0xdeadbeef 0x00230500@}
8721 @end example
8722 @end deffn
8723
8724 @deffn {Command} {read_memory} address width count ['phys']
8725 This function provides an efficient way to read the target memory from a Tcl
8726 script.
8727 A Tcl list containing the requested memory elements is returned by this function.
8728
8729 @itemize
8730 @item @var{address} ... target memory address
8731 @item @var{width} ... memory access bit size, can be 8, 16, 32 or 64
8732 @item @var{count} ... number of elements to read
8733 @item ['phys'] ... treat the memory address as physical instead of virtual address
8734 @end itemize
8735
8736 For example, the following command reads two 32 bit words from the target
8737 memory at address 0x20000000:
8738
8739 @example
8740 read_memory 0x20000000 32 2
8741 @end example
8742 @end deffn
8743
8744 @deffn {Command} {halt} [ms]
8745 @deffnx {Command} {wait_halt} [ms]
8746 The @command{halt} command first sends a halt request to the target,
8747 which @command{wait_halt} doesn't.
8748 Otherwise these behave the same: wait up to @var{ms} milliseconds,
8749 or 5 seconds if there is no parameter, for the target to halt
8750 (and enter debug mode).
8751 Using 0 as the @var{ms} parameter prevents OpenOCD from waiting.
8752
8753 @quotation Warning
8754 On ARM cores, software using the @emph{wait for interrupt} operation
8755 often blocks the JTAG access needed by a @command{halt} command.
8756 This is because that operation also puts the core into a low
8757 power mode by gating the core clock;
8758 but the core clock is needed to detect JTAG clock transitions.
8759
8760 One partial workaround uses adaptive clocking: when the core is
8761 interrupted the operation completes, then JTAG clocks are accepted
8762 at least until the interrupt handler completes.
8763 However, this workaround is often unusable since the processor, board,
8764 and JTAG adapter must all support adaptive JTAG clocking.
8765 Also, it can't work until an interrupt is issued.
8766
8767 A more complete workaround is to not use that operation while you
8768 work with a JTAG debugger.
8769 Tasking environments generally have idle loops where the body is the
8770 @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
8771 (On older cores, it is a coprocessor action;
8772 newer cores have a @option{wfi} instruction.)
8773 Such loops can just remove that operation, at the cost of higher
8774 power consumption (because the CPU is needlessly clocked).
8775 @end quotation
8776
8777 @end deffn
8778
8779 @deffn {Command} {resume} [address]
8780 Resume the target at its current code position,
8781 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
8782 OpenOCD will wait 5 seconds for the target to resume.
8783 @end deffn
8784
8785 @deffn {Command} {step} [address]
8786 Single-step the target at its current code position,
8787 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
8788 @end deffn
8789
8790 @anchor{resetcommand}
8791 @deffn {Command} {reset}
8792 @deffnx {Command} {reset run}
8793 @deffnx {Command} {reset halt}
8794 @deffnx {Command} {reset init}
8795 Perform as hard a reset as possible, using SRST if possible.
8796 @emph{All defined targets will be reset, and target
8797 events will fire during the reset sequence.}
8798
8799 The optional parameter specifies what should
8800 happen after the reset.
8801 If there is no parameter, a @command{reset run} is executed.
8802 The other options will not work on all systems.
8803 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
8804
8805 @itemize @minus
8806 @item @b{run} Let the target run
8807 @item @b{halt} Immediately halt the target
8808 @item @b{init} Immediately halt the target, and execute the reset-init script
8809 @end itemize
8810 @end deffn
8811
8812 @deffn {Command} {soft_reset_halt}
8813 Requesting target halt and executing a soft reset. This is often used
8814 when a target cannot be reset and halted. The target, after reset is
8815 released begins to execute code. OpenOCD attempts to stop the CPU and
8816 then sets the program counter back to the reset vector. Unfortunately
8817 the code that was executed may have left the hardware in an unknown
8818 state.
8819 @end deffn
8820
8821 @deffn {Command} {adapter assert} [signal [assert|deassert signal]]
8822 @deffnx {Command} {adapter deassert} [signal [assert|deassert signal]]
8823 Set values of reset signals.
8824 Without parameters returns current status of the signals.
8825 The @var{signal} parameter values may be
8826 @option{srst}, indicating that srst signal is to be asserted or deasserted,
8827 @option{trst}, indicating that trst signal is to be asserted or deasserted.
8828
8829 The @command{reset_config} command should already have been used
8830 to configure how the board and the adapter treat these two
8831 signals, and to say if either signal is even present.
8832 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
8833 Trying to assert a signal that is not present triggers an error.
8834 If a signal is present on the adapter and not specified in the command,
8835 the signal will not be modified.
8836
8837 @quotation Note
8838 TRST is specially handled.
8839 It actually signifies JTAG's @sc{reset} state.
8840 So if the board doesn't support the optional TRST signal,
8841 or it doesn't support it along with the specified SRST value,
8842 JTAG reset is triggered with TMS and TCK signals
8843 instead of the TRST signal.
8844 And no matter how that JTAG reset is triggered, once
8845 the scan chain enters @sc{reset} with TRST inactive,
8846 TAP @code{post-reset} events are delivered to all TAPs
8847 with handlers for that event.
8848 @end quotation
8849 @end deffn
8850
8851 @anchor{memoryaccess}
8852 @section Memory access commands
8853 @cindex memory access
8854
8855 These commands allow accesses of a specific size to the memory
8856 system. Often these are used to configure the current target in some
8857 special way. For example - one may need to write certain values to the
8858 SDRAM controller to enable SDRAM.
8859
8860 @enumerate
8861 @item Use the @command{targets} (plural) command
8862 to change the current target.
8863 @item In system level scripts these commands are deprecated.
8864 Please use their TARGET object siblings to avoid making assumptions
8865 about what TAP is the current target, or about MMU configuration.
8866 @end enumerate
8867
8868 @deffn {Command} {mdd} [phys] addr [count]
8869 @deffnx {Command} {mdw} [phys] addr [count]
8870 @deffnx {Command} {mdh} [phys] addr [count]
8871 @deffnx {Command} {mdb} [phys] addr [count]
8872 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
8873 64-bit doublewords (@command{mdd}),
8874 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
8875 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
8876 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
8877 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
8878 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
8879 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
8880 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
8881 (If you want to process the data instead of displaying it,
8882 see the @code{read_memory} primitives.)
8883 @end deffn
8884
8885 @deffn {Command} {mwd} [phys] addr doubleword [count]
8886 @deffnx {Command} {mww} [phys] addr word [count]
8887 @deffnx {Command} {mwh} [phys] addr halfword [count]
8888 @deffnx {Command} {mwb} [phys] addr byte [count]
8889 Writes the specified @var{doubleword} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
8890 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
8891 at the specified address @var{addr}.
8892 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
8893 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
8894 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
8895 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
8896 If @var{count} is specified, fills that many units of consecutive address.
8897 @end deffn
8898
8899 @anchor{imageaccess}
8900 @section Image loading commands
8901 @cindex image loading
8902 @cindex image dumping
8903
8904 @deffn {Command} {dump_image} filename address size
8905 Dump @var{size} bytes of target memory starting at @var{address} to the
8906 binary file named @var{filename}.
8907 @end deffn
8908
8909 @deffn {Command} {fast_load}
8910 Loads an image stored in memory by @command{fast_load_image} to the
8911 current target. Must be preceded by fast_load_image.
8912 @end deffn
8913
8914 @deffn {Command} {fast_load_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}]
8915 Normally you should be using @command{load_image} or GDB load. However, for
8916 testing purposes or when I/O overhead is significant(OpenOCD running on an embedded
8917 host), storing the image in memory and uploading the image to the target
8918 can be a way to upload e.g. multiple debug sessions when the binary does not change.
8919 Arguments are the same as @command{load_image}, but the image is stored in OpenOCD host
8920 memory, i.e. does not affect target. This approach is also useful when profiling
8921 target programming performance as I/O and target programming can easily be profiled
8922 separately.
8923 @end deffn
8924
8925 @deffn {Command} {load_image} filename address [[@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}] @option{min_addr} @option{max_length}]
8926 Load image from file @var{filename} to target memory offset by @var{address} from its load address.
8927 The file format may optionally be specified
8928 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, @option{elf}, or @option{s19}).
8929 In addition the following arguments may be specified:
8930 @var{min_addr} - ignore data below @var{min_addr} (this is w.r.t. to the target's load address + @var{address})
8931 @var{max_length} - maximum number of bytes to load.
8932 @example
8933 proc load_image_bin @{fname foffset address length @} @{
8934 # Load data from fname filename at foffset offset to
8935 # target at address. Load at most length bytes.
8936 load_image $fname [expr @{$address - $foffset@}] bin \
8937 $address $length
8938 @}
8939 @end example
8940 @end deffn
8941
8942 @deffn {Command} {test_image} filename [address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]]
8943 Displays image section sizes and addresses
8944 as if @var{filename} were loaded into target memory
8945 starting at @var{address} (defaults to zero).
8946 The file format may optionally be specified
8947 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8948 @end deffn
8949
8950 @deffn {Command} {verify_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
8951 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
8952 The file format may optionally be specified
8953 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8954 This will first attempt a comparison using a CRC checksum, if this fails it will try a binary compare.
8955 @end deffn
8956
8957 @deffn {Command} {verify_image_checksum} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
8958 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
8959 The file format may optionally be specified
8960 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8961 This perform a comparison using a CRC checksum only
8962 @end deffn
8963
8964
8965 @section Breakpoint and Watchpoint commands
8966 @cindex breakpoint
8967 @cindex watchpoint
8968
8969 CPUs often make debug modules accessible through JTAG, with
8970 hardware support for a handful of code breakpoints and data
8971 watchpoints.
8972 In addition, CPUs almost always support software breakpoints.
8973
8974 @deffn {Command} {bp} [address len [@option{hw}]]
8975 With no parameters, lists all active breakpoints.
8976 Else sets a breakpoint on code execution starting
8977 at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
8978 This is a software breakpoint, unless @option{hw} is specified
8979 in which case it will be a hardware breakpoint.
8980
8981 (@xref{arm9vectorcatch,,arm9 vector_catch}, or @pxref{xscalevectorcatch,,xscale vector_catch},
8982 for similar mechanisms that do not consume hardware breakpoints.)
8983 @end deffn
8984
8985 @deffn {Command} {rbp} @option{all} | address
8986 Remove the breakpoint at @var{address} or all breakpoints.
8987 @end deffn
8988
8989 @deffn {Command} {rwp} address
8990 Remove data watchpoint on @var{address}
8991 @end deffn
8992
8993 @deffn {Command} {wp} [address len [(@option{r}|@option{w}|@option{a}) [value [mask]]]]
8994 With no parameters, lists all active watchpoints.
8995 Else sets a data watchpoint on data from @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
8996 The watch point is an "access" watchpoint unless
8997 the @option{r} or @option{w} parameter is provided,
8998 defining it as respectively a read or write watchpoint.
8999 If a @var{value} is provided, that value is used when determining if
9000 the watchpoint should trigger. The value may be first be masked
9001 using @var{mask} to mark ``don't care'' fields.
9002 @end deffn
9003
9004
9005 @section Real Time Transfer (RTT)
9006
9007 Real Time Transfer (RTT) is an interface specified by SEGGER based on basic
9008 memory reads and writes to transfer data bidirectionally between target and host.
9009 The specification is independent of the target architecture.
9010 Every target that supports so called "background memory access", which means
9011 that the target memory can be accessed by the debugger while the target is
9012 running, can be used.
9013 This interface is especially of interest for targets without
9014 Serial Wire Output (SWO), such as ARM Cortex-M0, or where semihosting is not
9015 applicable because of real-time constraints.
9016
9017 @quotation Note
9018 The current implementation supports only single target devices.
9019 @end quotation
9020
9021 The data transfer between host and target device is organized through
9022 unidirectional up/down-channels for target-to-host and host-to-target
9023 communication, respectively.
9024
9025 @quotation Note
9026 The current implementation does not respect channel buffer flags.
9027 They are used to determine what happens when writing to a full buffer, for
9028 example.
9029 @end quotation
9030
9031 Channels are exposed via raw TCP/IP connections. One or more RTT servers can be
9032 assigned to each channel to make them accessible to an unlimited number
9033 of TCP/IP connections.
9034
9035 @deffn {Command} {rtt setup} address size ID
9036 Configure RTT for the currently selected target.
9037 Once RTT is started, OpenOCD searches for a control block with the
9038 identifier @var{ID} starting at the memory address @var{address} within the next
9039 @var{size} bytes.
9040 @end deffn
9041
9042 @deffn {Command} {rtt start}
9043 Start RTT.
9044 If the control block location is not known, OpenOCD starts searching for it.
9045 @end deffn
9046
9047 @deffn {Command} {rtt stop}
9048 Stop RTT.
9049 @end deffn
9050
9051 @deffn {Command} {rtt polling_interval} [interval]
9052 Display the polling interval.
9053 If @var{interval} is provided, set the polling interval.
9054 The polling interval determines (in milliseconds) how often the up-channels are
9055 checked for new data.
9056 @end deffn
9057
9058 @deffn {Command} {rtt channels}
9059 Display a list of all channels and their properties.
9060 @end deffn
9061
9062 @deffn {Command} {rtt channellist}
9063 Return a list of all channels and their properties as Tcl list.
9064 The list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
9065 @end deffn
9066
9067 @deffn {Command} {rtt server start} port channel
9068 Start a TCP server on @var{port} for the channel @var{channel}.
9069 @end deffn
9070
9071 @deffn {Command} {rtt server stop} port
9072 Stop the TCP sever with port @var{port}.
9073 @end deffn
9074
9075 The following example shows how to setup RTT using the SEGGER RTT implementation
9076 on the target device.
9077
9078 @example
9079 resume
9080
9081 rtt setup 0x20000000 2048 "SEGGER RTT"
9082 rtt start
9083
9084 rtt server start 9090 0
9085 @end example
9086
9087 In this example, OpenOCD searches the control block with the ID "SEGGER RTT"
9088 starting at 0x20000000 for 2048 bytes. The RTT channel 0 is exposed through the
9089 TCP/IP port 9090.
9090
9091
9092 @section Misc Commands
9093
9094 @cindex profiling
9095 @deffn {Command} {profile} seconds filename [start end]
9096 Profiling samples the CPU's program counter as quickly as possible,
9097 which is useful for non-intrusive stochastic profiling.
9098 Saves up to 10000 samples in @file{filename} using ``gmon.out''
9099 format. Optional @option{start} and @option{end} parameters allow to
9100 limit the address range.
9101 @end deffn
9102
9103 @deffn {Command} {version}
9104 Displays a string identifying the version of this OpenOCD server.
9105 @end deffn
9106
9107 @deffn {Command} {virt2phys} virtual_address
9108 Requests the current target to map the specified @var{virtual_address}
9109 to its corresponding physical address, and displays the result.
9110 @end deffn
9111
9112 @deffn {Command} {add_help_text} 'command_name' 'help-string'
9113 Add or replace help text on the given @var{command_name}.
9114 @end deffn
9115
9116 @deffn {Command} {add_usage_text} 'command_name' 'help-string'
9117 Add or replace usage text on the given @var{command_name}.
9118 @end deffn
9119
9120 @node Architecture and Core Commands
9121 @chapter Architecture and Core Commands
9122 @cindex Architecture Specific Commands
9123 @cindex Core Specific Commands
9124
9125 Most CPUs have specialized JTAG operations to support debugging.
9126 OpenOCD packages most such operations in its standard command framework.
9127 Some of those operations don't fit well in that framework, so they are
9128 exposed here as architecture or implementation (core) specific commands.
9129
9130 @anchor{armhardwaretracing}
9131 @section ARM Hardware Tracing
9132 @cindex tracing
9133 @cindex ETM
9134 @cindex ETB
9135
9136 CPUs based on ARM cores may include standard tracing interfaces,
9137 based on an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM) which sends voluminous
9138 address and data bus trace records to a ``Trace Port''.
9139
9140 @itemize
9141 @item
9142 Development-oriented boards will sometimes provide a high speed
9143 trace connector for collecting that data, when the particular CPU
9144 supports such an interface.
9145 (The standard connector is a 38-pin Mictor, with both JTAG
9146 and trace port support.)
9147 Those trace connectors are supported by higher end JTAG adapters
9148 and some logic analyzer modules; frequently those modules can
9149 buffer several megabytes of trace data.
9150 Configuring an ETM coupled to such an external trace port belongs
9151 in the board-specific configuration file.
9152 @item
9153 If the CPU doesn't provide an external interface, it probably
9154 has an ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB) on the chip, which is a
9155 dedicated SRAM. 4KBytes is one common ETB size.
9156 Configuring an ETM coupled only to an ETB belongs in the CPU-specific
9157 (target) configuration file, since it works the same on all boards.
9158 @end itemize
9159
9160 ETM support in OpenOCD doesn't seem to be widely used yet.
9161
9162 @quotation Issues
9163 ETM support may be buggy, and at least some @command{etm config}
9164 parameters should be detected by asking the ETM for them.
9165
9166 ETM trigger events could also implement a kind of complex
9167 hardware breakpoint, much more powerful than the simple
9168 watchpoint hardware exported by EmbeddedICE modules.
9169 @emph{Such breakpoints can be triggered even when using the
9170 dummy trace port driver}.
9171
9172 It seems like a GDB hookup should be possible,
9173 as well as tracing only during specific states
9174 (perhaps @emph{handling IRQ 23} or @emph{calls foo()}).
9175
9176 There should be GUI tools to manipulate saved trace data and help
9177 analyse it in conjunction with the source code.
9178 It's unclear how much of a common interface is shared
9179 with the current XScale trace support, or should be
9180 shared with eventual Nexus-style trace module support.
9181
9182 At this writing (November 2009) only ARM7, ARM9, and ARM11 support
9183 for ETM modules is available. The code should be able to
9184 work with some newer cores; but not all of them support
9185 this original style of JTAG access.
9186 @end quotation
9187
9188 @subsection ETM Configuration
9189 ETM setup is coupled with the trace port driver configuration.
9190
9191 @deffn {Config Command} {etm config} target width mode clocking driver
9192 Declares the ETM associated with @var{target}, and associates it
9193 with a given trace port @var{driver}. @xref{traceportdrivers,,Trace Port Drivers}.
9194
9195 Several of the parameters must reflect the trace port capabilities,
9196 which are a function of silicon capabilities (exposed later
9197 using @command{etm info}) and of what hardware is connected to
9198 that port (such as an external pod, or ETB).
9199 The @var{width} must be either 4, 8, or 16,
9200 except with ETMv3.0 and newer modules which may also
9201 support 1, 2, 24, 32, 48, and 64 bit widths.
9202 (With those versions, @command{etm info} also shows whether
9203 the selected port width and mode are supported.)
9204
9205 The @var{mode} must be @option{normal}, @option{multiplexed},
9206 or @option{demultiplexed}.
9207 The @var{clocking} must be @option{half} or @option{full}.
9208
9209 @quotation Warning
9210 With ETMv3.0 and newer, the bits set with the @var{mode} and
9211 @var{clocking} parameters both control the mode.
9212 This modified mode does not map to the values supported by
9213 previous ETM modules, so this syntax is subject to change.
9214 @end quotation
9215
9216 @quotation Note
9217 You can see the ETM registers using the @command{reg} command.
9218 Not all possible registers are present in every ETM.
9219 Most of the registers are write-only, and are used to configure
9220 what CPU activities are traced.
9221 @end quotation
9222 @end deffn
9223
9224 @deffn {Command} {etm info}
9225 Displays information about the current target's ETM.
9226 This includes resource counts from the @code{ETM_CONFIG} register,
9227 as well as silicon capabilities (except on rather old modules).
9228 from the @code{ETM_SYS_CONFIG} register.
9229 @end deffn
9230
9231 @deffn {Command} {etm status}
9232 Displays status of the current target's ETM and trace port driver:
9233 is the ETM idle, or is it collecting data?
9234 Did trace data overflow?
9235 Was it triggered?
9236 @end deffn
9237
9238 @deffn {Command} {etm tracemode} [type context_id_bits cycle_accurate branch_output]
9239 Displays what data that ETM will collect.
9240 If arguments are provided, first configures that data.
9241 When the configuration changes, tracing is stopped
9242 and any buffered trace data is invalidated.
9243
9244 @itemize
9245 @item @var{type} ... describing how data accesses are traced,
9246 when they pass any ViewData filtering that was set up.
9247 The value is one of
9248 @option{none} (save nothing),
9249 @option{data} (save data),
9250 @option{address} (save addresses),
9251 @option{all} (save data and addresses)
9252 @item @var{context_id_bits} ... 0, 8, 16, or 32
9253 @item @var{cycle_accurate} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}
9254 cycle-accurate instruction tracing.
9255 Before ETMv3, enabling this causes much extra data to be recorded.
9256 @item @var{branch_output} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}.
9257 Disable this unless you need to try reconstructing the instruction
9258 trace stream without an image of the code.
9259 @end itemize
9260 @end deffn
9261
9262 @deffn {Command} {etm trigger_debug} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
9263 Displays whether ETM triggering debug entry (like a breakpoint) is
9264 enabled or disabled, after optionally modifying that configuration.
9265 The default behaviour is @option{disable}.
9266 Any change takes effect after the next @command{etm start}.
9267
9268 By using script commands to configure ETM registers, you can make the
9269 processor enter debug state automatically when certain conditions,
9270 more complex than supported by the breakpoint hardware, happen.
9271 @end deffn
9272
9273 @subsection ETM Trace Operation
9274
9275 After setting up the ETM, you can use it to collect data.
9276 That data can be exported to files for later analysis.
9277 It can also be parsed with OpenOCD, for basic sanity checking.
9278
9279 To configure what is being traced, you will need to write
9280 various trace registers using @command{reg ETM_*} commands.
9281 For the definitions of these registers, read ARM publication
9282 @emph{IHI 0014, ``Embedded Trace Macrocell, Architecture Specification''}.
9283 Be aware that most of the relevant registers are write-only,
9284 and that ETM resources are limited. There are only a handful
9285 of address comparators, data comparators, counters, and so on.
9286
9287 Examples of scenarios you might arrange to trace include:
9288
9289 @itemize
9290 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{excluding} subroutines
9291 it calls. Use address range comparators to enable tracing
9292 for instruction access within that function's body.
9293 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{including} subroutines
9294 it calls. Use the sequencer and address comparators to activate
9295 tracing on an ``entered function'' state, then deactivate it by
9296 exiting that state when the function's exit code is invoked.
9297 @item Code flow starting at the fifth invocation of a function,
9298 combining one of the above models with a counter.
9299 @item CPU data accesses to the registers for a particular device,
9300 using address range comparators and the ViewData logic.
9301 @item Such data accesses only during IRQ handling, combining the above
9302 model with sequencer triggers which on entry and exit to the IRQ handler.
9303 @item @emph{... more}
9304 @end itemize
9305
9306 At this writing, September 2009, there are no Tcl utility
9307 procedures to help set up any common tracing scenarios.
9308
9309 @deffn {Command} {etm analyze}
9310 Reads trace data into memory, if it wasn't already present.
9311 Decodes and prints the data that was collected.
9312 @end deffn
9313
9314 @deffn {Command} {etm dump} filename
9315 Stores the captured trace data in @file{filename}.
9316 @end deffn
9317
9318 @deffn {Command} {etm image} filename [base_address] [type]
9319 Opens an image file.
9320 @end deffn
9321
9322 @deffn {Command} {etm load} filename
9323 Loads captured trace data from @file{filename}.
9324 @end deffn
9325
9326 @deffn {Command} {etm start}
9327 Starts trace data collection.
9328 @end deffn
9329
9330 @deffn {Command} {etm stop}
9331 Stops trace data collection.
9332 @end deffn
9333
9334 @anchor{traceportdrivers}
9335 @subsection Trace Port Drivers
9336
9337 To use an ETM trace port it must be associated with a driver.
9338
9339 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} {dummy}
9340 Use the @option{dummy} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
9341 not connected to anything (on-chip ETB or off-chip trace connector).
9342 @emph{This driver lets OpenOCD talk to the ETM, but it does not expose
9343 any trace data collection.}
9344 @deffn {Config Command} {etm_dummy config} target
9345 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a dummy driver.
9346 @end deffn
9347 @end deffn
9348
9349 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} {etb}
9350 Use the @option{etb} driver if you are configuring an ETM
9351 to use on-chip ETB memory.
9352 @deffn {Config Command} {etb config} target etb_tap
9353 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with the ETB at @var{etb_tap}.
9354 You can see the ETB registers using the @command{reg} command.
9355 @end deffn
9356 @deffn {Command} {etb trigger_percent} [percent]
9357 This displays, or optionally changes, ETB behavior after the
9358 ETM's configured @emph{trigger} event fires.
9359 It controls how much more trace data is saved after the (single)
9360 trace trigger becomes active.
9361
9362 @itemize
9363 @item The default corresponds to @emph{trace around} usage,
9364 recording 50 percent data before the event and the rest
9365 afterwards.
9366 @item The minimum value of @var{percent} is 2 percent,
9367 recording almost exclusively data before the trigger.
9368 Such extreme @emph{trace before} usage can help figure out
9369 what caused that event to happen.
9370 @item The maximum value of @var{percent} is 100 percent,
9371 recording data almost exclusively after the event.
9372 This extreme @emph{trace after} usage might help sort out
9373 how the event caused trouble.
9374 @end itemize
9375 @c REVISIT allow "break" too -- enter debug mode.
9376 @end deffn
9377
9378 @end deffn
9379
9380 @anchor{armcrosstrigger}
9381 @section ARM Cross-Trigger Interface
9382 @cindex CTI
9383
9384 The ARM Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) is a generic CoreSight component
9385 that connects event sources like tracing components or CPU cores with each
9386 other through a common trigger matrix (CTM). For ARMv8 architecture, a
9387 CTI is mandatory for core run control and each core has an individual
9388 CTI instance attached to it. OpenOCD has limited support for CTI using
9389 the @emph{cti} group of commands.
9390
9391 @deffn {Command} {cti create} cti_name @option{-dap} dap_name @option{-ap-num} apn @option{-baseaddr} base_address
9392 Creates a CTI instance @var{cti_name} on the DAP instance @var{dap_name} on MEM-AP
9393 @var{apn}.
9394 On ADIv5 DAP @var{apn} is the numeric index of the DAP AP the CTI is connected to.
9395 On ADIv6 DAP @var{apn} is the base address of the DAP AP the CTI is connected to.
9396 The @var{base_address} must match the base address of the CTI
9397 on the respective MEM-AP. All arguments are mandatory. This creates a
9398 new command @command{$cti_name} which is used for various purposes
9399 including additional configuration.
9400 @end deffn
9401
9402 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name enable} @option{on|off}
9403 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the CTI.
9404 @end deffn
9405
9406 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name dump}
9407 Displays a register dump of the CTI.
9408 @end deffn
9409
9410 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name write} @var{reg_name} @var{value}
9411 Write @var{value} to the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
9412 @end deffn
9413
9414 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name read} @var{reg_name}
9415 Print the value read from the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
9416 @end deffn
9417
9418 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name ack} @var{event}
9419 Acknowledge a CTI @var{event}.
9420 @end deffn
9421
9422 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name channel} @var{channel_number} @var{operation}
9423 Perform a specific channel operation, the possible operations are:
9424 gate, ungate, set, clear and pulse
9425 @end deffn
9426
9427 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name testmode} @option{on|off}
9428 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the integration test mode
9429 of the CTI.
9430 @end deffn
9431
9432 @deffn {Command} {cti names}
9433 Prints a list of names of all CTI objects created. This command is mainly
9434 useful in TCL scripting.
9435 @end deffn
9436
9437 @section Generic ARM
9438 @cindex ARM
9439
9440 These commands should be available on all ARM processors.
9441 They are available in addition to other core-specific
9442 commands that may be available.
9443
9444 @deffn {Command} {arm core_state} [@option{arm}|@option{thumb}]
9445 Displays the core_state, optionally changing it to process
9446 either @option{arm} or @option{thumb} instructions.
9447 The target may later be resumed in the currently set core_state.
9448 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
9449 that is not currently supported in OpenOCD.)
9450 @end deffn
9451
9452 @deffn {Command} {arm disassemble} address [count [@option{thumb}]]
9453 @cindex disassemble
9454 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
9455 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
9456 If @option{thumb} is specified, or the low bit of the address is set,
9457 Thumb2 (mixed 16/32-bit) instructions are used;
9458 else ARM (32-bit) instructions are used.
9459 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
9460 those instructions are not currently understood by OpenOCD.)
9461
9462 Note that all Thumb instructions are Thumb2 instructions,
9463 so older processors (without Thumb2 support) will still
9464 see correct disassembly of Thumb code.
9465 Also, ThumbEE opcodes are the same as Thumb2,
9466 with a handful of exceptions.
9467 ThumbEE disassembly currently has no explicit support.
9468 @end deffn
9469
9470 @deffn {Command} {arm mcr} pX op1 CRn CRm op2 value
9471 Write @var{value} to a coprocessor @var{pX} register
9472 passing parameters @var{CRn},
9473 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
9474 and using the MCR instruction.
9475 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
9476 an ARM register.)
9477 @end deffn
9478
9479 @deffn {Command} {arm mrc} pX coproc op1 CRn CRm op2
9480 Read a coprocessor @var{pX} register passing parameters @var{CRn},
9481 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
9482 and the MRC instruction.
9483 Returns the result so it can be manipulated by Jim scripts.
9484 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
9485 an ARM register.)
9486 @end deffn
9487
9488 @deffn {Command} {arm reg}
9489 Display a table of all banked core registers, fetching the current value from every
9490 core mode if necessary.
9491 @end deffn
9492
9493 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9494 @cindex ARM semihosting
9495 Display status of semihosting, after optionally changing that status.
9496
9497 Semihosting allows for code executing on an ARM target to use the
9498 I/O facilities on the host computer i.e. the system where OpenOCD
9499 is running. The target application must be linked against a library
9500 implementing the ARM semihosting convention that forwards operation
9501 requests by using a special SVC instruction that is trapped at the
9502 Supervisor Call vector by OpenOCD.
9503 @end deffn
9504
9505 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_redirect} (@option{disable} | @option{tcp} <port>
9506 [@option{debug}|@option{stdio}|@option{all})
9507 @cindex ARM semihosting
9508 Redirect semihosting messages to a specified TCP port.
9509
9510 This command redirects debug (READC, WRITEC and WRITE0) and stdio (READ, WRITE)
9511 semihosting operations to the specified TCP port.
9512 The command allows to select which type of operations to redirect (debug, stdio, all (default)).
9513 Note: for stdio operations, only I/O from/to ':tt' file descriptors are redirected.
9514 @end deffn
9515
9516 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_cmdline} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9517 @cindex ARM semihosting
9518 Set the command line to be passed to the debugger.
9519
9520 @example
9521 arm semihosting_cmdline argv0 argv1 argv2 ...
9522 @end example
9523
9524 This option lets one set the command line arguments to be passed to
9525 the program. The first argument (argv0) is the program name in a
9526 standard C environment (argv[0]). Depending on the program (not much
9527 programs look at argv[0]), argv0 is ignored and can be any string.
9528 @end deffn
9529
9530 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_fileio} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9531 @cindex ARM semihosting
9532 Display status of semihosting fileio, after optionally changing that
9533 status.
9534
9535 Enabling this option forwards semihosting I/O to GDB process using the
9536 File-I/O remote protocol extension. This is especially useful for
9537 interacting with remote files or displaying console messages in the
9538 debugger.
9539 @end deffn
9540
9541 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_resexit} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9542 @cindex ARM semihosting
9543 Enable resumable SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT.
9544
9545 When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called outside a debug session,
9546 things are simple, the openocd process calls exit() and passes
9547 the value returned by the target.
9548
9549 When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called during a debug session,
9550 by default execution returns to the debugger, leaving the
9551 debugger in a HALT state, similar to the state entered when
9552 encountering a break.
9553
9554 In some use cases, it is useful to have SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT
9555 return normally, as any semihosting call, and do not break
9556 to the debugger.
9557 The standard allows this to happen, but the condition
9558 to trigger it is a bit obscure ("by performing an RDI_Execute
9559 request or equivalent").
9560
9561 To make the SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT call return normally, enable
9562 this option (default: disabled).
9563 @end deffn
9564
9565 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_read_user_param}
9566 @cindex ARM semihosting
9567 Read parameter of the semihosting call from the target. Usable in
9568 semihosting-user-cmd-0x10* event handlers, returning a string.
9569
9570 When the target makes semihosting call with operation number from range 0x100-
9571 0x107, an optional string parameter can be passed to the server. This parameter
9572 is valid during the run of the event handlers and is accessible with this
9573 command.
9574 @end deffn
9575
9576 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_basedir} [dir]
9577 @cindex ARM semihosting
9578 Set the base directory for semihosting I/O, either an absolute path or a path relative to OpenOCD working directory.
9579 Use "." for the current directory.
9580 @end deffn
9581
9582 @section ARMv4 and ARMv5 Architecture
9583 @cindex ARMv4
9584 @cindex ARMv5
9585
9586 The ARMv4 and ARMv5 architectures are widely used in embedded systems,
9587 and introduced core parts of the instruction set in use today.
9588 That includes the Thumb instruction set, introduced in the ARMv4T
9589 variant.
9590
9591 @subsection ARM7 and ARM9 specific commands
9592 @cindex ARM7
9593 @cindex ARM9
9594
9595 These commands are specific to ARM7 and ARM9 cores, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T,
9596 ARM9TDMI, ARM920T or ARM926EJ-S.
9597 They are available in addition to the ARM commands,
9598 and any other core-specific commands that may be available.
9599
9600 @deffn {Command} {arm7_9 dbgrq} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9601 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the
9602 EmbeddedIce DBGRQ signal to force entry into debug mode,
9603 instead of breakpoints.
9604 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9605
9606 This should be
9607 safe for all but ARM7TDMI-S cores (like NXP LPC).
9608 This feature is enabled by default on most ARM9 cores,
9609 including ARM9TDMI, ARM920T, and ARM926EJ-S.
9610 @end deffn
9611
9612 @deffn {Command} {arm7_9 dcc_downloads} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9613 @cindex DCC
9614 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the debug communications
9615 channel (DCC) to write larger (>128 byte) amounts of memory.
9616 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9617
9618 DCC downloads offer a huge speed increase, but might be
9619 unsafe, especially with targets running at very low speeds. This command was introduced
9620 with OpenOCD rev. 60, and requires a few bytes of working area.
9621 @end deffn
9622
9623 @deffn {Command} {arm7_9 fast_memory_access} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9624 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of memory writes and reads
9625 that don't check completion of the operation.
9626 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9627
9628 This provides a huge speed increase, especially with USB JTAG
9629 cables (FT2232), but might be unsafe if used with targets running at very low
9630 speeds, like the 32kHz startup clock of an AT91RM9200.
9631 @end deffn
9632
9633 @subsection ARM9 specific commands
9634 @cindex ARM9
9635
9636 ARM9-family cores are built around ARM9TDMI or ARM9E (including ARM9EJS)
9637 integer processors.
9638 Such cores include the ARM920T, ARM926EJ-S, and ARM966.
9639
9640 @c 9-june-2009: tried this on arm920t, it didn't work.
9641 @c no-params always lists nothing caught, and that's how it acts.
9642 @c 23-oct-2009: doesn't work _consistently_ ... as if the ICE
9643 @c versions have different rules about when they commit writes.
9644
9645 @anchor{arm9vectorcatch}
9646 @deffn {Command} {arm9 vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
9647 @cindex vector_catch
9648 Vector Catch hardware provides a sort of dedicated breakpoint
9649 for hardware events such as reset, interrupt, and abort.
9650 You can use this to conserve normal breakpoint resources,
9651 so long as you're not concerned with code that branches directly
9652 to those hardware vectors.
9653
9654 This always finishes by listing the current configuration.
9655 If parameters are provided, it first reconfigures the
9656 vector catch hardware to intercept
9657 @option{all} of the hardware vectors,
9658 @option{none} of them,
9659 or a list with one or more of the following:
9660 @option{reset} @option{undef} @option{swi} @option{pabt} @option{dabt}
9661 @option{irq} @option{fiq}.
9662 @end deffn
9663
9664 @subsection ARM920T specific commands
9665 @cindex ARM920T
9666
9667 These commands are available to ARM920T based CPUs,
9668 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
9669 built using the ARM9TDMI integer core.
9670 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
9671 and ARM9 commands.
9672
9673 @deffn {Command} {arm920t cache_info}
9674 Print information about the caches found. This allows to see whether your target
9675 is an ARM920T (2x16kByte cache) or ARM922T (2x8kByte cache).
9676 @end deffn
9677
9678 @deffn {Command} {arm920t cp15} regnum [value]
9679 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
9680 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
9681 This uses "physical access" and the register number is as
9682 shown in bits 38..33 of table 9-9 in the ARM920T TRM.
9683 (Not all registers can be written.)
9684 @end deffn
9685
9686 @deffn {Command} {arm920t read_cache} filename
9687 Dump the content of ICache and DCache to a file named @file{filename}.
9688 @end deffn
9689
9690 @deffn {Command} {arm920t read_mmu} filename
9691 Dump the content of the ITLB and DTLB to a file named @file{filename}.
9692 @end deffn
9693
9694 @subsection ARM926ej-s specific commands
9695 @cindex ARM926ej-s
9696
9697 These commands are available to ARM926ej-s based CPUs,
9698 which are implementations of the ARMv5TEJ architecture
9699 based on the ARM9EJ-S integer core.
9700 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
9701 and ARM9 commands.
9702
9703 The Feroceon cores also support these commands, although
9704 they are not built from ARM926ej-s designs.
9705
9706 @deffn {Command} {arm926ejs cache_info}
9707 Print information about the caches found.
9708 @end deffn
9709
9710 @subsection ARM966E specific commands
9711 @cindex ARM966E
9712
9713 These commands are available to ARM966 based CPUs,
9714 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
9715 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
9716 and ARM9 commands.
9717
9718 @deffn {Command} {arm966e cp15} regnum [value]
9719 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
9720 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
9721 The six bit @var{regnum} values are bits 37..32 from table 7-2 of the
9722 ARM966E-S TRM.
9723 There is no current control over bits 31..30 from that table,
9724 as required for BIST support.
9725 @end deffn
9726
9727 @subsection XScale specific commands
9728 @cindex XScale
9729
9730 Some notes about the debug implementation on the XScale CPUs:
9731
9732 The XScale CPU provides a special debug-only mini-instruction cache
9733 (mini-IC) in which exception vectors and target-resident debug handler
9734 code are placed by OpenOCD. In order to get access to the CPU, OpenOCD
9735 must point vector 0 (the reset vector) to the entry of the debug
9736 handler. However, this means that the complete first cacheline in the
9737 mini-IC is marked valid, which makes the CPU fetch all exception
9738 handlers from the mini-IC, ignoring the code in RAM.
9739
9740 To address this situation, OpenOCD provides the @code{xscale
9741 vector_table} command, which allows the user to explicitly write
9742 individual entries to either the high or low vector table stored in
9743 the mini-IC.
9744
9745 It is recommended to place a pc-relative indirect branch in the vector
9746 table, and put the branch destination somewhere in memory. Doing so
9747 makes sure the code in the vector table stays constant regardless of
9748 code layout in memory:
9749 @example
9750 _vectors:
9751 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9752 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9753 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9754 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9755 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9756 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9757 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9758 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9759 .org 0x100
9760 .long real_reset_vector
9761 .long real_ui_handler
9762 .long real_swi_handler
9763 .long real_pf_abort
9764 .long real_data_abort
9765 .long 0 /* unused */
9766 .long real_irq_handler
9767 .long real_fiq_handler
9768 @end example
9769
9770 Alternatively, you may choose to keep some or all of the mini-IC
9771 vector table entries synced with those written to memory by your
9772 system software. The mini-IC can not be modified while the processor
9773 is executing, but for each vector table entry not previously defined
9774 using the @code{xscale vector_table} command, OpenOCD will copy the
9775 value from memory to the mini-IC every time execution resumes from a
9776 halt. This is done for both high and low vector tables (although the
9777 table not in use may not be mapped to valid memory, and in this case
9778 that copy operation will silently fail). This means that you will
9779 need to briefly halt execution at some strategic point during system
9780 start-up; e.g., after the software has initialized the vector table,
9781 but before exceptions are enabled. A breakpoint can be used to
9782 accomplish this once the appropriate location in the start-up code has
9783 been identified. A watchpoint over the vector table region is helpful
9784 in finding the location if you're not sure. Note that the same
9785 situation exists any time the vector table is modified by the system
9786 software.
9787
9788 The debug handler must be placed somewhere in the address space using
9789 the @code{xscale debug_handler} command. The allowed locations for the
9790 debug handler are either (0x800 - 0x1fef800) or (0xfe000800 -
9791 0xfffff800). The default value is 0xfe000800.
9792
9793 XScale has resources to support two hardware breakpoints and two
9794 watchpoints. However, the following restrictions on watchpoint
9795 functionality apply: (1) the value and mask arguments to the @code{wp}
9796 command are not supported, (2) the watchpoint length must be a
9797 power of two and not less than four, and can not be greater than the
9798 watchpoint address, and (3) a watchpoint with a length greater than
9799 four consumes all the watchpoint hardware resources. This means that
9800 at any one time, you can have enabled either two watchpoints with a
9801 length of four, or one watchpoint with a length greater than four.
9802
9803 These commands are available to XScale based CPUs,
9804 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
9805
9806 @deffn {Command} {xscale analyze_trace}
9807 Displays the contents of the trace buffer.
9808 @end deffn
9809
9810 @deffn {Command} {xscale cache_clean_address} address
9811 Changes the address used when cleaning the data cache.
9812 @end deffn
9813
9814 @deffn {Command} {xscale cache_info}
9815 Displays information about the CPU caches.
9816 @end deffn
9817
9818 @deffn {Command} {xscale cp15} regnum [value]
9819 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
9820 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
9821 @end deffn
9822
9823 @deffn {Command} {xscale debug_handler} target address
9824 Changes the address used for the specified target's debug handler.
9825 @end deffn
9826
9827 @deffn {Command} {xscale dcache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9828 Enables or disable the CPU's data cache.
9829 @end deffn
9830
9831 @deffn {Command} {xscale dump_trace} filename
9832 Dumps the raw contents of the trace buffer to @file{filename}.
9833 @end deffn
9834
9835 @deffn {Command} {xscale icache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9836 Enables or disable the CPU's instruction cache.
9837 @end deffn
9838
9839 @deffn {Command} {xscale mmu} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9840 Enables or disable the CPU's memory management unit.
9841 @end deffn
9842
9843 @deffn {Command} {xscale trace_buffer} [@option{enable}|@option{disable} [@option{fill} [n] | @option{wrap}]]
9844 Displays the trace buffer status, after optionally
9845 enabling or disabling the trace buffer
9846 and modifying how it is emptied.
9847 @end deffn
9848
9849 @deffn {Command} {xscale trace_image} filename [offset [type]]
9850 Opens a trace image from @file{filename}, optionally rebasing
9851 its segment addresses by @var{offset}.
9852 The image @var{type} may be one of
9853 @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
9854 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19),
9855 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
9856 @end deffn
9857
9858 @anchor{xscalevectorcatch}
9859 @deffn {Command} {xscale vector_catch} [mask]
9860 @cindex vector_catch
9861 Display a bitmask showing the hardware vectors to catch.
9862 If the optional parameter is provided, first set the bitmask to that value.
9863
9864 The mask bits correspond with bit 16..23 in the DCSR:
9865 @example
9866 0x01 Trap Reset
9867 0x02 Trap Undefined Instructions
9868 0x04 Trap Software Interrupt
9869 0x08 Trap Prefetch Abort
9870 0x10 Trap Data Abort
9871 0x20 reserved
9872 0x40 Trap IRQ
9873 0x80 Trap FIQ
9874 @end example
9875 @end deffn
9876
9877 @deffn {Command} {xscale vector_table} [(@option{low}|@option{high}) index value]
9878 @cindex vector_table
9879
9880 Set an entry in the mini-IC vector table. There are two tables: one for
9881 low vectors (at 0x00000000), and one for high vectors (0xFFFF0000), each
9882 holding the 8 exception vectors. @var{index} can be 1-7, because vector 0
9883 points to the debug handler entry and can not be overwritten.
9884 @var{value} holds the 32-bit opcode that is placed in the mini-IC.
9885
9886 Without arguments, the current settings are displayed.
9887
9888 @end deffn
9889
9890 @section ARMv6 Architecture
9891 @cindex ARMv6
9892
9893 @subsection ARM11 specific commands
9894 @cindex ARM11
9895
9896 @deffn {Command} {arm11 memwrite burst} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9897 Displays the value of the memwrite burst-enable flag,
9898 which is enabled by default.
9899 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9900 Burst writes are only used for memory writes larger than 1 word.
9901 They improve performance by assuming that the CPU has read each data
9902 word over JTAG and completed its write before the next word arrives,
9903 instead of polling for a status flag to verify that completion.
9904 This is usually safe, because JTAG runs much slower than the CPU.
9905 @end deffn
9906
9907 @deffn {Command} {arm11 memwrite error_fatal} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9908 Displays the value of the memwrite error_fatal flag,
9909 which is enabled by default.
9910 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9911 When set, certain memory write errors cause earlier transfer termination.
9912 @end deffn
9913
9914 @deffn {Command} {arm11 step_irq_enable} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9915 Displays the value of the flag controlling whether
9916 IRQs are enabled during single stepping;
9917 they are disabled by default.
9918 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that.
9919 @end deffn
9920
9921 @deffn {Command} {arm11 vcr} [value]
9922 @cindex vector_catch
9923 Displays the value of the @emph{Vector Catch Register (VCR)},
9924 coprocessor 14 register 7.
9925 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
9926
9927 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
9928 for certain hardware events.
9929 The specific bit values are core-specific (as in fact is using
9930 coprocessor 14 register 7 itself) but all current ARM11
9931 cores @emph{except the ARM1176} use the same six bits.
9932 @end deffn
9933
9934 @section ARMv7 and ARMv8 Architecture
9935 @cindex ARMv7
9936 @cindex ARMv8
9937
9938 @subsection ARMv7-A specific commands
9939 @cindex Cortex-A
9940
9941 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a cache_info}
9942 display information about target caches
9943 @end deffn
9944
9945 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a dacrfixup} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9946 Work around issues with software breakpoints when the program text is
9947 mapped read-only by the operating system. This option sets the CP15 DACR
9948 to "all-manager" to bypass MMU permission checks on memory access.
9949 Defaults to 'off'.
9950 @end deffn
9951
9952 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a dbginit}
9953 Initialize core debug
9954 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
9955 @end deffn
9956
9957 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a smp} [on|off]
9958 Display/set the current SMP mode
9959 @end deffn
9960
9961 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a smp_gdb} [core_id]
9962 Display/set the current core displayed in GDB
9963 @end deffn
9964
9965 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9966 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
9967 @end deffn
9968
9969 @deffn {Command} {cache_config l2x} [base way]
9970 configure l2x cache
9971 @end deffn
9972
9973 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a mmu dump} [@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{addr} address [@option{num_entries}]]
9974 Dump the MMU translation table from TTB0 or TTB1 register, or from physical
9975 memory location @var{address}. When dumping the table from @var{address}, print at most
9976 @var{num_entries} page table entries. @var{num_entries} is optional, if omitted, the maximum
9977 possible (4096) entries are printed.
9978 @end deffn
9979
9980 @subsection ARMv7-R specific commands
9981 @cindex Cortex-R
9982
9983 @deffn {Command} {cortex_r4 dbginit}
9984 Initialize core debug
9985 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
9986 @end deffn
9987
9988 @deffn {Command} {cortex_r4 maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9989 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
9990 @end deffn
9991
9992
9993 @subsection ARM CoreSight TPIU and SWO specific commands
9994 @cindex tracing
9995 @cindex SWO
9996 @cindex SWV
9997 @cindex TPIU
9998
9999 ARM CoreSight provides several modules to generate debugging
10000 information internally (ITM, DWT and ETM). Their output is directed
10001 through TPIU or SWO modules to be captured externally either on an SWO pin (this
10002 configuration is called SWV) or on a synchronous parallel trace port.
10003
10004 ARM CoreSight provides independent HW blocks named TPIU and SWO each with its
10005 own functionality. Embedded in Cortex-M3 and M4, ARM provides an optional HW
10006 block that includes both TPIU and SWO functionalities and is again named TPIU,
10007 which causes quite some confusion.
10008 The registers map of all the TPIU and SWO implementations allows using a single
10009 driver that detects at runtime the features available.
10010
10011 The @command{tpiu} is used for either TPIU or SWO.
10012 A convenient alias @command{swo} is available to help distinguish, in scripts,
10013 the commands for SWO from the commands for TPIU.
10014
10015 @deffn {Command} {swo} ...
10016 Alias of @command{tpiu ...}. Can be used in scripts to distinguish the commands
10017 for SWO from the commands for TPIU.
10018 @end deffn
10019
10020 @deffn {Command} {tpiu create} tpiu_name configparams...
10021 Creates a TPIU or a SWO object. The two commands are equivalent.
10022 Add the object in a list and add new commands (@command{@var{tpiu_name}})
10023 which are used for various purposes including additional configuration.
10024
10025 @itemize @bullet
10026 @item @var{tpiu_name} -- the name of the TPIU or SWO object.
10027 This name is also used to create the object's command, referred to here
10028 as @command{$tpiu_name}, and in other places where the TPIU or SWO needs to be identified.
10029 @item @var{configparams} -- all parameters accepted by @command{$tpiu_name configure} are permitted.
10030
10031 You @emph{must} set here the AP and MEM_AP base_address through @code{-dap @var{dap_name}},
10032 @code{-ap-num @var{ap_number}} and @code{-baseaddr @var{base_address}}.
10033 @end itemize
10034 @end deffn
10035
10036 @deffn {Command} {tpiu names}
10037 Lists all the TPIU or SWO objects created so far. The two commands are equivalent.
10038 @end deffn
10039
10040 @deffn {Command} {tpiu init}
10041 Initialize all registered TPIU and SWO. The two commands are equivalent.
10042 These commands are used internally during initialization. They can be issued
10043 at any time after the initialization, too.
10044 @end deffn
10045
10046 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name cget} queryparm
10047 Each configuration parameter accepted by @command{$tpiu_name configure} can be
10048 individually queried, to return its current value.
10049 The @var{queryparm} is a parameter name accepted by that command, such as @code{-dap}.
10050 @end deffn
10051
10052 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name configure} configparams...
10053 The options accepted by this command may also be specified as parameters
10054 to @command{tpiu create}. Their values can later be queried one at a time by
10055 using the @command{$tpiu_name cget} command.
10056
10057 @itemize @bullet
10058 @item @code{-dap} @var{dap_name} -- names the DAP used to access this
10059 TPIU. @xref{dapdeclaration,,DAP declaration}, on how to create and manage DAP instances.
10060
10061 @item @code{-ap-num} @var{ap_number} -- sets DAP access port for TPIU.
10062 On ADIv5 DAP @var{ap_number} is the numeric index of the DAP AP the TPIU is connected to.
10063 On ADIv6 DAP @var{ap_number} is the base address of the DAP AP the TPIU is connected to.
10064
10065 @item @code{-baseaddr} @var{base_address} -- sets the TPIU @var{base_address} where
10066 to access the TPIU in the DAP AP memory space.
10067
10068 @item @code{-protocol} (@option{sync}|@option{uart}|@option{manchester}) -- sets the
10069 protocol used for trace data:
10070 @itemize @minus
10071 @item @option{sync} -- synchronous parallel trace output mode, using @var{port_width}
10072 data bits (default);
10073 @item @option{uart} -- use asynchronous SWO mode with NRZ (same as regular UART 8N1) coding;
10074 @item @option{manchester} -- use asynchronous SWO mode with Manchester coding.
10075 @end itemize
10076
10077 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} @var{event_body} -- assigns an event handler,
10078 a TCL string which is evaluated when the event is triggered. The events
10079 @code{pre-enable}, @code{post-enable}, @code{pre-disable} and @code{post-disable}
10080 are defined for TPIU/SWO.
10081 A typical use case for the event @code{pre-enable} is to enable the trace clock
10082 of the TPIU.
10083
10084 @item @code{-output} (@option{external}|@option{:}@var{port}|@var{filename}|@option{-}) -- specifies
10085 the destination of the trace data:
10086 @itemize @minus
10087 @item @option{external} -- configure TPIU/SWO to let user capture trace
10088 output externally, either with an additional UART or with a logic analyzer (default);
10089 @item @option{-} -- configure TPIU/SWO and debug adapter to gather trace data
10090 and forward it to @command{tcl_trace} command;
10091 @item @option{:}@var{port} -- configure TPIU/SWO and debug adapter to gather
10092 trace data, open a TCP server at port @var{port} and send the trace data to
10093 each connected client;
10094 @item @var{filename} -- configure TPIU/SWO and debug adapter to
10095 gather trace data and append it to @var{filename}, which can be
10096 either a regular file or a named pipe.
10097 @end itemize
10098
10099 @item @code{-traceclk} @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} -- mandatory parameter.
10100 Specifies the frequency in Hz of the trace clock. For the TPIU embedded in
10101 Cortex-M3 or M4, this is usually the same frequency as HCLK. For protocol
10102 @option{sync} this is twice the frequency of the pin data rate.
10103
10104 @item @code{-pin-freq} @var{trace_freq} -- specifies the expected data rate
10105 in Hz of the SWO pin. Parameter used only on protocols @option{uart} and
10106 @option{manchester}. Can be omitted to let the adapter driver select the
10107 maximum supported rate automatically.
10108
10109 @item @code{-port-width} @var{port_width} -- sets to @var{port_width} the width
10110 of the synchronous parallel port used for trace output. Parameter used only on
10111 protocol @option{sync}. If not specified, default value is @var{1}.
10112
10113 @item @code{-formatter} (@option{0}|@option{1}) -- specifies if the formatter
10114 should be enabled. Parameter used only on protocol @option{sync}. If not specified,
10115 default value is @var{0}.
10116 @end itemize
10117 @end deffn
10118
10119 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name enable}
10120 Uses the parameters specified by the previous @command{$tpiu_name configure}
10121 to configure and enable the TPIU or the SWO.
10122 If required, the adapter is also configured and enabled to receive the trace
10123 data.
10124 This command can be used before @command{init}, but it will take effect only
10125 after the @command{init}.
10126 @end deffn
10127
10128 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name disable}
10129 Disable the TPIU or the SWO, terminating the receiving of the trace data.
10130 @end deffn
10131
10132
10133
10134 Example usage:
10135 @enumerate
10136 @item STM32L152 board is programmed with an application that configures
10137 PLL to provide core clock with 24MHz frequency; to use ITM output it's
10138 enough to:
10139 @example
10140 #include <libopencm3/cm3/itm.h>
10141 ...
10142 ITM_STIM8(0) = c;
10143 ...
10144 @end example
10145 (the most obvious way is to use the first stimulus port for printf,
10146 for that this ITM_STIM8 assignment can be used inside _write(); to make it
10147 blocking to avoid data loss, add @code{while (!(ITM_STIM8(0) &
10148 ITM_STIM_FIFOREADY));});
10149 @item An FT2232H UART is connected to the SWO pin of the board;
10150 @item Commands to configure UART for 12MHz baud rate:
10151 @example
10152 $ setserial /dev/ttyUSB1 spd_cust divisor 5
10153 $ stty -F /dev/ttyUSB1 38400
10154 @end example
10155 (FT2232H's base frequency is 60MHz, spd_cust allows to alias 38400
10156 baud with our custom divisor to get 12MHz)
10157 @item @code{itmdump -f /dev/ttyUSB1 -d1}
10158 @item OpenOCD invocation line:
10159 @example
10160 openocd -f interface/stlink.cfg \
10161 -c "transport select hla_swd" \
10162 -f target/stm32l1.cfg \
10163 -c "stm32l1.tpiu configure -protocol uart" \
10164 -c "stm32l1.tpiu configure -traceclk 24000000 -pin-freq 12000000" \
10165 -c "stm32l1.tpiu enable"
10166 @end example
10167 @end enumerate
10168
10169 @subsection ARMv7-M specific commands
10170 @cindex tracing
10171 @cindex SWO
10172 @cindex SWV
10173 @cindex ITM
10174 @cindex ETM
10175
10176 @deffn {Command} {itm port} @var{port} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
10177 Enable or disable trace output for ITM stimulus @var{port} (counting
10178 from 0). Port 0 is enabled on target creation automatically.
10179 @end deffn
10180
10181 @deffn {Command} {itm ports} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
10182 Enable or disable trace output for all ITM stimulus ports.
10183 @end deffn
10184
10185 @subsection Cortex-M specific commands
10186 @cindex Cortex-M
10187
10188 @deffn {Command} {cortex_m maskisr} (@option{auto}|@option{on}|@option{off}|@option{steponly})
10189 Control masking (disabling) interrupts during target step/resume.
10190
10191 The @option{auto} option handles interrupts during stepping in a way that they
10192 get served but don't disturb the program flow. The step command first allows
10193 pending interrupt handlers to execute, then disables interrupts and steps over
10194 the next instruction where the core was halted. After the step interrupts
10195 are enabled again. If the interrupt handlers don't complete within 500ms,
10196 the step command leaves with the core running.
10197
10198 The @option{steponly} option disables interrupts during single-stepping but
10199 enables them during normal execution. This can be used as a partial workaround
10200 for 702596 erratum in Cortex-M7 r0p1. See "Cortex-M7 (AT610) and Cortex-M7 with
10201 FPU (AT611) Software Developer Errata Notice" from ARM for further details.
10202
10203 Note that a free hardware (FPB) breakpoint is required for the @option{auto}
10204 option. If no breakpoint is available at the time of the step, then the step
10205 is taken with interrupts enabled, i.e. the same way the @option{off} option
10206 does.
10207
10208 Default is @option{auto}.
10209 @end deffn
10210
10211 @deffn {Command} {cortex_m vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
10212 @cindex vector_catch
10213 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
10214 for certain hardware events.
10215
10216 Parameters request interception of
10217 @option{all} of these hardware event vectors,
10218 @option{none} of them,
10219 or one or more of the following:
10220 @option{hard_err} for a HardFault exception;
10221 @option{mm_err} for a MemManage exception;
10222 @option{bus_err} for a BusFault exception;
10223 @option{irq_err},
10224 @option{state_err},
10225 @option{chk_err}, or
10226 @option{nocp_err} for various UsageFault exceptions; or
10227 @option{reset}.
10228 If NVIC setup code does not enable them,
10229 MemManage, BusFault, and UsageFault exceptions
10230 are mapped to HardFault.
10231 UsageFault checks for
10232 divide-by-zero and unaligned access
10233 must also be explicitly enabled.
10234
10235 This finishes by listing the current vector catch configuration.
10236 @end deffn
10237
10238 @deffn {Command} {cortex_m reset_config} (@option{sysresetreq}|@option{vectreset})
10239 Control reset handling if hardware srst is not fitted
10240 @xref{reset_config,,reset_config}.
10241
10242 @itemize @minus
10243 @item @option{sysresetreq} use AIRCR SYSRESETREQ to reset system.
10244 @item @option{vectreset} use AIRCR VECTRESET to reset system (default).
10245 @end itemize
10246
10247 Using @option{vectreset} is a safe option for Cortex-M3, M4 and M7 cores.
10248 This however has the disadvantage of only resetting the core, all peripherals
10249 are unaffected. A solution would be to use a @code{reset-init} event handler
10250 to manually reset the peripherals.
10251 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
10252
10253 Cortex-M0, M0+ and M1 do not support @option{vectreset}, use @option{sysresetreq}
10254 instead.
10255 @end deffn
10256
10257 @subsection ARMv8-A specific commands
10258 @cindex ARMv8-A
10259 @cindex aarch64
10260
10261 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 cache_info}
10262 Display information about target caches
10263 @end deffn
10264
10265 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 dbginit}
10266 This command enables debugging by clearing the OS Lock and sticky power-down and reset
10267 indications. It also establishes the expected, basic cross-trigger configuration the aarch64
10268 target code relies on. In a configuration file, the command would typically be called from a
10269 @code{reset-end} or @code{reset-deassert-post} handler, to re-enable debugging after a system reset.
10270 However, normally it is not necessary to use the command at all.
10271 @end deffn
10272
10273 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 disassemble} address [count]
10274 @cindex disassemble
10275 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
10276 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
10277 @end deffn
10278
10279 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 smp} [on|off]
10280 Display, enable or disable SMP handling mode. The state of SMP handling influences the way targets in an SMP group
10281 are handled by the run control. With SMP handling enabled, issuing halt or resume to one core will trigger
10282 halting or resuming of all cores in the group. The command @code{target smp} defines which targets are in the SMP
10283 group. With SMP handling disabled, all targets need to be treated individually.
10284 @end deffn
10285
10286 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
10287 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping. The default configuration is
10288 @option{on}.
10289 @end deffn
10290
10291 @deffn {Command} {$target_name catch_exc} [@option{off}|@option{sec_el1}|@option{sec_el3}|@option{nsec_el1}|@option{nsec_el2}]+
10292 Cause @command{$target_name} to halt when an exception is taken. Any combination of
10293 Secure (sec) EL1/EL3 or Non-Secure (nsec) EL1/EL2 is valid. The target
10294 @command{$target_name} will halt before taking the exception. In order to resume
10295 the target, the exception catch must be disabled again with @command{$target_name catch_exc off}.
10296 Issuing the command without options prints the current configuration.
10297 @end deffn
10298
10299 @section EnSilica eSi-RISC Architecture
10300
10301 eSi-RISC is a highly configurable microprocessor architecture for embedded systems
10302 provided by EnSilica. (See: @url{http://www.ensilica.com/risc-ip/}.)
10303
10304 @subsection eSi-RISC Configuration
10305
10306 @deffn {Command} {esirisc cache_arch} (@option{harvard}|@option{von_neumann})
10307 Configure the caching architecture. Targets with the @code{UNIFIED_ADDRESS_SPACE}
10308 option disabled employ a Harvard architecture. By default, @option{von_neumann} is assumed.
10309 @end deffn
10310
10311 @deffn {Command} {esirisc hwdc} (@option{all}|@option{none}|mask ...)
10312 Configure hardware debug control. The HWDC register controls which exceptions return
10313 control back to the debugger. Possible masks are @option{all}, @option{none},
10314 @option{reset}, @option{interrupt}, @option{syscall}, @option{error}, and @option{debug}.
10315 By default, @option{reset}, @option{error}, and @option{debug} are enabled.
10316 @end deffn
10317
10318 @subsection eSi-RISC Operation
10319
10320 @deffn {Command} {esirisc flush_caches}
10321 Flush instruction and data caches. This command requires that the target is halted
10322 when the command is issued and configured with an instruction or data cache.
10323 @end deffn
10324
10325 @subsection eSi-Trace Configuration
10326
10327 eSi-RISC targets may be configured with support for instruction tracing. Trace
10328 data may be written to an in-memory buffer or FIFO. If a FIFO is configured, DMA
10329 is typically employed to move trace data off-device using a high-speed
10330 peripheral (eg. SPI). Collected trace data is encoded in one of three different
10331 formats. At a minimum, @command{esirisc trace buffer} or @command{esirisc trace
10332 fifo} must be issued along with @command{esirisc trace format} before trace data
10333 can be collected.
10334
10335 OpenOCD provides rudimentary analysis of collected trace data. If more detail is
10336 needed, collected trace data can be dumped to a file and processed by external
10337 tooling.
10338
10339 @quotation Issues
10340 OpenOCD is unable to process trace data sent to a FIFO. A potential workaround
10341 for this issue is to configure DMA to copy trace data to an in-memory buffer,
10342 which can then be passed to the @command{esirisc trace analyze} and
10343 @command{esirisc trace dump} commands.
10344
10345 It is possible to corrupt trace data when using a FIFO if the peripheral
10346 responsible for draining data from the FIFO is not fast enough. This can be
10347 managed by enabling flow control, however this can impact timing-sensitive
10348 software operation on the CPU.
10349 @end quotation
10350
10351 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace buffer} address size [@option{wrap}]
10352 Configure trace buffer using the provided address and size. If the @option{wrap}
10353 option is specified, trace collection will continue once the end of the buffer
10354 is reached. By default, wrap is disabled.
10355 @end deffn
10356
10357 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace fifo} address
10358 Configure trace FIFO using the provided address.
10359 @end deffn
10360
10361 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace flow_control} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
10362 Enable or disable stalling the CPU to collect trace data. By default, flow
10363 control is disabled.
10364 @end deffn
10365
10366 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace format} (@option{full}|@option{branch}|@option{icache}) pc_bits
10367 Configure trace format and number of PC bits to be captured. @option{pc_bits}
10368 must be within 1 and 31 as the LSB is not collected. If external tooling is used
10369 to analyze collected trace data, these values must match.
10370
10371 Supported trace formats:
10372 @itemize
10373 @item @option{full} capture full trace data, allowing execution history and
10374 timing to be determined.
10375 @item @option{branch} capture taken branch instructions and branch target
10376 addresses.
10377 @item @option{icache} capture instruction cache misses.
10378 @end itemize
10379 @end deffn
10380
10381 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace trigger start} (@option{condition}) [start_data start_mask]
10382 Configure trigger start condition using the provided start data and mask. A
10383 brief description of each condition is provided below; for more detail on how
10384 these values are used, see the eSi-RISC Architecture Manual.
10385
10386 Supported conditions:
10387 @itemize
10388 @item @option{none} manual tracing (see @command{esirisc trace start}).
10389 @item @option{pc} start tracing if the PC matches start data and mask.
10390 @item @option{load} start tracing if the effective address of a load
10391 instruction matches start data and mask.
10392 @item @option{store} start tracing if the effective address of a store
10393 instruction matches start data and mask.
10394 @item @option{exception} start tracing if the EID of an exception matches start
10395 data and mask.
10396 @item @option{eret} start tracing when an @code{ERET} instruction is executed.
10397 @item @option{wait} start tracing when a @code{WAIT} instruction is executed.
10398 @item @option{stop} start tracing when a @code{STOP} instruction is executed.
10399 @item @option{high} start tracing when an external signal is a logical high.
10400 @item @option{low} start tracing when an external signal is a logical low.
10401 @end itemize
10402 @end deffn
10403
10404 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace trigger stop} (@option{condition}) [stop_data stop_mask]
10405 Configure trigger stop condition using the provided stop data and mask. A brief
10406 description of each condition is provided below; for more detail on how these
10407 values are used, see the eSi-RISC Architecture Manual.
10408
10409 Supported conditions:
10410 @itemize
10411 @item @option{none} manual tracing (see @command{esirisc trace stop}).
10412 @item @option{pc} stop tracing if the PC matches stop data and mask.
10413 @item @option{load} stop tracing if the effective address of a load
10414 instruction matches stop data and mask.
10415 @item @option{store} stop tracing if the effective address of a store
10416 instruction matches stop data and mask.
10417 @item @option{exception} stop tracing if the EID of an exception matches stop
10418 data and mask.
10419 @item @option{eret} stop tracing when an @code{ERET} instruction is executed.
10420 @item @option{wait} stop tracing when a @code{WAIT} instruction is executed.
10421 @item @option{stop} stop tracing when a @code{STOP} instruction is executed.
10422 @end itemize
10423 @end deffn
10424
10425 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace trigger delay} (@option{trigger}) [cycles]
10426 Configure trigger start/stop delay in clock cycles.
10427
10428 Supported triggers:
10429 @itemize
10430 @item @option{none} no delay to start or stop collection.
10431 @item @option{start} delay @option{cycles} after trigger to start collection.
10432 @item @option{stop} delay @option{cycles} after trigger to stop collection.
10433 @item @option{both} delay @option{cycles} after both triggers to start or stop
10434 collection.
10435 @end itemize
10436 @end deffn
10437
10438 @subsection eSi-Trace Operation
10439
10440 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace init}
10441 Initialize trace collection. This command must be called any time the
10442 configuration changes. If a trace buffer has been configured, the contents will
10443 be overwritten when trace collection starts.
10444 @end deffn
10445
10446 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace info}
10447 Display trace configuration.
10448 @end deffn
10449
10450 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace status}
10451 Display trace collection status.
10452 @end deffn
10453
10454 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace start}
10455 Start manual trace collection.
10456 @end deffn
10457
10458 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace stop}
10459 Stop manual trace collection.
10460 @end deffn
10461
10462 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace analyze} [address size]
10463 Analyze collected trace data. This command may only be used if a trace buffer
10464 has been configured. If a trace FIFO has been configured, trace data must be
10465 copied to an in-memory buffer identified by the @option{address} and
10466 @option{size} options using DMA.
10467 @end deffn
10468
10469 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace dump} [address size] @file{filename}
10470 Dump collected trace data to file. This command may only be used if a trace
10471 buffer has been configured. If a trace FIFO has been configured, trace data must
10472 be copied to an in-memory buffer identified by the @option{address} and
10473 @option{size} options using DMA.
10474 @end deffn
10475
10476 @section Intel Architecture
10477
10478 Intel Quark X10xx is the first product in the Quark family of SoCs. It is an IA-32
10479 (Pentium x86 ISA) compatible SoC. The core CPU in the X10xx is codenamed Lakemont.
10480 Lakemont version 1 (LMT1) is used in X10xx. The CPU TAP (Lakemont TAP) is used for
10481 software debug and the CLTAP is used for SoC level operations.
10482 Useful docs are here: https://communities.intel.com/community/makers/documentation
10483 @itemize
10484 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 OpenOCD/GDB/Eclipse App Note (web search for doc num 330015)
10485 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Debug Operations User Guide (web search for doc num 329866)
10486 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Datasheet (web search for doc num 329676)
10487 @end itemize
10488
10489 @subsection x86 32-bit specific commands
10490 The three main address spaces for x86 are memory, I/O and configuration space.
10491 These commands allow a user to read and write to the 64Kbyte I/O address space.
10492
10493 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 idw} address
10494 Display the contents of a 32-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10495 @end deffn
10496
10497 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 idh} address
10498 Display the contents of a 16-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10499 @end deffn
10500
10501 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 idb} address
10502 Display the contents of a 8-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10503 @end deffn
10504
10505 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 iww} address
10506 Write the contents of a 32-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10507 @end deffn
10508
10509 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 iwh} address
10510 Write the contents of a 16-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10511 @end deffn
10512
10513 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 iwb} address
10514 Write the contents of a 8-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10515 @end deffn
10516
10517 @section OpenRISC Architecture
10518
10519 The OpenRISC CPU is a soft core. It is used in a programmable SoC which can be
10520 configured with any of the TAP / Debug Unit available.
10521
10522 @subsection TAP and Debug Unit selection commands
10523 @deffn {Command} {tap_select} (@option{vjtag}|@option{mohor}|@option{xilinx_bscan})
10524 Select between the Altera Virtual JTAG , Xilinx Virtual JTAG and Mohor TAP.
10525 @end deffn
10526 @deffn {Command} {du_select} (@option{adv}|@option{mohor}) [option]
10527 Select between the Advanced Debug Interface and the classic one.
10528
10529 An option can be passed as a second argument to the debug unit.
10530
10531 When using the Advanced Debug Interface, option = 1 means the RTL core is
10532 configured with ADBG_USE_HISPEED = 1. This configuration skips status checking
10533 between bytes while doing read or write bursts.
10534 @end deffn
10535
10536 @subsection Registers commands
10537 @deffn {Command} {addreg} [name] [address] [feature] [reg_group]
10538 Add a new register in the cpu register list. This register will be
10539 included in the generated target descriptor file.
10540
10541 @strong{[feature]} must be "org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group[0..10]".
10542
10543 @strong{[reg_group]} can be anything. The default register list defines "system",
10544 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic"
10545 and "timer" groups.
10546
10547 @emph{example:}
10548 @example
10549 addreg rtest 0x1234 org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group0 system
10550 @end example
10551
10552 @end deffn
10553
10554 @section RISC-V Architecture
10555
10556 @uref{http://riscv.org/, RISC-V} is a free and open ISA. OpenOCD supports JTAG
10557 debug of RV32 and RV64 cores in heterogeneous multicore systems of up to 32
10558 harts. (It's possible to increase this limit to 1024 by changing
10559 RISCV_MAX_HARTS in riscv.h.) OpenOCD primarily supports 0.13 of the RISC-V
10560 Debug Specification, but there is also support for legacy targets that
10561 implement version 0.11.
10562
10563 @subsection RISC-V Terminology
10564
10565 A @emph{hart} is a hardware thread. A hart may share resources (eg. FPU) with
10566 another hart, or may be a separate core. RISC-V treats those the same, and
10567 OpenOCD exposes each hart as a separate core.
10568
10569 @subsection Vector Registers
10570
10571 For harts that implement the vector extension, OpenOCD provides access to the
10572 relevant CSRs, as well as the vector registers (v0-v31). The size of each
10573 vector register is dependent on the value of vlenb. RISC-V allows each vector
10574 register to be divided into selected-width elements, and this division can be
10575 changed at run-time. Because OpenOCD cannot update register definitions at
10576 run-time, it exposes each vector register to gdb as a union of fields of
10577 vectors so that users can easily access individual bytes, shorts, words,
10578 longs, and quads inside each vector register. It is left to gdb or
10579 higher-level debuggers to present this data in a more intuitive format.
10580
10581 In the XML register description, the vector registers (when vlenb=16) look as
10582 follows:
10583
10584 @example
10585 <feature name="org.gnu.gdb.riscv.vector">
10586 <vector id="bytes" type="uint8" count="16"/>
10587 <vector id="shorts" type="uint16" count="8"/>
10588 <vector id="words" type="uint32" count="4"/>
10589 <vector id="longs" type="uint64" count="2"/>
10590 <vector id="quads" type="uint128" count="1"/>
10591 <union id="riscv_vector">
10592 <field name="b" type="bytes"/>
10593 <field name="s" type="shorts"/>
10594 <field name="w" type="words"/>
10595 <field name="l" type="longs"/>
10596 <field name="q" type="quads"/>
10597 </union>
10598 <reg name="v0" bitsize="128" regnum="4162" save-restore="no"
10599 type="riscv_vector" group="vector"/>
10600 ...
10601 <reg name="v31" bitsize="128" regnum="4193" save-restore="no"
10602 type="riscv_vector" group="vector"/>
10603 </feature>
10604 @end example
10605
10606 @subsection RISC-V Debug Configuration Commands
10607
10608 @deffn {Config Command} {riscv expose_csrs} n[-m|=name] [...]
10609 Configure which CSRs to expose in addition to the standard ones. The CSRs to expose
10610 can be specified as individual register numbers or register ranges (inclusive). For the
10611 individually listed CSRs, a human-readable name can optionally be set using the @code{n=name}
10612 syntax, which will get @code{csr_} prepended to it. If no name is provided, the register will be
10613 named @code{csr<n>}.
10614
10615 By default OpenOCD attempts to expose only CSRs that are mentioned in a spec,
10616 and then only if the corresponding extension appears to be implemented. This
10617 command can be used if OpenOCD gets this wrong, or if the target implements custom
10618 CSRs.
10619
10620 @example
10621 # Expose a single RISC-V CSR number 128 under the name "csr128":
10622 $_TARGETNAME expose_csrs 128
10623
10624 # Expose multiple RISC-V CSRs 128..132 under names "csr128" through "csr132":
10625 $_TARGETNAME expose_csrs 128-132
10626
10627 # Expose a single RISC-V CSR number 1996 under custom name "csr_myregister":
10628 $_TARGETNAME expose_csrs 1996=myregister
10629 @end example
10630 @end deffn
10631
10632 @deffn {Config Command} {riscv expose_custom} n[-m|=name] [...]
10633 The RISC-V Debug Specification allows targets to expose custom registers
10634 through abstract commands. (See Section 3.5.1.1 in that document.) This command
10635 configures individual registers or register ranges (inclusive) that shall be exposed.
10636 Number 0 indicates the first custom register, whose abstract command number is 0xc000.
10637 For individually listed registers, a human-readable name can be optionally provided
10638 using the @code{n=name} syntax, which will get @code{custom_} prepended to it. If no
10639 name is provided, the register will be named @code{custom<n>}.
10640
10641 @example
10642 # Expose one RISC-V custom register with number 0xc010 (0xc000 + 16)
10643 # under the name "custom16":
10644 $_TARGETNAME expose_custom 16
10645
10646 # Expose a range of RISC-V custom registers with numbers 0xc010 .. 0xc018
10647 # (0xc000+16 .. 0xc000+24) under the names "custom16" through "custom24":
10648 $_TARGETNAME expose_custom 16-24
10649
10650 # Expose one RISC-V custom register with number 0xc020 (0xc000 + 32) under
10651 # user-defined name "custom_myregister":
10652 $_TARGETNAME expose_custom 32=myregister
10653 @end example
10654 @end deffn
10655
10656 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_command_timeout_sec} [seconds]
10657 Set the wall-clock timeout (in seconds) for individual commands. The default
10658 should work fine for all but the slowest targets (eg. simulators).
10659 @end deffn
10660
10661 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_reset_timeout_sec} [seconds]
10662 Set the maximum time to wait for a hart to come out of reset after reset is
10663 deasserted.
10664 @end deffn
10665
10666 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_scratch_ram} none|[address]
10667 Set the address of 16 bytes of scratch RAM the debugger can use, or 'none'.
10668 This is used to access 64-bit floating point registers on 32-bit targets.
10669 @end deffn
10670
10671 @deffn Command {riscv set_mem_access} method1 [method2] [method3]
10672 Specify which RISC-V memory access method(s) shall be used, and in which order
10673 of priority. At least one method must be specified.
10674
10675 Available methods are:
10676 @itemize
10677 @item @code{progbuf} - Use RISC-V Debug Program Buffer to access memory.
10678 @item @code{sysbus} - Access memory via RISC-V Debug System Bus interface.
10679 @item @code{abstract} - Access memory via RISC-V Debug abstract commands.
10680 @end itemize
10681
10682 By default, all memory access methods are enabled in the following order:
10683 @code{progbuf sysbus abstract}.
10684
10685 This command can be used to change the memory access methods if the default
10686 behavior is not suitable for a particular target.
10687 @end deffn
10688
10689 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_enable_virtual} on|off
10690 When on, memory accesses are performed on physical or virtual memory depending
10691 on the current system configuration. When off (default), all memory accessses are performed
10692 on physical memory.
10693 @end deffn
10694
10695 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_enable_virt2phys} on|off
10696 When on (default), memory accesses are performed on physical or virtual memory
10697 depending on the current satp configuration. When off, all memory accessses are
10698 performed on physical memory.
10699 @end deffn
10700
10701 @deffn {Command} {riscv resume_order} normal|reversed
10702 Some software assumes all harts are executing nearly continuously. Such
10703 software may be sensitive to the order that harts are resumed in. On harts
10704 that don't support hasel, this option allows the user to choose the order the
10705 harts are resumed in. If you are using this option, it's probably masking a
10706 race condition problem in your code.
10707
10708 Normal order is from lowest hart index to highest. This is the default
10709 behavior. Reversed order is from highest hart index to lowest.
10710 @end deffn
10711
10712 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ir} (@option{idcode}|@option{dtmcs}|@option{dmi}) [value]
10713 Set the IR value for the specified JTAG register. This is useful, for
10714 example, when using the existing JTAG interface on a Xilinx FPGA by
10715 way of BSCANE2 primitives that only permit a limited selection of IR
10716 values.
10717
10718 When utilizing version 0.11 of the RISC-V Debug Specification,
10719 @option{dtmcs} and @option{dmi} set the IR values for the DTMCONTROL
10720 and DBUS registers, respectively.
10721 @end deffn
10722
10723 @deffn {Command} {riscv use_bscan_tunnel} value
10724 Enable or disable use of a BSCAN tunnel to reach DM. Supply the width of
10725 the DM transport TAP's instruction register to enable. Supply a value of 0 to disable.
10726 @end deffn
10727
10728 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ebreakm} on|off
10729 Control dcsr.ebreakm. When on (default), M-mode ebreak instructions trap to
10730 OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
10731 @end deffn
10732
10733 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ebreaks} on|off
10734 Control dcsr.ebreaks. When on (default), S-mode ebreak instructions trap to
10735 OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
10736 @end deffn
10737
10738 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ebreaku} on|off
10739 Control dcsr.ebreaku. When on (default), U-mode ebreak instructions trap to
10740 OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
10741 @end deffn
10742
10743 @subsection RISC-V Authentication Commands
10744
10745 The following commands can be used to authenticate to a RISC-V system. Eg. a
10746 trivial challenge-response protocol could be implemented as follows in a
10747 configuration file, immediately following @command{init}:
10748 @example
10749 set challenge [riscv authdata_read]
10750 riscv authdata_write [expr @{$challenge + 1@}]
10751 @end example
10752
10753 @deffn {Command} {riscv authdata_read}
10754 Return the 32-bit value read from authdata.
10755 @end deffn
10756
10757 @deffn {Command} {riscv authdata_write} value
10758 Write the 32-bit value to authdata.
10759 @end deffn
10760
10761 @subsection RISC-V DMI Commands
10762
10763 The following commands allow direct access to the Debug Module Interface, which
10764 can be used to interact with custom debug features.
10765
10766 @deffn {Command} {riscv dmi_read} address
10767 Perform a 32-bit DMI read at address, returning the value.
10768 @end deffn
10769
10770 @deffn {Command} {riscv dmi_write} address value
10771 Perform a 32-bit DMI write of value at address.
10772 @end deffn
10773
10774 @section ARC Architecture
10775 @cindex ARC
10776
10777 Synopsys DesignWare ARC Processors are a family of 32-bit CPUs that SoC
10778 designers can optimize for a wide range of uses, from deeply embedded to
10779 high-performance host applications in a variety of market segments. See more
10780 at: @url{http://www.synopsys.com/IP/ProcessorIP/ARCProcessors/Pages/default.aspx}.
10781 OpenOCD currently supports ARC EM processors.
10782 There is a set ARC-specific OpenOCD commands that allow low-level
10783 access to the core and provide necessary support for ARC extensibility and
10784 configurability capabilities. ARC processors has much more configuration
10785 capabilities than most of the other processors and in addition there is an
10786 extension interface that allows SoC designers to add custom registers and
10787 instructions. For the OpenOCD that mostly means that set of core and AUX
10788 registers in target will vary and is not fixed for a particular processor
10789 model. To enable extensibility several TCL commands are provided that allow to
10790 describe those optional registers in OpenOCD configuration files. Moreover
10791 those commands allow for a dynamic target features discovery.
10792
10793
10794 @subsection General ARC commands
10795
10796 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg} configparams
10797
10798 Add a new register to processor target. By default newly created register is
10799 marked as not existing. @var{configparams} must have following required
10800 arguments:
10801
10802 @itemize @bullet
10803
10804 @item @code{-name} name
10805 @*Name of a register.
10806
10807 @item @code{-num} number
10808 @*Architectural register number: core register number or AUX register number.
10809
10810 @item @code{-feature} XML_feature
10811 @*Name of GDB XML target description feature.
10812
10813 @end itemize
10814
10815 @var{configparams} may have following optional arguments:
10816
10817 @itemize @bullet
10818
10819 @item @code{-gdbnum} number
10820 @*GDB register number. It is recommended to not assign GDB register number
10821 manually, because there would be a risk that two register will have same
10822 number. When register GDB number is not set with this option, then register
10823 will get a previous register number + 1. This option is required only for those
10824 registers that must be at particular address expected by GDB.
10825
10826 @item @code{-core}
10827 @*This option specifies that register is a core registers. If not - this is an
10828 AUX register. AUX registers and core registers reside in different address
10829 spaces.
10830
10831 @item @code{-bcr}
10832 @*This options specifies that register is a BCR register. BCR means Build
10833 Configuration Registers - this is a special type of AUX registers that are read
10834 only and non-volatile, that is - they never change their value. Therefore OpenOCD
10835 never invalidates values of those registers in internal caches. Because BCR is a
10836 type of AUX registers, this option cannot be used with @code{-core}.
10837
10838 @item @code{-type} type_name
10839 @*Name of type of this register. This can be either one of the basic GDB types,
10840 or a custom types described with @command{arc add-reg-type-[flags|struct]}.
10841
10842 @item @code{-g}
10843 @* If specified then this is a "general" register. General registers are always
10844 read by OpenOCD on context save (when core has just been halted) and is always
10845 transferred to GDB client in a response to g-packet. Contrary to this,
10846 non-general registers are read and sent to GDB client on-demand. In general it
10847 is not recommended to apply this option to custom registers.
10848
10849 @end itemize
10850
10851 @end deffn
10852
10853 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg-type-flags} -name name flags...
10854 Adds new register type of ``flags'' class. ``Flags'' types can contain only
10855 one-bit fields. Each flag definition looks like @code{-flag name bit-position}.
10856 @end deffn
10857
10858 @anchor{add-reg-type-struct}
10859 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg-type-struct} -name name structs...
10860 Adds new register type of ``struct'' class. ``Struct'' types can contain either
10861 bit-fields or fields of other types, however at the moment only bit fields are
10862 supported. Structure bit field definition looks like @code{-bitfield name
10863 startbit endbit}.
10864 @end deffn
10865
10866 @deffn {Command} {arc get-reg-field} reg-name field-name
10867 Returns value of bit-field in a register. Register must be ``struct'' register
10868 type, @xref{add-reg-type-struct}. command definition.
10869 @end deffn
10870
10871 @deffn {Command} {arc set-reg-exists} reg-names...
10872 Specify that some register exists. Any amount of names can be passed
10873 as an argument for a single command invocation.
10874 @end deffn
10875
10876 @subsection ARC JTAG commands
10877
10878 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag set-aux-reg} regnum value
10879 This command writes value to AUX register via its number. This command access
10880 register in target directly via JTAG, bypassing any OpenOCD internal caches,
10881 therefore it is unsafe to use if that register can be operated by other means.
10882
10883 @end deffn
10884
10885 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag set-core-reg} regnum value
10886 This command is similar to @command{arc jtag set-aux-reg} but is for core
10887 registers.
10888 @end deffn
10889
10890 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag get-aux-reg} regnum
10891 This command returns the value storded in AUX register via its number. This commands access
10892 register in target directly via JTAG, bypassing any OpenOCD internal caches,
10893 therefore it is unsafe to use if that register can be operated by other means.
10894
10895 @end deffn
10896
10897 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag get-core-reg} regnum
10898 This command is similar to @command{arc jtag get-aux-reg} but is for core
10899 registers.
10900 @end deffn
10901
10902 @section STM8 Architecture
10903 @uref{http://st.com/stm8/, STM8} is a 8-bit microcontroller platform from
10904 STMicroelectronics, based on a proprietary 8-bit core architecture.
10905
10906 OpenOCD supports debugging STM8 through the STMicroelectronics debug
10907 protocol SWIM, @pxref{swimtransport,,SWIM}.
10908
10909 @section Xtensa Architecture
10910
10911 Xtensa is a highly-customizable, user-extensible microprocessor and DSP
10912 architecture for complex embedded systems provided by Cadence Design
10913 Systems, Inc. See the
10914 @uref{https://www.cadence.com/en_US/home/tools/ip/tensilica-ip.html, Tensilica IP}
10915 website for additional information and documentation.
10916
10917 OpenOCD supports generic Xtensa processor implementations which can be customized by
10918 providing a core-specific configuration file which describes every enabled
10919 Xtensa architecture option, e.g. number of address registers, exceptions, reduced
10920 size instructions support, memory banks configuration etc. OpenOCD also supports SMP
10921 configurations for Xtensa processors with any number of cores and allows configuring
10922 their debug interconnect (termed "break/stall networks"), which control how debug
10923 signals are distributed among cores. Xtensa "break networks" are compatible with
10924 ARM's Cross Trigger Interface (CTI). OpenOCD implements both generic Xtensa targets
10925 as well as several Espressif Xtensa-based chips from the
10926 @uref{https://www.espressif.com/en/products/socs, ESP32 family}.
10927
10928 OCD sessions for Xtensa processor and DSP targets are accessed via the Xtensa
10929 Debug Module (XDM), which provides external connectivity either through a
10930 traditional JTAG interface or an ARM DAP interface. If used, the DAP interface
10931 can control Xtensa targets through JTAG or SWD probes.
10932
10933 @subsection Xtensa Core Configuration
10934
10935 Due to the high level of configurability in Xtensa cores, the Xtensa target
10936 configuration comprises two categories:
10937
10938 @enumerate
10939 @item Base Xtensa support common to all core configurations, and
10940 @item Core-specific support as configured for individual cores.
10941 @end enumerate
10942
10943 All common Xtensa support is built into the OpenOCD Xtensa target layer and
10944 is enabled through a combination of TCL scripts: the target-specific
10945 @file{target/xtensa.cfg} and a board-specific @file{board/xtensa-*.cfg},
10946 similar to other target architectures.
10947
10948 Importantly, core-specific configuration information must be provided by
10949 the user, and takes the form of an @file{xtensa-core-XXX.cfg} TCL script that
10950 defines the core's configurable features through a series of Xtensa
10951 configuration commands (detailed below).
10952
10953 This core-specific @file{xtensa-core-XXX.cfg} file is typically either:
10954
10955 @itemize @bullet
10956 @item Located within the Xtensa core configuration build as
10957 @file{src/config/xtensa-core-openocd.cfg}, or
10958 @item Generated by running the command @code{xt-gdb --dump-oocd-config}
10959 from the Xtensa processor tool-chain's command-line tools.
10960 @end itemize
10961
10962 NOTE: @file{xtensa-core-XXX.cfg} must match the target Xtensa hardware
10963 connected to OpenOCD.
10964
10965 Some example Xtensa configurations are bundled with OpenOCD for reference:
10966 @itemize @bullet
10967 @item Cadence Palladium VDebug emulation target. The user can combine their
10968 @file{xtensa-core-XXX.cfg} with the provided
10969 @file{board/xtensa-palladium-vdebug.cfg} to debug an emulated Xtensa RTL design.
10970 @item NXP MIMXRT685-EVK evaluation kit. The relevant configuration files are
10971 @file{board/xtensa-rt685-jlink.cfg} and @file{board/xtensa-core-nxp_rt600.cfg}.
10972 Additional information is provided by
10973 @uref{https://www.nxp.com/design/development-boards/i-mx-evaluation-and-development-boards/i-mx-rt600-evaluation-kit:MIMXRT685-EVK,
10974 NXP}.
10975 @end itemize
10976
10977 @subsection Xtensa Configuration Commands
10978
10979 @deffn {Config Command} {xtensa xtdef} (@option{LX}|@option{NX})
10980 Configure the Xtensa target architecture. Currently, Xtensa support is limited
10981 to LX6, LX7, and NX cores.
10982 @end deffn
10983
10984 @deffn {Config Command} {xtensa xtopt} option value
10985 Configure Xtensa target options that are relevant to the debug subsystem.
10986 @var{option} is one of: @option{arnum}, @option{windowed},
10987 @option{cpenable}, @option{exceptions}, @option{intnum}, @option{hipriints},
10988 @option{excmlevel}, @option{intlevels}, @option{debuglevel},
10989 @option{ibreaknum}, or @option{dbreaknum}. @var{value} is an integer with
10990 the exact range determined by each particular option.
10991
10992 NOTE: Some options are specific to Xtensa LX or Xtensa NX architecture, while
10993 others may be common to both but have different valid ranges.
10994 @end deffn
10995
10996 @deffn {Config Command} {xtensa xtmem} (@option{iram}|@option{dram}|@option{sram}|@option{irom}|@option{drom}|@option{srom}) baseaddr bytes
10997 Configure Xtensa target memory. Memory type determines access rights,
10998 where RAMs are read/write while ROMs are read-only. @var{baseaddr} and
10999 @var{bytes} are both integers, typically hexadecimal and decimal, respectively.
11000 @end deffn
11001
11002 @deffn {Config Command} {xtensa xtmem} (@option{icache}|@option{dcache}) linebytes cachebytes ways [writeback]
11003 Configure Xtensa processor cache. All parameters are required except for
11004 the optional @option{writeback} parameter; all are integers.
11005 @end deffn
11006
11007 @deffn {Config Command} {xtensa xtmpu} numfgseg minsegsz lockable execonly
11008 Configure an Xtensa Memory Protection Unit (MPU). MPUs can restrict access
11009 and/or control cacheability of specific address ranges, but are lighter-weight
11010 than a full traditional MMU. All parameters are required; all are integers.
11011 @end deffn
11012
11013 @deffn {Config Command} {xtensa xtmmu} numirefillentries numdrefillentries
11014 (Xtensa-LX only) Configure an Xtensa Memory Management Unit (MMU). Both
11015 parameters are required; both are integers.
11016 @end deffn
11017
11018 @deffn {Config Command} {xtensa xtregs} numregs
11019 Configure the total number of registers for the Xtensa core. Configuration
11020 logic expects to subsequently process this number of @code{xtensa xtreg}
11021 definitions. @var{numregs} is an integer.
11022 @end deffn
11023
11024 @deffn {Config Command} {xtensa xtregfmt} (@option{sparse}|@option{contiguous}) [general]
11025 Configure the type of register map used by GDB to access the Xtensa core.
11026 Generic Xtensa tools (e.g. xt-gdb) require @option{sparse} mapping (default) while
11027 Espressif tools expect @option{contiguous} mapping. Contiguous mapping takes an
11028 additional, optional integer parameter @option{numgregs}, which specifies the number
11029 of general registers used in handling g/G packets.
11030 @end deffn
11031
11032 @deffn {Config Command} {xtensa xtreg} name offset
11033 Configure an Xtensa core register. All core registers are 32 bits wide,
11034 while TIE and user registers may have variable widths. @var{name} is a
11035 character string identifier while @var{offset} is a hexadecimal integer.
11036 @end deffn
11037
11038 @subsection Xtensa Operation Commands
11039
11040 @deffn {Command} {xtensa maskisr} (@option{on}|@option{off})
11041 (Xtensa-LX only) Mask or unmask Xtensa interrupts during instruction step.
11042 When masked, an interrupt that occurs during a step operation is handled and
11043 its ISR is executed, with the user's debug session returning after potentially
11044 executing many instructions. When unmasked, a triggered interrupt will result
11045 in execution progressing the requested number of instructions into the relevant
11046 vector/ISR code.
11047 @end deffn
11048
11049 @deffn {Command} {xtensa set_permissive} (0|1)
11050 By default accessing memory beyond defined regions is forbidden. This commnd controls memory access address check.
11051 When set to (1), skips access controls and address range check before read/write memory.
11052 @end deffn
11053
11054 @deffn {Command} {xtensa smpbreak} [none|breakinout|runstall] | [BreakIn] [BreakOut] [RunStallIn] [DebugModeOut]
11055 Configures debug signals connection ("break network") for currently selected core.
11056 @itemize @bullet
11057 @item @code{none} - Core's "break/stall network" is disconnected. Core is not affected by any debug
11058 signal from other cores.
11059 @item @code{breakinout} - Core's "break network" is fully connected (break inputs and outputs are enabled).
11060 Core will receive debug break signals from other cores and send such signals to them. For example when another core
11061 is stopped due to breakpoint hit this core will be stopped too and vice versa.
11062 @item @code{runstall} - Core's "stall network" is fully connected (stall inputs and outputs are enabled).
11063 This feature is not well implemented and tested yet.
11064 @item @code{BreakIn} - Core's "break-in" signal is enabled.
11065 Core will receive debug break signals from other cores. For example when another core is
11066 stopped due to breakpoint hit this core will be stopped too.
11067 @item @code{BreakOut} - Core's "break-out" signal is enabled.
11068 Core will send debug break signal to other cores. For example when this core is
11069 stopped due to breakpoint hit other cores with enabled break-in signals will be stopped too.
11070 @item @code{RunStallIn} - Core's "runstall-in" signal is enabled.
11071 This feature is not well implemented and tested yet.
11072 @item @code{DebugModeOut} - Core's "debugmode-out" signal is enabled.
11073 This feature is not well implemented and tested yet.
11074 @end itemize
11075 @end deffn
11076
11077 @deffn {Command} {xtensa exe} <ascii-encoded hexadecimal instruction bytes>
11078 Execute arbitrary instruction(s) provided as an ascii string. The string represents an integer
11079 number of instruction bytes, thus its length must be even.
11080 @end deffn
11081
11082 @subsection Xtensa Performance Monitor Configuration
11083
11084 @deffn {Command} {xtensa perfmon_enable} <counter_id> <select> [mask] [kernelcnt] [tracelevel]
11085 Enable and start performance counter.
11086 @itemize @bullet
11087 @item @code{counter_id} - Counter ID (0-1).
11088 @item @code{select} - Selects performance metric to be counted by the counter,
11089 e.g. 0 - CPU cycles, 2 - retired instructions.
11090 @item @code{mask} - Selects input subsets to be counted (counter will
11091 increment only once even if more than one condition corresponding to a mask bit occurs).
11092 @item @code{kernelcnt} - 0 - count events with "CINTLEVEL <= tracelevel",
11093 1 - count events with "CINTLEVEL > tracelevel".
11094 @item @code{tracelevel} - Compares this value to "CINTLEVEL" when deciding
11095 whether to count.
11096 @end itemize
11097 @end deffn
11098
11099 @deffn {Command} {xtensa perfmon_dump} (counter_id)
11100 Dump performance counter value. If no argument specified, dumps all counters.
11101 @end deffn
11102
11103 @subsection Xtensa Trace Configuration
11104
11105 @deffn {Command} {xtensa tracestart} [pc <pcval>/[<maskbitcount>]] [after <n> [ins|words]]
11106 Set up and start a HW trace. Optionally set PC address range to trigger tracing stop when reached during program execution.
11107 This command also allows to specify the amount of data to capture after stop trigger activation.
11108 @itemize @bullet
11109 @item @code{pcval} - PC value which will trigger trace data collection stop.
11110 @item @code{maskbitcount} - PC value mask.
11111 @item @code{n} - Maximum number of instructions/words to capture after trace stop trigger.
11112 @end itemize
11113 @end deffn
11114
11115 @deffn {Command} {xtensa tracestop}
11116 Stop current trace as started by the tracestart command.
11117 @end deffn
11118
11119 @deffn {Command} {xtensa tracedump} <outfile>
11120 Dump trace memory to a file.
11121 @end deffn
11122
11123 @anchor{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing}
11124 @section Software Debug Messages and Tracing
11125 @cindex Linux-ARM DCC support
11126 @cindex tracing
11127 @cindex libdcc
11128 @cindex DCC
11129 OpenOCD can process certain requests from target software, when
11130 the target uses appropriate libraries.
11131 The most powerful mechanism is semihosting, but there is also
11132 a lighter weight mechanism using only the DCC channel.
11133
11134 Currently @command{target_request debugmsgs}
11135 is supported only for @option{arm7_9} and @option{cortex_m} cores.
11136 These messages are received as part of target polling, so
11137 you need to have @command{poll on} active to receive them.
11138 They are intrusive in that they will affect program execution
11139 times. If that is a problem, @pxref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.
11140
11141 See @file{libdcc} in the contrib dir for more details.
11142 In addition to sending strings, characters, and
11143 arrays of various size integers from the target,
11144 @file{libdcc} also exports a software trace point mechanism.
11145 The target being debugged may
11146 issue trace messages which include a 24-bit @dfn{trace point} number.
11147 Trace point support includes two distinct mechanisms,
11148 each supported by a command:
11149
11150 @itemize
11151 @item @emph{History} ... A circular buffer of trace points
11152 can be set up, and then displayed at any time.
11153 This tracks where code has been, which can be invaluable in
11154 finding out how some fault was triggered.
11155
11156 The buffer may overflow, since it collects records continuously.
11157 It may be useful to use some of the 24 bits to represent a
11158 particular event, and other bits to hold data.
11159
11160 @item @emph{Counting} ... An array of counters can be set up,
11161 and then displayed at any time.
11162 This can help establish code coverage and identify hot spots.
11163
11164 The array of counters is directly indexed by the trace point
11165 number, so trace points with higher numbers are not counted.
11166 @end itemize
11167
11168 Linux-ARM kernels have a ``Kernel low-level debugging
11169 via EmbeddedICE DCC channel'' option (CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC,
11170 depends on CONFIG_DEBUG_LL) which uses this mechanism to
11171 deliver messages before a serial console can be activated.
11172 This is not the same format used by @file{libdcc}.
11173 Other software, such as the U-Boot boot loader, sometimes
11174 does the same thing.
11175
11176 @deffn {Command} {target_request debugmsgs} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{charmsg}]
11177 Displays current handling of target DCC message requests.
11178 These messages may be sent to the debugger while the target is running.
11179 The optional @option{enable} and @option{charmsg} parameters
11180 both enable the messages, while @option{disable} disables them.
11181
11182 With @option{charmsg} the DCC words each contain one character,
11183 as used by Linux with CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC;
11184 otherwise the libdcc format is used.
11185 @end deffn
11186
11187 @deffn {Command} {trace history} [@option{clear}|count]
11188 With no parameter, displays all the trace points that have triggered
11189 in the order they triggered.
11190 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace history records.
11191 With a @var{count} parameter, allocates space for that many
11192 history records.
11193 @end deffn
11194
11195 @deffn {Command} {trace point} [@option{clear}|identifier]
11196 With no parameter, displays all trace point identifiers and how many times
11197 they have been triggered.
11198 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace point counters.
11199 With a numeric @var{identifier} parameter, creates a new a trace point counter
11200 and associates it with that identifier.
11201
11202 @emph{Important:} The identifier and the trace point number
11203 are not related except by this command.
11204 These trace point numbers always start at zero (from server startup,
11205 or after @command{trace point clear}) and count up from there.
11206 @end deffn
11207
11208
11209 @node JTAG Commands
11210 @chapter JTAG Commands
11211 @cindex JTAG Commands
11212 Most general purpose JTAG commands have been presented earlier.
11213 (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}, @ref{Reset Configuration}, and @ref{TAP Declaration}.)
11214 Lower level JTAG commands, as presented here,
11215 may be needed to work with targets which require special
11216 attention during operations such as reset or initialization.
11217
11218 To use these commands you will need to understand some
11219 of the basics of JTAG, including:
11220
11221 @itemize @bullet
11222 @item A JTAG scan chain consists of a sequence of individual TAP
11223 devices such as a CPUs.
11224 @item Control operations involve moving each TAP through the same
11225 standard state machine (in parallel)
11226 using their shared TMS and clock signals.
11227 @item Data transfer involves shifting data through the chain of
11228 instruction or data registers of each TAP, writing new register values
11229 while the reading previous ones.
11230 @item Data register sizes are a function of the instruction active in
11231 a given TAP, while instruction register sizes are fixed for each TAP.
11232 All TAPs support a BYPASS instruction with a single bit data register.
11233 @item The way OpenOCD differentiates between TAP devices is by
11234 shifting different instructions into (and out of) their instruction
11235 registers.
11236 @end itemize
11237
11238 @section Low Level JTAG Commands
11239
11240 These commands are used by developers who need to access
11241 JTAG instruction or data registers, possibly controlling
11242 the order of TAP state transitions.
11243 If you're not debugging OpenOCD internals, or bringing up a
11244 new JTAG adapter or a new type of TAP device (like a CPU or
11245 JTAG router), you probably won't need to use these commands.
11246 In a debug session that doesn't use JTAG for its transport protocol,
11247 these commands are not available.
11248
11249 @deffn {Command} {drscan} tap [numbits value]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
11250 Loads the data register of @var{tap} with a series of bit fields
11251 that specify the entire register.
11252 Each field is @var{numbits} bits long with
11253 a numeric @var{value} (hexadecimal encouraged).
11254 The return value holds the original value of each
11255 of those fields.
11256
11257 For example, a 38 bit number might be specified as one
11258 field of 32 bits then one of 6 bits.
11259 @emph{For portability, never pass fields which are more
11260 than 32 bits long. Many OpenOCD implementations do not
11261 support 64-bit (or larger) integer values.}
11262
11263 All TAPs other than @var{tap} must be in BYPASS mode.
11264 The single bit in their data registers does not matter.
11265
11266 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
11267 in that state.
11268 For example @sc{drpause} might be specified, so that more
11269 instructions can be issued before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
11270 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
11271
11272 @quotation Warning
11273 OpenOCD does not record information about data register lengths,
11274 so @emph{it is important that you get the bit field lengths right}.
11275 Remember that different JTAG instructions refer to different
11276 data registers, which may have different lengths.
11277 Moreover, those lengths may not be fixed;
11278 the SCAN_N instruction can change the length of
11279 the register accessed by the INTEST instruction
11280 (by connecting a different scan chain).
11281 @end quotation
11282 @end deffn
11283
11284 @deffn {Command} {flush_count}
11285 Returns the number of times the JTAG queue has been flushed.
11286 This may be used for performance tuning.
11287
11288 For example, flushing a queue over USB involves a
11289 minimum latency, often several milliseconds, which does
11290 not change with the amount of data which is written.
11291 You may be able to identify performance problems by finding
11292 tasks which waste bandwidth by flushing small transfers too often,
11293 instead of batching them into larger operations.
11294 @end deffn
11295
11296 @deffn {Command} {irscan} [tap instruction]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
11297 For each @var{tap} listed, loads the instruction register
11298 with its associated numeric @var{instruction}.
11299 (The number of bits in that instruction may be displayed
11300 using the @command{scan_chain} command.)
11301 For other TAPs, a BYPASS instruction is loaded.
11302
11303 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
11304 in that state.
11305 For example @sc{irpause} might be specified, so the data register
11306 can be loaded before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
11307 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
11308
11309 @quotation Note
11310 OpenOCD currently supports only a single field for instruction
11311 register values, unlike data register values.
11312 For TAPs where the instruction register length is more than 32 bits,
11313 portable scripts currently must issue only BYPASS instructions.
11314 @end quotation
11315 @end deffn
11316
11317 @deffn {Command} {pathmove} start_state [next_state ...]
11318 Start by moving to @var{start_state}, which
11319 must be one of the @emph{stable} states.
11320 Unless it is the only state given, this will often be the
11321 current state, so that no TCK transitions are needed.
11322 Then, in a series of single state transitions
11323 (conforming to the JTAG state machine) shift to
11324 each @var{next_state} in sequence, one per TCK cycle.
11325 The final state must also be stable.
11326 @end deffn
11327
11328 @deffn {Command} {runtest} @var{num_cycles}
11329 Move to the @sc{run/idle} state, and execute at least
11330 @var{num_cycles} of the JTAG clock (TCK).
11331 Instructions often need some time
11332 to execute before they take effect.
11333 @end deffn
11334
11335 @c tms_sequence (short|long)
11336 @c ... temporary, debug-only, other than USBprog bug workaround...
11337
11338 @deffn {Command} {verify_ircapture} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
11339 Verify values captured during @sc{ircapture} and returned
11340 during IR scans. Default is enabled, but this can be
11341 overridden by @command{verify_jtag}.
11342 This flag is ignored when validating JTAG chain configuration.
11343 @end deffn
11344
11345 @deffn {Command} {verify_jtag} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
11346 Enables verification of DR and IR scans, to help detect
11347 programming errors. For IR scans, @command{verify_ircapture}
11348 must also be enabled.
11349 Default is enabled.
11350 @end deffn
11351
11352 @section TAP state names
11353 @cindex TAP state names
11354
11355 The @var{tap_state} names used by OpenOCD in the @command{drscan},
11356 @command{irscan}, and @command{pathmove} commands are the same
11357 as those used in SVF boundary scan documents, except that
11358 SVF uses @sc{idle} instead of @sc{run/idle}.
11359
11360 @itemize @bullet
11361 @item @b{RESET} ... @emph{stable} (with TMS high);
11362 acts as if TRST were pulsed
11363 @item @b{RUN/IDLE} ... @emph{stable}; don't assume this always means IDLE
11364 @item @b{DRSELECT}
11365 @item @b{DRCAPTURE}
11366 @item @b{DRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
11367 through the data register
11368 @item @b{DREXIT1}
11369 @item @b{DRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; data register ready
11370 for update or more shifting
11371 @item @b{DREXIT2}
11372 @item @b{DRUPDATE}
11373 @item @b{IRSELECT}
11374 @item @b{IRCAPTURE}
11375 @item @b{IRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
11376 through the instruction register
11377 @item @b{IREXIT1}
11378 @item @b{IRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; instruction register ready
11379 for update or more shifting
11380 @item @b{IREXIT2}
11381 @item @b{IRUPDATE}
11382 @end itemize
11383
11384 Note that only six of those states are fully ``stable'' in the
11385 face of TMS fixed (low except for @sc{reset})
11386 and a free-running JTAG clock. For all the
11387 others, the next TCK transition changes to a new state.
11388
11389 @itemize @bullet
11390 @item From @sc{drshift} and @sc{irshift}, clock transitions will
11391 produce side effects by changing register contents. The values
11392 to be latched in upcoming @sc{drupdate} or @sc{irupdate} states
11393 may not be as expected.
11394 @item @sc{run/idle}, @sc{drpause}, and @sc{irpause} are reasonable
11395 choices after @command{drscan} or @command{irscan} commands,
11396 since they are free of JTAG side effects.
11397 @item @sc{run/idle} may have side effects that appear at non-JTAG
11398 levels, such as advancing the ARM9E-S instruction pipeline.
11399 Consult the documentation for the TAP(s) you are working with.
11400 @end itemize
11401
11402 @node Boundary Scan Commands
11403 @chapter Boundary Scan Commands
11404
11405 One of the original purposes of JTAG was to support
11406 boundary scan based hardware testing.
11407 Although its primary focus is to support On-Chip Debugging,
11408 OpenOCD also includes some boundary scan commands.
11409
11410 @section SVF: Serial Vector Format
11411 @cindex Serial Vector Format
11412 @cindex SVF
11413
11414 The Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{SVF}, is a
11415 way to represent JTAG test patterns in text files.
11416 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
11417 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
11418
11419 @deffn {Command} {svf} @file{filename} [@option{-tap @var{tapname}}] [@option{[-]quiet}] @
11420 [@option{[-]nil}] [@option{[-]progress}] [@option{[-]ignore_error}]
11421 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
11422 runs the SVF script from @file{filename}.
11423
11424 Arguments can be specified in any order; the optional dash doesn't
11425 affect their semantics.
11426
11427 Command options:
11428 @itemize @minus
11429 @item @option{-tap @var{tapname}} ignore IR and DR headers and footers
11430 specified by the SVF file with HIR, TIR, HDR and TDR commands;
11431 instead, calculate them automatically according to the current JTAG
11432 chain configuration, targeting @var{tapname};
11433 @item @option{[-]quiet} do not log every command before execution;
11434 @item @option{[-]nil} ``dry run'', i.e., do not perform any operations
11435 on the real interface;
11436 @item @option{[-]progress} enable progress indication;
11437 @item @option{[-]ignore_error} continue execution despite TDO check
11438 errors.
11439 @end itemize
11440 @end deffn
11441
11442 @section XSVF: Xilinx Serial Vector Format
11443 @cindex Xilinx Serial Vector Format
11444 @cindex XSVF
11445
11446 The Xilinx Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{XSVF}, is a
11447 binary representation of SVF which is optimized for use with
11448 Xilinx devices.
11449 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
11450 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
11451
11452 @quotation Important
11453 Not all XSVF commands are supported.
11454 @end quotation
11455
11456 @deffn {Command} {xsvf} (tapname|@option{plain}) filename [@option{virt2}] [@option{quiet}]
11457 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
11458 runs the XSVF script from @file{filename}.
11459 When a @var{tapname} is specified, the commands are directed at
11460 that TAP.
11461 When @option{virt2} is specified, the @sc{xruntest} command counts
11462 are interpreted as TCK cycles instead of microseconds.
11463 Unless the @option{quiet} option is specified,
11464 messages are logged for comments and some retries.
11465 @end deffn
11466
11467 The OpenOCD sources also include two utility scripts
11468 for working with XSVF; they are not currently installed
11469 after building the software.
11470 You may find them useful:
11471
11472 @itemize
11473 @item @emph{svf2xsvf} ... converts SVF files into the extended XSVF
11474 syntax understood by the @command{xsvf} command; see notes below.
11475 @item @emph{xsvfdump} ... converts XSVF files into a text output format;
11476 understands the OpenOCD extensions.
11477 @end itemize
11478
11479 The input format accepts a handful of non-standard extensions.
11480 These include three opcodes corresponding to SVF extensions
11481 from Lattice Semiconductor (LCOUNT, LDELAY, LDSR), and
11482 two opcodes supporting a more accurate translation of SVF
11483 (XTRST, XWAITSTATE).
11484 If @emph{xsvfdump} shows a file is using those opcodes, it
11485 probably will not be usable with other XSVF tools.
11486
11487
11488 @section IPDBG: JTAG-Host server
11489 @cindex IPDBG JTAG-Host server
11490 @cindex IPDBG
11491
11492 IPDBG is a set of tools to debug IP-Cores. It comprises, among others, a logic analyzer and an arbitrary
11493 waveform generator. These are synthesize-able hardware descriptions of
11494 logic circuits in addition to software for control, visualization and further analysis.
11495 In a session using JTAG for its transport protocol, OpenOCD supports the function
11496 of a JTAG-Host. The JTAG-Host is needed to connect the circuit over JTAG to the
11497 control-software. For more details see @url{http://ipdbg.org}.
11498
11499 @deffn {Command} {ipdbg} [@option{-start|-stop}] @option{-tap @var{tapname}} @option{-hub @var{ir_value} [@var{dr_length}]} [@option{-port @var{number}}] [@option{-tool @var{number}}] [@option{-vir [@var{vir_value} [@var{length} [@var{instr_code}]]]}]
11500 Starts or stops a IPDBG JTAG-Host server. Arguments can be specified in any order.
11501
11502 Command options:
11503 @itemize @bullet
11504 @item @option{-start|-stop} starts or stops a IPDBG JTAG-Host server (default: start).
11505 @item @option{-tap @var{tapname}} targeting the TAP @var{tapname}.
11506 @item @option{-hub @var{ir_value}} states that the JTAG hub is
11507 reachable with dr-scans while the JTAG instruction register has the value @var{ir_value}.
11508 @item @option{-port @var{number}} tcp port number where the JTAG-Host is listening.
11509 @item @option{-tool @var{number}} number of the tool/feature. These corresponds to the ports "data_(up/down)_(0..6)" at the JtagHub.
11510 @item @option{-vir [@var{vir_value} [@var{length} [@var{instr_code}]]]} On some devices, the user data-register is only reachable if there is a
11511 specific value in a second dr. This second dr is called vir (virtual ir). With this parameter given, the IPDBG satisfies this condition prior an
11512 access to the IPDBG-Hub. The value shifted into the vir is given by the first parameter @var{vir_value} (default: 0x11). The second
11513 parameter @var{length} is the length of the vir data register (default: 5). With the @var{instr_code} (default: 0x00e) parameter the ir value to
11514 shift data through vir can be configured.
11515 @end itemize
11516 @end deffn
11517
11518 Examples:
11519 @example
11520 ipdbg -start -tap xc6s.tap -hub 0x02 -port 4242 -tool 4
11521 @end example
11522 Starts a server listening on tcp-port 4242 which connects to tool 4.
11523 The connection is through the TAP of a Xilinx Spartan 6 on USER1 instruction (tested with a papillion pro board).
11524
11525 @example
11526 ipdbg -start -tap 10m50.tap -hub 0x00C -vir -port 60000 -tool 1
11527 @end example
11528 Starts a server listening on tcp-port 60000 which connects to tool 1 (data_up_1/data_down_1).
11529 The connection is through the TAP of a Intel MAX10 virtual jtag component (sld_instance_index is 0; sld_ir_width is smaller than 5).
11530
11531 @node Utility Commands
11532 @chapter Utility Commands
11533 @cindex Utility Commands
11534
11535 @section RAM testing
11536 @cindex RAM testing
11537
11538 There is often a need to stress-test random access memory (RAM) for
11539 errors. OpenOCD comes with a Tcl implementation of well-known memory
11540 testing procedures allowing the detection of all sorts of issues with
11541 electrical wiring, defective chips, PCB layout and other common
11542 hardware problems.
11543
11544 To use them, you usually need to initialise your RAM controller first;
11545 consult your SoC's documentation to get the recommended list of
11546 register operations and translate them to the corresponding
11547 @command{mww}/@command{mwb} commands.
11548
11549 Load the memory testing functions with
11550
11551 @example
11552 source [find tools/memtest.tcl]
11553 @end example
11554
11555 to get access to the following facilities:
11556
11557 @deffn {Command} {memTestDataBus} address
11558 Test the data bus wiring in a memory region by performing a walking
11559 1's test at a fixed address within that region.
11560 @end deffn
11561
11562 @deffn {Command} {memTestAddressBus} baseaddress size
11563 Perform a walking 1's test on the relevant bits of the address and
11564 check for aliasing. This test will find single-bit address failures
11565 such as stuck-high, stuck-low, and shorted pins.
11566 @end deffn
11567
11568 @deffn {Command} {memTestDevice} baseaddress size
11569 Test the integrity of a physical memory device by performing an
11570 increment/decrement test over the entire region. In the process every
11571 storage bit in the device is tested as zero and as one.
11572 @end deffn
11573
11574 @deffn {Command} {runAllMemTests} baseaddress size
11575 Run all of the above tests over a specified memory region.
11576 @end deffn
11577
11578 @section Firmware recovery helpers
11579 @cindex Firmware recovery
11580
11581 OpenOCD includes an easy-to-use script to facilitate mass-market
11582 devices recovery with JTAG.
11583
11584 For quickstart instructions run:
11585 @example
11586 openocd -f tools/firmware-recovery.tcl -c firmware_help
11587 @end example
11588
11589 @node GDB and OpenOCD
11590 @chapter GDB and OpenOCD
11591 @cindex GDB
11592 OpenOCD complies with the remote gdbserver protocol and, as such, can be used
11593 to debug remote targets.
11594 Setting up GDB to work with OpenOCD can involve several components:
11595
11596 @itemize
11597 @item The OpenOCD server support for GDB may need to be configured.
11598 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
11599 @item GDB's support for OpenOCD may need configuration,
11600 as shown in this chapter.
11601 @item If you have a GUI environment like Eclipse,
11602 that also will probably need to be configured.
11603 @end itemize
11604
11605 Of course, the version of GDB you use will need to be one which has
11606 been built to know about the target CPU you're using. It's probably
11607 part of the tool chain you're using. For example, if you are doing
11608 cross-development for ARM on an x86 PC, instead of using the native
11609 x86 @command{gdb} command you might use @command{arm-none-eabi-gdb}
11610 if that's the tool chain used to compile your code.
11611
11612 @section Connecting to GDB
11613 @cindex Connecting to GDB
11614 Use GDB 6.7 or newer with OpenOCD if you run into trouble. For
11615 instance GDB 6.3 has a known bug that produces bogus memory access
11616 errors, which has since been fixed; see
11617 @url{http://osdir.com/ml/gdb.bugs.discuss/2004-12/msg00018.html}
11618
11619 OpenOCD can communicate with GDB in two ways:
11620
11621 @enumerate
11622 @item
11623 A socket (TCP/IP) connection is typically started as follows:
11624 @example
11625 target extended-remote localhost:3333
11626 @end example
11627 This would cause GDB to connect to the gdbserver on the local pc using port 3333.
11628
11629 The extended remote protocol is a super-set of the remote protocol and should
11630 be the preferred choice. More details are available in GDB documentation
11631 @url{https://sourceware.org/gdb/onlinedocs/gdb/Connecting.html}
11632
11633 To speed-up typing, any GDB command can be abbreviated, including the extended
11634 remote command above that becomes:
11635 @example
11636 tar ext :3333
11637 @end example
11638
11639 @b{Note:} If any backward compatibility issue requires using the old remote
11640 protocol in place of the extended remote one, the former protocol is still
11641 available through the command:
11642 @example
11643 target remote localhost:3333
11644 @end example
11645
11646 @item
11647 A pipe connection is typically started as follows:
11648 @example
11649 target extended-remote | \
11650 openocd -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log"
11651 @end example
11652 This would cause GDB to run OpenOCD and communicate using pipes (stdin/stdout).
11653 Using this method has the advantage of GDB starting/stopping OpenOCD for the debug
11654 session. log_output sends the log output to a file to ensure that the pipe is
11655 not saturated when using higher debug level outputs.
11656 @end enumerate
11657
11658 To list the available OpenOCD commands type @command{monitor help} on the
11659 GDB command line.
11660
11661 @section Sample GDB session startup
11662
11663 With the remote protocol, GDB sessions start a little differently
11664 than they do when you're debugging locally.
11665 Here's an example showing how to start a debug session with a
11666 small ARM program.
11667 In this case the program was linked to be loaded into SRAM on a Cortex-M3.
11668 Most programs would be written into flash (address 0) and run from there.
11669
11670 @example
11671 $ arm-none-eabi-gdb example.elf
11672 (gdb) target extended-remote localhost:3333
11673 Remote debugging using localhost:3333
11674 ...
11675 (gdb) monitor reset halt
11676 ...
11677 (gdb) load
11678 Loading section .vectors, size 0x100 lma 0x20000000
11679 Loading section .text, size 0x5a0 lma 0x20000100
11680 Loading section .data, size 0x18 lma 0x200006a0
11681 Start address 0x2000061c, load size 1720
11682 Transfer rate: 22 KB/sec, 573 bytes/write.
11683 (gdb) continue
11684 Continuing.
11685 ...
11686 @end example
11687
11688 You could then interrupt the GDB session to make the program break,
11689 type @command{where} to show the stack, @command{list} to show the
11690 code around the program counter, @command{step} through code,
11691 set breakpoints or watchpoints, and so on.
11692
11693 @section Configuring GDB for OpenOCD
11694
11695 OpenOCD supports the gdb @option{qSupported} packet, this enables information
11696 to be sent by the GDB remote server (i.e. OpenOCD) to GDB. Typical information includes
11697 packet size and the device's memory map.
11698 You do not need to configure the packet size by hand,
11699 and the relevant parts of the memory map should be automatically
11700 set up when you declare (NOR) flash banks.
11701
11702 However, there are other things which GDB can't currently query.
11703 You may need to set those up by hand.
11704 As OpenOCD starts up, you will often see a line reporting
11705 something like:
11706
11707 @example
11708 Info : lm3s.cpu: hardware has 6 breakpoints, 4 watchpoints
11709 @end example
11710
11711 You can pass that information to GDB with these commands:
11712
11713 @example
11714 set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit 6
11715 set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit 4
11716 @end example
11717
11718 With that particular hardware (Cortex-M3) the hardware breakpoints
11719 only work for code running from flash memory. Most other ARM systems
11720 do not have such restrictions.
11721
11722 Rather than typing such commands interactively, you may prefer to
11723 save them in a file and have GDB execute them as it starts, perhaps
11724 using a @file{.gdbinit} in your project directory or starting GDB
11725 using @command{gdb -x filename}.
11726
11727 @section Programming using GDB
11728 @cindex Programming using GDB
11729 @anchor{programmingusinggdb}
11730
11731 By default the target memory map is sent to GDB. This can be disabled by
11732 the following OpenOCD configuration option:
11733 @example
11734 gdb_memory_map disable
11735 @end example
11736 For this to function correctly a valid flash configuration must also be set
11737 in OpenOCD. For faster performance you should also configure a valid
11738 working area.
11739
11740 Informing GDB of the memory map of the target will enable GDB to protect any
11741 flash areas of the target and use hardware breakpoints by default. This means
11742 that the OpenOCD option @command{gdb_breakpoint_override} is not required when
11743 using a memory map. @xref{gdbbreakpointoverride,,gdb_breakpoint_override}.
11744
11745 To view the configured memory map in GDB, use the GDB command @option{info mem}.
11746 All other unassigned addresses within GDB are treated as RAM.
11747
11748 GDB 6.8 and higher set any memory area not in the memory map as inaccessible.
11749 This can be changed to the old behaviour by using the following GDB command
11750 @example
11751 set mem inaccessible-by-default off
11752 @end example
11753
11754 If @command{gdb_flash_program enable} is also used, GDB will be able to
11755 program any flash memory using the vFlash interface.
11756
11757 GDB will look at the target memory map when a load command is given, if any
11758 areas to be programmed lie within the target flash area the vFlash packets
11759 will be used.
11760
11761 If the target needs configuring before GDB programming, set target
11762 event gdb-flash-erase-start:
11763 @example
11764 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-flash-erase-start BODY
11765 @end example
11766 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, for other GDB programming related events.
11767
11768 To verify any flash programming the GDB command @option{compare-sections}
11769 can be used.
11770
11771 @section Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
11772 @cindex Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
11773 @anchor{gdbmeminspect}
11774
11775 If your project controls more than a blinking LED, let's say a heavy industrial
11776 robot or an experimental nuclear reactor, stopping the controlling process
11777 just because you want to attach GDB is not a good option.
11778
11779 OpenOCD does not support GDB non-stop mode (might be implemented in the future).
11780 Though there is a possible setup where the target does not get stopped
11781 and GDB treats it as it were running.
11782 If the target supports background access to memory while it is running,
11783 you can use GDB in this mode to inspect memory (mainly global variables)
11784 without any intrusion of the target process.
11785
11786 Remove default setting of gdb-attach event. @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
11787 Place following command after target configuration:
11788 @example
11789 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-attach @{@}
11790 @end example
11791
11792 If any of installed flash banks does not support probe on running target,
11793 switch off gdb_memory_map:
11794 @example
11795 gdb_memory_map disable
11796 @end example
11797
11798 Ensure GDB is configured without interrupt-on-connect.
11799 Some GDB versions set it by default, some does not.
11800 @example
11801 set remote interrupt-on-connect off
11802 @end example
11803
11804 If you switched gdb_memory_map off, you may want to setup GDB memory map
11805 manually or issue @command{set mem inaccessible-by-default off}
11806
11807 Now you can issue GDB command @command{target extended-remote ...} and inspect memory
11808 of a running target. Do not use GDB commands @command{continue},
11809 @command{step} or @command{next} as they synchronize GDB with your target
11810 and GDB would require stopping the target to get the prompt back.
11811
11812 Do not use this mode under an IDE like Eclipse as it caches values of
11813 previously shown variables.
11814
11815 It's also possible to connect more than one GDB to the same target by the
11816 target's configuration option @code{-gdb-max-connections}. This allows, for
11817 example, one GDB to run a script that continuously polls a set of variables
11818 while other GDB can be used interactively. Be extremely careful in this case,
11819 because the two GDB can easily get out-of-sync.
11820
11821 @section RTOS Support
11822 @cindex RTOS Support
11823 @anchor{gdbrtossupport}
11824
11825 OpenOCD includes RTOS support, this will however need enabling as it defaults to disabled.
11826 It can be enabled by passing @option{-rtos} arg to the target. @xref{rtostype,,RTOS Type}.
11827
11828 @xref{Threads, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads,
11829 Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads, gdb, GDB manual}, for details about relevant
11830 GDB commands.
11831
11832 @* An example setup is below:
11833
11834 @example
11835 $_TARGETNAME configure -rtos auto
11836 @end example
11837
11838 This will attempt to auto detect the RTOS within your application.
11839
11840 Currently supported rtos's include:
11841 @itemize @bullet
11842 @item @option{eCos}
11843 @item @option{ThreadX}
11844 @item @option{FreeRTOS}
11845 @item @option{linux}
11846 @item @option{ChibiOS}
11847 @item @option{embKernel}
11848 @item @option{mqx}
11849 @item @option{uCOS-III}
11850 @item @option{nuttx}
11851 @item @option{RIOT}
11852 @item @option{hwthread} (This is not an actual RTOS. @xref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.)
11853 @item @option{Zephyr}
11854 @end itemize
11855
11856 At any time, it's possible to drop the selected RTOS using:
11857 @example
11858 $_TARGETNAME configure -rtos none
11859 @end example
11860
11861 Before an RTOS can be detected, it must export certain symbols; otherwise, it cannot
11862 be used by OpenOCD. Below is a list of the required symbols for each supported RTOS.
11863
11864 @table @code
11865 @item eCos symbols
11866 Cyg_Thread::thread_list, Cyg_Scheduler_Base::current_thread.
11867 @item ThreadX symbols
11868 _tx_thread_current_ptr, _tx_thread_created_ptr, _tx_thread_created_count.
11869 @item FreeRTOS symbols
11870 @raggedright
11871 pxCurrentTCB, pxReadyTasksLists, xDelayedTaskList1, xDelayedTaskList2,
11872 pxDelayedTaskList, pxOverflowDelayedTaskList, xPendingReadyList,
11873 uxCurrentNumberOfTasks, uxTopUsedPriority.
11874 @end raggedright
11875 @item linux symbols
11876 init_task.
11877 @item ChibiOS symbols
11878 rlist, ch_debug, chSysInit.
11879 @item embKernel symbols
11880 Rtos::sCurrentTask, Rtos::sListReady, Rtos::sListSleep,
11881 Rtos::sListSuspended, Rtos::sMaxPriorities, Rtos::sCurrentTaskCount.
11882 @item mqx symbols
11883 _mqx_kernel_data, MQX_init_struct.
11884 @item uC/OS-III symbols
11885 OSRunning, OSTCBCurPtr, OSTaskDbgListPtr, OSTaskQty.
11886 @item nuttx symbols
11887 g_readytorun, g_tasklisttable.
11888 @item RIOT symbols
11889 @raggedright
11890 sched_threads, sched_num_threads, sched_active_pid, max_threads,
11891 _tcb_name_offset.
11892 @end raggedright
11893 @item Zephyr symbols
11894 _kernel, _kernel_openocd_offsets, _kernel_openocd_size_t_size
11895 @end table
11896
11897 For most RTOS supported the above symbols will be exported by default. However for
11898 some, eg. FreeRTOS, uC/OS-III and Zephyr, extra steps must be taken.
11899
11900 Zephyr must be compiled with the DEBUG_THREAD_INFO option. This will generate some symbols
11901 with information needed in order to build the list of threads.
11902
11903 FreeRTOS and uC/OS-III RTOSes may require additional OpenOCD-specific file to be linked
11904 along with the project:
11905
11906 @table @code
11907 @item FreeRTOS
11908 contrib/rtos-helpers/FreeRTOS-openocd.c
11909 @item uC/OS-III
11910 contrib/rtos-helpers/uCOS-III-openocd.c
11911 @end table
11912
11913 @anchor{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb}
11914 @section Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB
11915 @cindex SMP
11916 @cindex RTOS
11917 @cindex hwthread
11918 OpenOCD includes a pseudo RTOS called @emph{hwthread} that presents CPU cores
11919 ("hardware threads") in an SMP system as threads to GDB. With this extension,
11920 GDB can be used to inspect the state of an SMP system in a natural way.
11921 After halting the system, using the GDB command @command{info threads} will
11922 list the context of each active CPU core in the system. GDB's @command{thread}
11923 command can be used to switch the view to a different CPU core.
11924 The @command{step} and @command{stepi} commands can be used to step a specific core
11925 while other cores are free-running or remain halted, depending on the
11926 scheduler-locking mode configured in GDB.
11927
11928 @node Tcl Scripting API
11929 @chapter Tcl Scripting API
11930 @cindex Tcl Scripting API
11931 @cindex Tcl scripts
11932 @section API rules
11933
11934 Tcl commands are stateless; e.g. the @command{telnet} command has
11935 a concept of currently active target, the Tcl API proc's take this sort
11936 of state information as an argument to each proc.
11937
11938 There are three main types of return values: single value, name value
11939 pair list and lists.
11940
11941 Name value pair. The proc 'foo' below returns a name/value pair
11942 list.
11943
11944 @example
11945 > set foo(me) Duane
11946 > set foo(you) Oyvind
11947 > set foo(mouse) Micky
11948 > set foo(duck) Donald
11949 @end example
11950
11951 If one does this:
11952
11953 @example
11954 > set foo
11955 @end example
11956
11957 The result is:
11958
11959 @example
11960 me Duane you Oyvind mouse Micky duck Donald
11961 @end example
11962
11963 Thus, to get the names of the associative array is easy:
11964
11965 @verbatim
11966 foreach { name value } [set foo] {
11967 puts "Name: $name, Value: $value"
11968 }
11969 @end verbatim
11970
11971 Lists returned should be relatively small. Otherwise, a range
11972 should be passed in to the proc in question.
11973
11974 @section Internal low-level Commands
11975
11976 By "low-level", we mean commands that a human would typically not
11977 invoke directly.
11978
11979 @itemize
11980 @item @b{flash banks} <@var{driver}> <@var{base}> <@var{size}> <@var{chip_width}> <@var{bus_width}> <@var{target}> [@option{driver options} ...]
11981
11982 Return information about the flash banks
11983
11984 @item @b{capture} <@var{command}>
11985
11986 Run <@var{command}> and return full log output that was produced during
11987 its execution. Example:
11988
11989 @example
11990 > capture "reset init"
11991 @end example
11992
11993 @end itemize
11994
11995 OpenOCD commands can consist of two words, e.g. "flash banks". The
11996 @file{startup.tcl} "unknown" proc will translate this into a Tcl proc
11997 called "flash_banks".
11998
11999 @section Tcl RPC server
12000 @cindex RPC
12001
12002 OpenOCD provides a simple RPC server that allows to run arbitrary Tcl
12003 commands and receive the results.
12004
12005 To access it, your application needs to connect to a configured TCP port
12006 (see @command{tcl_port}). Then it can pass any string to the
12007 interpreter terminating it with @code{0x1a} and wait for the return
12008 value (it will be terminated with @code{0x1a} as well). This can be
12009 repeated as many times as desired without reopening the connection.
12010
12011 It is not needed anymore to prefix the OpenOCD commands with
12012 @code{ocd_} to get the results back. But sometimes you might need the
12013 @command{capture} command.
12014
12015 See @file{contrib/rpc_examples/} for specific client implementations.
12016
12017 @section Tcl RPC server notifications
12018 @cindex RPC Notifications
12019
12020 Notifications are sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
12021 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
12022
12023 Target event, state and reset notifications are emitted as Tcl associative arrays
12024 in the following format.
12025
12026 @verbatim
12027 type target_event event [event-name]
12028 type target_state state [state-name]
12029 type target_reset mode [reset-mode]
12030 @end verbatim
12031
12032 @deffn {Command} {tcl_notifications} [on/off]
12033 Toggle output of target notifications to the current Tcl RPC server.
12034 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
12035 Defaults to off.
12036
12037 @end deffn
12038
12039 @section Tcl RPC server trace output
12040 @cindex RPC trace output
12041
12042 Trace data is sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
12043 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
12044
12045 Target trace data is emitted as a Tcl associative array in the following format.
12046
12047 @verbatim
12048 type target_trace data [trace-data-hex-encoded]
12049 @end verbatim
12050
12051 @deffn {Command} {tcl_trace} [on/off]
12052 Toggle output of target trace data to the current Tcl RPC server.
12053 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
12054 Defaults to off.
12055
12056 See an example application here:
12057 @url{https://github.com/apmorton/OpenOcdTraceUtil} [OpenOcdTraceUtil]
12058
12059 @end deffn
12060
12061 @node FAQ
12062 @chapter FAQ
12063 @cindex faq
12064 @enumerate
12065 @anchor{faqrtck}
12066 @item @b{RTCK, also known as: Adaptive Clocking - What is it?}
12067 @cindex RTCK
12068 @cindex adaptive clocking
12069 @*
12070
12071 In digital circuit design it is often referred to as ``clock
12072 synchronisation'' the JTAG interface uses one clock (TCK or TCLK)
12073 operating at some speed, your CPU target is operating at another.
12074 The two clocks are not synchronised, they are ``asynchronous''
12075
12076 In order for the two to work together they must be synchronised
12077 well enough to work; JTAG can't go ten times faster than the CPU,
12078 for example. There are 2 basic options:
12079 @enumerate
12080 @item
12081 Use a special "adaptive clocking" circuit to change the JTAG
12082 clock rate to match what the CPU currently supports.
12083 @item
12084 The JTAG clock must be fixed at some speed that's enough slower than
12085 the CPU clock that all TMS and TDI transitions can be detected.
12086 @end enumerate
12087
12088 @b{Does this really matter?} For some chips and some situations, this
12089 is a non-issue, like a 500MHz ARM926 with a 5 MHz JTAG link;
12090 the CPU has no difficulty keeping up with JTAG.
12091 Startup sequences are often problematic though, as are other
12092 situations where the CPU clock rate changes (perhaps to save
12093 power).
12094
12095 For example, Atmel AT91SAM chips start operation from reset with
12096 a 32kHz system clock. Boot firmware may activate the main oscillator
12097 and PLL before switching to a faster clock (perhaps that 500 MHz
12098 ARM926 scenario).
12099 If you're using JTAG to debug that startup sequence, you must slow
12100 the JTAG clock to sometimes 1 to 4kHz. After startup completes,
12101 JTAG can use a faster clock.
12102
12103 Consider also debugging a 500MHz ARM926 hand held battery powered
12104 device that enters a low power ``deep sleep'' mode, at 32kHz CPU
12105 clock, between keystrokes unless it has work to do. When would
12106 that 5 MHz JTAG clock be usable?
12107
12108 @b{Solution #1 - A special circuit}
12109
12110 In order to make use of this,
12111 your CPU, board, and JTAG adapter must all support the RTCK
12112 feature. Not all of them support this; keep reading!
12113
12114 The RTCK ("Return TCK") signal in some ARM chips is used to help with
12115 this problem. ARM has a good description of the problem described at
12116 this link: @url{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} [checked
12117 28/nov/2008]. Link title: ``How does the JTAG synchronisation logic
12118 work? / how does adaptive clocking work?''.
12119
12120 The nice thing about adaptive clocking is that ``battery powered hand
12121 held device example'' - the adaptiveness works perfectly all the
12122 time. One can set a break point or halt the system in the deep power
12123 down code, slow step out until the system speeds up.
12124
12125 Note that adaptive clocking may also need to work at the board level,
12126 when a board-level scan chain has multiple chips.
12127 Parallel clock voting schemes are good way to implement this,
12128 both within and between chips, and can easily be implemented
12129 with a CPLD.
12130 It's not difficult to have logic fan a module's input TCK signal out
12131 to each TAP in the scan chain, and then wait until each TAP's RTCK comes
12132 back with the right polarity before changing the output RTCK signal.
12133 Texas Instruments makes some clock voting logic available
12134 for free (with no support) in VHDL form; see
12135 @url{http://tiexpressdsp.com/index.php/Adaptive_Clocking}
12136
12137 @b{Solution #2 - Always works - but may be slower}
12138
12139 Often this is a perfectly acceptable solution.
12140
12141 In most simple terms: Often the JTAG clock must be 1/10 to 1/12 of
12142 the target clock speed. But what that ``magic division'' is varies
12143 depending on the chips on your board.
12144 @b{ARM rule of thumb} Most ARM based systems require an 6:1 division;
12145 ARM11 cores use an 8:1 division.
12146 @b{Xilinx rule of thumb} is 1/12 the clock speed.
12147
12148 Note: most full speed FT2232 based JTAG adapters are limited to a
12149 maximum of 6MHz. The ones using USB high speed chips (FT2232H)
12150 often support faster clock rates (and adaptive clocking).
12151
12152 You can still debug the 'low power' situations - you just need to
12153 either use a fixed and very slow JTAG clock rate ... or else
12154 manually adjust the clock speed at every step. (Adjusting is painful
12155 and tedious, and is not always practical.)
12156
12157 It is however easy to ``code your way around it'' - i.e.: Cheat a little,
12158 have a special debug mode in your application that does a ``high power
12159 sleep''. If you are careful - 98% of your problems can be debugged
12160 this way.
12161
12162 Note that on ARM you may need to avoid using the @emph{wait for interrupt}
12163 operation in your idle loops even if you don't otherwise change the CPU
12164 clock rate.
12165 That operation gates the CPU clock, and thus the JTAG clock; which
12166 prevents JTAG access. One consequence is not being able to @command{halt}
12167 cores which are executing that @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
12168
12169 To set the JTAG frequency use the command:
12170
12171 @example
12172 # Example: 1.234MHz
12173 adapter speed 1234
12174 @end example
12175
12176
12177 @item @b{Win32 Pathnames} Why don't backslashes work in Windows paths?
12178
12179 OpenOCD uses Tcl and a backslash is an escape char. Use @{ and @}
12180 around Windows filenames.
12181
12182 @example
12183 > echo \a
12184
12185 > echo @{\a@}
12186 \a
12187 > echo "\a"
12188
12189 >
12190 @end example
12191
12192
12193 @item @b{Missing: cygwin1.dll} OpenOCD complains about a missing cygwin1.dll.
12194
12195 Make sure you have Cygwin installed, or at least a version of OpenOCD that
12196 claims to come with all the necessary DLLs. When using Cygwin, try launching
12197 OpenOCD from the Cygwin shell.
12198
12199 @item @b{Breakpoint Issue} I'm trying to set a breakpoint using GDB (or a front-end like Insight or
12200 Eclipse), but OpenOCD complains that "Info: arm7_9_common.c:213
12201 arm7_9_add_breakpoint(): sw breakpoint requested, but software breakpoints not enabled".
12202
12203 GDB issues software breakpoints when a normal breakpoint is requested, or to implement
12204 source-line single-stepping. On ARMv4T systems, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T or ARM920T,
12205 software breakpoints consume one of the two available hardware breakpoints.
12206
12207 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} When erasing or writing LPC2000 on-chip flash, the operation fails at random.
12208
12209 Make sure the core frequency specified in the @option{flash lpc2000} line matches the
12210 clock at the time you're programming the flash. If you've specified the crystal's
12211 frequency, make sure the PLL is disabled. If you've specified the full core speed
12212 (e.g. 60MHz), make sure the PLL is enabled.
12213
12214 @item @b{Amontec Chameleon} When debugging using an Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
12215 I keep getting "Error: amt_jtagaccel.c:184 amt_wait_scan_busy(): amt_jtagaccel timed
12216 out while waiting for end of scan, rtck was disabled".
12217
12218 Make sure your PC's parallel port operates in EPP mode. You might have to try several
12219 settings in your PC BIOS (ECP, EPP, and different versions of those).
12220
12221 @item @b{Data Aborts} When debugging with OpenOCD and GDB (plain GDB, Insight, or Eclipse),
12222 I get lots of "Error: arm7_9_common.c:1771 arm7_9_read_memory():
12223 memory read caused data abort".
12224
12225 The errors are non-fatal, and are the result of GDB trying to trace stack frames
12226 beyond the last valid frame. It might be possible to prevent this by setting up
12227 a proper "initial" stack frame, if you happen to know what exactly has to
12228 be done, feel free to add this here.
12229
12230 @b{Simple:} In your startup code - push 8 registers of zeros onto the
12231 stack before calling main(). What GDB is doing is ``climbing'' the run
12232 time stack by reading various values on the stack using the standard
12233 call frame for the target. GDB keeps going - until one of 2 things
12234 happen @b{#1} an invalid frame is found, or @b{#2} some huge number of
12235 stackframes have been processed. By pushing zeros on the stack, GDB
12236 gracefully stops.
12237
12238 @b{Debugging Interrupt Service Routines} - In your ISR before you call
12239 your C code, do the same - artificially push some zeros onto the stack,
12240 remember to pop them off when the ISR is done.
12241
12242 @b{Also note:} If you have a multi-threaded operating system, they
12243 often do not @b{in the interest of saving memory} waste these few
12244 bytes. Painful...
12245
12246
12247 @item @b{JTAG Reset Config} I get the following message in the OpenOCD console (or log file):
12248 "Warning: arm7_9_common.c:679 arm7_9_assert_reset(): srst resets test logic, too".
12249
12250 This warning doesn't indicate any serious problem, as long as you don't want to
12251 debug your core right out of reset. Your .cfg file specified @option{reset_config
12252 trst_and_srst srst_pulls_trst} to tell OpenOCD that either your board,
12253 your debugger or your target uC (e.g. LPC2000) can't assert the two reset signals
12254 independently. With this setup, it's not possible to halt the core right out of
12255 reset, everything else should work fine.
12256
12257 @item @b{USB Power} When using OpenOCD in conjunction with Amontec JTAGkey and the Yagarto
12258 toolchain (Eclipse, arm-elf-gcc, arm-elf-gdb), the debugging seems to be
12259 unstable. When single-stepping over large blocks of code, GDB and OpenOCD
12260 quit with an error message. Is there a stability issue with OpenOCD?
12261
12262 No, this is not a stability issue concerning OpenOCD. Most users have solved
12263 this issue by simply using a self-powered USB hub, which they connect their
12264 Amontec JTAGkey to. Apparently, some computers do not provide a USB power
12265 supply stable enough for the Amontec JTAGkey to be operated.
12266
12267 @b{Laptops running on battery have this problem too...}
12268
12269 @item @b{GDB Disconnects} When using the Amontec JTAGkey, sometimes OpenOCD crashes with the following
12270 error message: "Error: gdb_server.c:101 gdb_get_char(): read: 10054".
12271 What does that mean and what might be the reason for this?
12272
12273 Error code 10054 corresponds to WSAECONNRESET, which means that the debugger (GDB)
12274 has closed the connection to OpenOCD. This might be a GDB issue.
12275
12276 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} In the configuration file in the section where flash device configurations
12277 are described, there is a parameter for specifying the clock frequency
12278 for LPC2000 internal flash devices (e.g. @option{flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000
12279 0x0 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME lpc2000_v1 14746 calc_checksum}), which must be
12280 specified in kilohertz. However, I do have a quartz crystal of a
12281 frequency that contains fractions of kilohertz (e.g. 14,745,600 Hz,
12282 i.e. 14,745.600 kHz). Is it possible to specify real numbers for the
12283 clock frequency?
12284
12285 No. The clock frequency specified here must be given as an integral number.
12286 However, this clock frequency is used by the In-Application-Programming (IAP)
12287 routines of the LPC2000 family only, which seems to be very tolerant concerning
12288 the given clock frequency, so a slight difference between the specified clock
12289 frequency and the actual clock frequency will not cause any trouble.
12290
12291 @item @b{Command Order} Do I have to keep a specific order for the commands in the configuration file?
12292
12293 Well, yes and no. Commands can be given in arbitrary order, yet the
12294 devices listed for the JTAG scan chain must be given in the right
12295 order (jtag newdevice), with the device closest to the TDO-Pin being
12296 listed first. In general, whenever objects of the same type exist
12297 which require an index number, then these objects must be given in the
12298 right order (jtag newtap, targets and flash banks - a target
12299 references a jtag newtap and a flash bank references a target).
12300
12301 You can use the ``scan_chain'' command to verify and display the tap order.
12302
12303 Also, some commands can't execute until after @command{init} has been
12304 processed. Such commands include @command{nand probe} and everything
12305 else that needs to write to controller registers, perhaps for setting
12306 up DRAM and loading it with code.
12307
12308 @anchor{faqtaporder}
12309 @item @b{JTAG TAP Order} Do I have to declare the TAPS in some
12310 particular order?
12311
12312 Yes; whenever you have more than one, you must declare them in
12313 the same order used by the hardware.
12314
12315 Many newer devices have multiple JTAG TAPs. For example:
12316 STMicroelectronics STM32 chips have two TAPs, a ``boundary scan TAP'' and
12317 ``Cortex-M3'' TAP. Example: The STM32 reference manual, Document ID:
12318 RM0008, Section 26.5, Figure 259, page 651/681, the ``TDI'' pin is
12319 connected to the boundary scan TAP, which then connects to the
12320 Cortex-M3 TAP, which then connects to the TDO pin.
12321
12322 Thus, the proper order for the STM32 chip is: (1) The Cortex-M3, then
12323 (2) The boundary scan TAP. If your board includes an additional JTAG
12324 chip in the scan chain (for example a Xilinx CPLD or FPGA) you could
12325 place it before or after the STM32 chip in the chain. For example:
12326
12327 @itemize @bullet
12328 @item OpenOCD_TDI(output) -> STM32 TDI Pin (BS Input)
12329 @item STM32 BS TDO (output) -> STM32 Cortex-M3 TDI (input)
12330 @item STM32 Cortex-M3 TDO (output) -> SM32 TDO Pin
12331 @item STM32 TDO Pin (output) -> Xilinx TDI Pin (input)
12332 @item Xilinx TDO Pin -> OpenOCD TDO (input)
12333 @end itemize
12334
12335 The ``jtag device'' commands would thus be in the order shown below. Note:
12336
12337 @itemize @bullet
12338 @item jtag newtap Xilinx tap -irlen ...
12339 @item jtag newtap stm32 cpu -irlen ...
12340 @item jtag newtap stm32 bs -irlen ...
12341 @item # Create the debug target and say where it is
12342 @item target create stm32.cpu -chain-position stm32.cpu ...
12343 @end itemize
12344
12345
12346 @item @b{SYSCOMP} Sometimes my debugging session terminates with an error. When I look into the
12347 log file, I can see these error messages: Error: arm7_9_common.c:561
12348 arm7_9_execute_sys_speed(): timeout waiting for SYSCOMP
12349
12350 TODO.
12351
12352 @end enumerate
12353
12354 @node Tcl Crash Course
12355 @chapter Tcl Crash Course
12356 @cindex Tcl
12357
12358 Not everyone knows Tcl - this is not intended to be a replacement for
12359 learning Tcl, the intent of this chapter is to give you some idea of
12360 how the Tcl scripts work.
12361
12362 This chapter is written with two audiences in mind. (1) OpenOCD users
12363 who need to understand a bit more of how Jim-Tcl works so they can do
12364 something useful, and (2) those that want to add a new command to
12365 OpenOCD.
12366
12367 @section Tcl Rule #1
12368 There is a famous joke, it goes like this:
12369 @enumerate
12370 @item Rule #1: The wife is always correct
12371 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
12372 @end enumerate
12373
12374 The Tcl equal is this:
12375
12376 @enumerate
12377 @item Rule #1: Everything is a string
12378 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
12379 @end enumerate
12380
12381 As in the famous joke, the consequences of Rule #1 are profound. Once
12382 you understand Rule #1, you will understand Tcl.
12383
12384 @section Tcl Rule #1b
12385 There is a second pair of rules.
12386 @enumerate
12387 @item Rule #1: Control flow does not exist. Only commands
12388 @* For example: the classic FOR loop or IF statement is not a control
12389 flow item, they are commands, there is no such thing as control flow
12390 in Tcl.
12391 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
12392 @* Actually what happens is this: There are commands that by
12393 convention, act like control flow key words in other languages. One of
12394 those commands is the word ``for'', another command is ``if''.
12395 @end enumerate
12396
12397 @section Per Rule #1 - All Results are strings
12398 Every Tcl command results in a string. The word ``result'' is used
12399 deliberately. No result is just an empty string. Remember: @i{Rule #1 -
12400 Everything is a string}
12401
12402 @section Tcl Quoting Operators
12403 In life of a Tcl script, there are two important periods of time, the
12404 difference is subtle.
12405 @enumerate
12406 @item Parse Time
12407 @item Evaluation Time
12408 @end enumerate
12409
12410 The two key items here are how ``quoted things'' work in Tcl. Tcl has
12411 three primary quoting constructs, the [square-brackets] the
12412 @{curly-braces@} and ``double-quotes''
12413
12414 By now you should know $VARIABLES always start with a $DOLLAR
12415 sign. BTW: To set a variable, you actually use the command ``set'', as
12416 in ``set VARNAME VALUE'' much like the ancient BASIC language ``let x
12417 = 1'' statement, but without the equal sign.
12418
12419 @itemize @bullet
12420 @item @b{[square-brackets]}
12421 @* @b{[square-brackets]} are command substitutions. It operates much
12422 like Unix Shell `back-ticks`. The result of a [square-bracket]
12423 operation is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything is a
12424 string}. These two statements are roughly identical:
12425 @example
12426 # bash example
12427 X=`date`
12428 echo "The Date is: $X"
12429 # Tcl example
12430 set X [date]
12431 puts "The Date is: $X"
12432 @end example
12433 @item @b{``double-quoted-things''}
12434 @* @b{``double-quoted-things''} are just simply quoted
12435 text. $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are expanded in place - the
12436 result however is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything
12437 is a string}
12438 @example
12439 set x "Dinner"
12440 puts "It is now \"[date]\", $x is in 1 hour"
12441 @end example
12442 @item @b{@{Curly-Braces@}}
12443 @*@b{@{Curly-Braces@}} are magic: $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are
12444 parsed, but are NOT expanded or executed. @{Curly-Braces@} are like
12445 'single-quote' operators in BASH shell scripts, with the added
12446 feature: @{curly-braces@} can be nested, single quotes can not. @{@{@{this is
12447 nested 3 times@}@}@} NOTE: [date] is a bad example;
12448 at this writing, Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command.
12449 @end itemize
12450
12451 @section Consequences of Rule 1/2/3/4
12452
12453 The consequences of Rule 1 are profound.
12454
12455 @subsection Tokenisation & Execution.
12456
12457 Of course, whitespace, blank lines and #comment lines are handled in
12458 the normal way.
12459
12460 As a script is parsed, each (multi) line in the script file is
12461 tokenised and according to the quoting rules. After tokenisation, that
12462 line is immediately executed.
12463
12464 Multi line statements end with one or more ``still-open''
12465 @{curly-braces@} which - eventually - closes a few lines later.
12466
12467 @subsection Command Execution
12468
12469 Remember earlier: There are no ``control flow''
12470 statements in Tcl. Instead there are COMMANDS that simply act like
12471 control flow operators.
12472
12473 Commands are executed like this:
12474
12475 @enumerate
12476 @item Parse the next line into (argc) and (argv[]).
12477 @item Look up (argv[0]) in a table and call its function.
12478 @item Repeat until End Of File.
12479 @end enumerate
12480
12481 It sort of works like this:
12482 @example
12483 for(;;)@{
12484 ReadAndParse( &argc, &argv );
12485
12486 cmdPtr = LookupCommand( argv[0] );
12487
12488 (*cmdPtr->Execute)( argc, argv );
12489 @}
12490 @end example
12491
12492 When the command ``proc'' is parsed (which creates a procedure
12493 function) it gets 3 parameters on the command line. @b{1} the name of
12494 the proc (function), @b{2} the list of parameters, and @b{3} the body
12495 of the function. Note the choice of words: LIST and BODY. The PROC
12496 command stores these items in a table somewhere so it can be found by
12497 ``LookupCommand()''
12498
12499 @subsection The FOR command
12500
12501 The most interesting command to look at is the FOR command. In Tcl,
12502 the FOR command is normally implemented in C. Remember, FOR is a
12503 command just like any other command.
12504
12505 When the ascii text containing the FOR command is parsed, the parser
12506 produces 5 parameter strings, @i{(If in doubt: Refer to Rule #1)} they
12507 are:
12508
12509 @enumerate 0
12510 @item The ascii text 'for'
12511 @item The start text
12512 @item The test expression
12513 @item The next text
12514 @item The body text
12515 @end enumerate
12516
12517 Sort of reminds you of ``main( int argc, char **argv )'' does it not?
12518 Remember @i{Rule #1 - Everything is a string.} The key point is this:
12519 Often many of those parameters are in @{curly-braces@} - thus the
12520 variables inside are not expanded or replaced until later.
12521
12522 Remember that every Tcl command looks like the classic ``main( argc,
12523 argv )'' function in C. In JimTCL - they actually look like this:
12524
12525 @example
12526 int
12527 MyCommand( Jim_Interp *interp,
12528 int *argc,
12529 Jim_Obj * const *argvs );
12530 @end example
12531
12532 Real Tcl is nearly identical. Although the newer versions have
12533 introduced a byte-code parser and interpreter, but at the core, it
12534 still operates in the same basic way.
12535
12536 @subsection FOR command implementation
12537
12538 To understand Tcl it is perhaps most helpful to see the FOR
12539 command. Remember, it is a COMMAND not a control flow structure.
12540
12541 In Tcl there are two underlying C helper functions.
12542
12543 Remember Rule #1 - You are a string.
12544
12545 The @b{first} helper parses and executes commands found in an ascii
12546 string. Commands can be separated by semicolons, or newlines. While
12547 parsing, variables are expanded via the quoting rules.
12548
12549 The @b{second} helper evaluates an ascii string as a numerical
12550 expression and returns a value.
12551
12552 Here is an example of how the @b{FOR} command could be
12553 implemented. The pseudo code below does not show error handling.
12554 @example
12555 void Execute_AsciiString( void *interp, const char *string );
12556
12557 int Evaluate_AsciiExpression( void *interp, const char *string );
12558
12559 int
12560 MyForCommand( void *interp,
12561 int argc,
12562 char **argv )
12563 @{
12564 if( argc != 5 )@{
12565 SetResult( interp, "WRONG number of parameters");
12566 return ERROR;
12567 @}
12568
12569 // argv[0] = the ascii string just like C
12570
12571 // Execute the start statement.
12572 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[1] );
12573
12574 // Top of loop test
12575 for(;;)@{
12576 i = Evaluate_AsciiExpression(interp, argv[2]);
12577 if( i == 0 )
12578 break;
12579
12580 // Execute the body
12581 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[3] );
12582
12583 // Execute the LOOP part
12584 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[4] );
12585 @}
12586
12587 // Return no error
12588 SetResult( interp, "" );
12589 return SUCCESS;
12590 @}
12591 @end example
12592
12593 Every other command IF, WHILE, FORMAT, PUTS, EXPR, everything works
12594 in the same basic way.
12595
12596 @section OpenOCD Tcl Usage
12597
12598 @subsection source and find commands
12599 @b{Where:} In many configuration files
12600 @* Example: @b{ source [find FILENAME] }
12601 @*Remember the parsing rules
12602 @enumerate
12603 @item The @command{find} command is in square brackets,
12604 and is executed with the parameter FILENAME. It should find and return
12605 the full path to a file with that name; it uses an internal search path.
12606 The RESULT is a string, which is substituted into the command line in
12607 place of the bracketed @command{find} command.
12608 (Don't try to use a FILENAME which includes the "#" character.
12609 That character begins Tcl comments.)
12610 @item The @command{source} command is executed with the resulting filename;
12611 it reads a file and executes as a script.
12612 @end enumerate
12613 @subsection format command
12614 @b{Where:} Generally occurs in numerous places.
12615 @* Tcl has no command like @b{printf()}, instead it has @b{format}, which is really more like
12616 @b{sprintf()}.
12617 @b{Example}
12618 @example
12619 set x 6
12620 set y 7
12621 puts [format "The answer: %d" [expr @{$x * $y@}]]
12622 @end example
12623 @enumerate
12624 @item The SET command creates 2 variables, X and Y.
12625 @item The double [nested] EXPR command performs math
12626 @* The EXPR command produces numerical result as a string.
12627 @* Refer to Rule #1
12628 @item The format command is executed, producing a single string
12629 @* Refer to Rule #1.
12630 @item The PUTS command outputs the text.
12631 @end enumerate
12632 @subsection Body or Inlined Text
12633 @b{Where:} Various TARGET scripts.
12634 @example
12635 #1 Good
12636 proc someproc @{@} @{
12637 ... multiple lines of stuff ...
12638 @}
12639 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO someproc
12640 #2 Good - no variables
12641 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "this ; that;"
12642 #3 Good Curly Braces
12643 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO @{
12644 puts "Time: [date]"
12645 @}
12646 #4 DANGER DANGER DANGER
12647 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "puts \"Time: [date]\""
12648 @end example
12649 @enumerate
12650 @item The $_TARGETNAME is an OpenOCD variable convention.
12651 @*@b{$_TARGETNAME} represents the last target created, the value changes
12652 each time a new target is created. Remember the parsing rules. When
12653 the ascii text is parsed, the @b{$_TARGETNAME} becomes a simple string,
12654 the name of the target which happens to be a TARGET (object)
12655 command.
12656 @item The 2nd parameter to the @option{-event} parameter is a TCBODY
12657 @*There are 4 examples:
12658 @enumerate
12659 @item The TCLBODY is a simple string that happens to be a proc name
12660 @item The TCLBODY is several simple commands separated by semicolons
12661 @item The TCLBODY is a multi-line @{curly-brace@} quoted string
12662 @item The TCLBODY is a string with variables that get expanded.
12663 @end enumerate
12664
12665 In the end, when the target event FOO occurs the TCLBODY is
12666 evaluated. Method @b{#1} and @b{#2} are functionally identical. For
12667 Method @b{#3} and @b{#4} it is more interesting. What is the TCLBODY?
12668
12669 Remember the parsing rules. In case #3, @{curly-braces@} mean the
12670 $VARS and [square-brackets] are expanded later, when the EVENT occurs,
12671 and the text is evaluated. In case #4, they are replaced before the
12672 ``Target Object Command'' is executed. This occurs at the same time
12673 $_TARGETNAME is replaced. In case #4 the date will never
12674 change. @{BTW: [date] is a bad example; at this writing,
12675 Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command@}
12676 @end enumerate
12677 @subsection Global Variables
12678 @b{Where:} You might discover this when writing your own procs @* In
12679 simple terms: Inside a PROC, if you need to access a global variable
12680 you must say so. See also ``upvar''. Example:
12681 @example
12682 proc myproc @{ @} @{
12683 set y 0 #Local variable Y
12684 global x #Global variable X
12685 puts [format "X=%d, Y=%d" $x $y]
12686 @}
12687 @end example
12688 @section Other Tcl Hacks
12689 @b{Dynamic variable creation}
12690 @example
12691 # Dynamically create a bunch of variables.
12692 for @{ set x 0 @} @{ $x < 32 @} @{ set x [expr @{$x + 1@}]@} @{
12693 # Create var name
12694 set vn [format "BIT%d" $x]
12695 # Make it a global
12696 global $vn
12697 # Set it.
12698 set $vn [expr @{1 << $x@}]
12699 @}
12700 @end example
12701 @b{Dynamic proc/command creation}
12702 @example
12703 # One "X" function - 5 uart functions.
12704 foreach who @{A B C D E@}
12705 proc [format "show_uart%c" $who] @{ @} "show_UARTx $who"
12706 @}
12707 @end example
12708
12709 @node License
12710 @appendix The GNU Free Documentation License.
12711 @include fdl.texi
12712
12713 @node OpenOCD Concept Index
12714 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
12715 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
12716 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
12717 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
12718 @unnumbered OpenOCD Concept Index
12719
12720 @printindex cp
12721
12722 @node Command and Driver Index
12723 @unnumbered Command and Driver Index
12724 @printindex fn
12725
12726 @bye

Linking to existing account procedure

If you already have an account and want to add another login method you MUST first sign in with your existing account and then change URL to read https://review.openocd.org/login/?link to get to this page again but this time it'll work for linking. Thank you.

SSH host keys fingerprints

1024 SHA256:YKx8b7u5ZWdcbp7/4AeXNaqElP49m6QrwfXaqQGJAOk gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (DSA)
384 SHA256:jHIbSQa4REvwCFG4cq5LBlBLxmxSqelQPem/EXIrxjk gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
521 SHA256:UAOPYkU9Fjtcao0Ul/Rrlnj/OsQvt+pgdYSZ4jOYdgs gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:A13M5QlnozFOvTllybRZH6vm7iSt0XLxbA48yfc2yfY gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:spYMBqEYoAOtK7yZBrcwE8ZpYt6b68Cfh9yEVetvbXg gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ED25519)
+--[ED25519 256]--+
|=..              |
|+o..   .         |
|*.o   . .        |
|+B . . .         |
|Bo. = o S        |
|Oo.+ + =         |
|oB=.* = . o      |
| =+=.+   + E     |
|. .=o   . o      |
+----[SHA256]-----+
2048 SHA256:0Onrb7/PHjpo6iVZ7xQX2riKN83FJ3KGU0TvI0TaFG4 gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (RSA)